Searchable Theosophical Texts
Theosophy House

The Ancient Wisdom
by 
Annie Besant 
(1847 - 1933)
Published in 1897
The Secret Doctrine by H P Blavatsky
Annie Besant was active in Theosophical circles and a collaborator
with 
Archbishop C. W. Leadbeater. 
THE UNITY UNDERLYING ALL RELIGIONS
Right thought is necessary to right conduct, right understanding to
right 
living, and the Divine Wisdom – whether called by its ancient
Sanskrit name of 
Brahma Vidya, or its modern Greek name of Theosophia, Theosophy – comes to the 
world as at once an adequate philosophy and an all-embracing
religion and ethic. 
It was once said of the Christian Scriptures by a devotee that they
contained 
shallows in which a child could wade and depths in which a giant
must swim. A 
similar statement might be made of Theosophy, for some of its
teachings are so 
simple and so practical that any person of average intelligence can
understand 
and follow them, while others are so lofty, so profound, that the
ablest strains 
his intellect to contain them and sinks exhausted in the effort. 
In the present volume an attempt will be made to place Theosophy
before the 
reader simply and clearly, in a way which shall convey its general
principles 
and truths as forming a coherent conception of the universe, and
shall give such 
detail as is necessary for the understanding of their relations to
each other. 
An elementary textbook cannot pretend to give the fullness of knowledge
that may 
be obtained from abstruser works, but it should leave the student
with clear 
fundamental ideas on his subject, with much indeed to add by future
study but 
with little to unlearn. Into the outline given by such a book the
student should 
be able to paint the details of further research. 
It is admitted on all hands that a survey of the great religions of
the world 
shows that they hold in common many religious, ethical, and
philosophical ideas. 
But while the fact is universally granted, the explanation of the
fact is a 
matter of dispute. 
Some allege that religions have grown up on the soil of human
ignorance tilled 
by the imagination, and have been gradually elaborated from crude
forms of 
animism and fetishism; their likenesses are referred to universal
natural 
phenomena imperfectly observed and fancifully explained, solar and
star worship 
being the universal key for one school, phallic worship the equally
universal 
key for another ; fear, desire, ignorance, and wonder led the savage
to 
personify the powers of nature, and priests played upon his terrors
and his 
hopes, his misty fancies, and his bewildered questionings ; myths
became 
scriptures and symbols facts, and their basis was universal the
likeness of the 
products was inevitable. Thus speak the doctors of
"Comparative Mythology," and 
plain people are silenced but not convinced under the rain of
proofs ; they 
cannot deny the likenesses, but they dimly feel: Are all man’s
dearest hopes and 
lofty imaginings nothing more than the outcome of savage fancies
and of groping 
ignorance? Have the great leaders of the race, the martyrs and
heroes of 
humanity, lived, wrought, suffered and died deluded, for the mere 
personifications of astronomical facts and for the draped
obscenities of 
barbarians? 
The second explanation of the common property in the religions of
the world 
asserts the existence of an original teaching in the custody of a
Brotherhood of 
greatspiritual Teachers, who – Themselves the outcome of past
cycles of 
evolution – acted as the instructors and guides of the
child-humanity of our 
planet, imparting to its races and nations in turn the fundamental
truths of 
religion in the form most adapted to the idiosyncrasies of the
recipients. 
According to this view, the Founders of the great religions are
members of the 
one Brotherhood, and were aided in Their mission by many other
members, lower in 
degree than Themselves, Initiates and disciples of various grades,
eminent in 
spiritual insight, in philosophical knowledge, or in purity of
ethical wisdom. 
These guided the infant nations, gave them their polity, enacted
their laws, 
ruled them as kings, taught them as philosophers, guided them as
priests ; all 
the nations of antiquity looked back to such mighty men, demigods,
and heroes, 
and they left their traces in literature, in architecture, in
legislation. 
That such men lived it seems difficult to deny in the face of
universal 
tradition, of still existing Scriptures, and of prehistoric remains
for the most 
part now in ruins, to say nothing of other testimony which the
ignorant would 
reject. The sacred books of the East are the best evidence for the
greatness of 
their authors, for who in later days or in modern times can even
approach the 
spiritual sublimity of their religious thought, the intellectual
splendour of 
their philosophy, the breadth and purity of their ethic? And when
we find that 
these books contain teachings about God, man, and the universe
identical in 
substance under much variety of outer appearance, it does not seem
unreasonable 
to refer to them to a central primary body of doctrine. To that
body we give the 
name Divine Wisdom, in its Greek form: THEOSOPHY.
As the origin and basis of all religions, it cannot be the
antagonist of any: it 
is indeed their purifier, revealing the valuable inner meaning of
much that has 
become mischievous in its external presentation by the perverseness
of ignorance 
and the accretions of superstition ; but it recognises and defends
itself in 
each, and seeks in each to unveil its hidden wisdom. No man in
becoming a 
Theosophist need cease to be a Christian, a Buddhist, a Hindu ; he
will but 
acquire a deeper insight into his own faith, a firmer hold on its
spiritual 
truths, a broader understanding of its sacred teachings. As Theosophy
of old 
gave birth to religions, so in modern times does it justify and
defend them. It 
is the rock whence all of them were hewn, the hole of the pit
whence all were 
dug. It justifies at the bar of intellectual criticism the deepest
longings and 
emotions of the human heart: it verifies our hopes for man ; it
gives us back 
ennobled our faith in God. 
The truth of this statement becomes more and more apparent as we
study the 
various world-Scriptures, and but a few selections from the wealth
of material 
available will be sufficient to establish the fact, and to guide
the student in 
his search for further verification. The main spiritual verities of
religion may 
be summarised thus: 
  One eternal, infinite,
incognisable real Existence. 
  From THAT the manifested
God, unfolding from unity to duality to trinity. 
  From the manifested Trinity
many spiritual Intelligences, guiding cosmic 
  order. 
  Man a reflection of the
manifested God and therefore a trinity fundamentally, 
  his inner and real Self
being eternal, one with the Self of the universe. 
  His evolution by repeated
incarnations, into which he is drawn by desire, and 
  from which he is set free
by knowledge and sacrifice, becoming divine in 
  potency as he had ever been
divine in latency. 
Turanians, the fourth subdivision of the great Fourth Race, the
race which 
inhabited the lost continent of Atlantis, and spread its offshoots
over the 
world. The Mongolians, the last subdivision of that same race,
later reinforced 
its population, so that in 
the settlement of the Fifth, or Aryan race in 
or Classic of Purity, we have a fragment of an ancient scripture of
singular 
beauty, breathing out the spirit of restfulness and peace so
characteristic of 
the "original teaching." Mr. Legge says in the
introductory note to his 
translation [ The Sacred Books of the East] that the treatise – 
"Is attributed to Ko Yüan (or Hsüan), a Taoist of the Wü
dynasty (A.D. 222-227), 
who is fabled to have attained to the state of an Immortal, and is
generally so 
denominated. He is represented as a worker of miracles ; as
addicted to 
intemperance, and very eccentric in his ways. When shipwrecked on
one occasion, 
he emerged from beneath the water with his clothes unwet, and
walked freely on 
the surface. Finally he ascended to the sky in bright day. All
these accounts 
may safely be put down as the figments of later time." 
Such stories are repeatedly told of Initiates of various degrees, and
are by no 
means necessarily "figments," but we are more interested
in Ko Yüan’s own 
account of the book. 
"When I obtained the true Tao, I recited this Ching [book] ten
thousand times. 
It is what the Spirits of heaven practise and had not been communicated
to 
scholars of this lower world. I got if from the Divine Ruler of the
Eastern Hwa 
; he received it from the Divine Ruler of the Golden Gate ; he
received it from 
the Royal-mother of the West. 
Now the "Divine Ruler of the Golden Gate," was the title
held by the Initiate 
who ruled the Toltec empire in Atlantis, and its use suggests that
the Classic 
of Purity was brought thence to 
Toltecs. The idea is strengthened by the contents of the brief
treatise, which 
deals with Tao – literally "the Way’ – the name by which the
One Reality is 
indicated in the ancient Turanian and Mongolian religion. We read: 
"The Great Tao has no bodily form, but It produced and
nourishes heaven and 
earth. The Great Tao has no passions, but It causes the sun and the
moon to 
revolve as they do. The Great Tao has no name, but It effects the
growth and 
maintenance of all things. (i,1) 
This is the manifested God as unity, but duality supervenes: 
Now the Tao (shows itself in two forms), the Pure and the Turbid,
and has (two 
conditions of) Motion and Rest, Heaven is pure and earth is turbid
; heaven 
moves and the earth is at rest . The masculine is pure and the
feminine is 
turbid ; the masculine moves and the feminine is still. The radical
(Purity) 
descended, and the (turbid) issue flowed abroad, and thus all
things were 
produced (I, 2). 
This passage is particularly interesting from the allusion to the
active and 
receptive sides of Nature, the distinction between Spirit, the
generator, and 
Matter, the nourisher, so familiar in later writings. 
In the Tao Te Ching the teaching as to the Unmanifested and the
Manifested comes 
out very plainly. 
"The Tao that can be trodden is not the enduring and unchanging
Tao. The name 
that can be named is not the enduring and unchanging name. Having
no name, it is 
the Originator of heaven and earth, having a name, it is the Mother
of all 
things…Under these two aspects it is really the same ; but as
development takes 
place it receives the different names. Together we call them the
Mystery (i, 
1,2,4). " 
Students of the Kabalah will be reminded of one of the Divine
Names, "the 
Concealed Mystery." Again: 
"There was something undefined and complete, coming into existence
before heaven 
and earth. How still it was and formless, standing alone and
undergoing no 
change, reaching everywhere and in no danger (of being exhausted).
It may be 
regarded as the Mother of all things. I do not know its name, and I
give it the 
designation of the Tao. Making an effort to give it a name, I call
it the Great. 
Great, it passes on ( in constant flow). Passing on, it becomes
remote. Having 
become remote, it returns (xxv, 1-3). " 
Very interesting it is to see here the idea of the forthgoing and
the returning 
of the One Life, so familiar to us in the Hindu Literature.
Familiar seems the 
verse: 
"All things under heaven sprang from It as existent (and
named) ; that existence 
sprang from It as non-existent (and not named) (xl,2)". 
That a Universe might become, the Unmanifest must give forth the
One from whom 
duality and trinity proceed: 
"The Tao produced One ; One produced Two ; Two produced Three
; Three produced 
all things. All things leave behind them the Obscurity (out of which
they have 
come), and go forward to embrace the Brightness (into which they
have emerged), 
while they are harmonised by the Breath of vacancy (xlii, 1)."
"Breath of Space" would be a happier translation. Since
all is produced from It, 
It exists in all: 
"All pervading is the Great Tao. It may be found on the left
hand and on the 
right …It clothes all things as with a garment, and makes no
assumption of being 
their lord ; - It may be named in the smallest things. All things
return (to 
their root and disappear), and do not know that it is It which
presides over 
their doing so – It may be named in the greatest things (xxxiv, 1,
2 )." 
Chwang-ze (fourth century BC) in his presentation of the ancient
teachings, 
refers to the spiritual Intelligences coming from the Tao: 
"It has Its root and ground (of existence) in Itself. Before
there were heaven 
and earth, from of old, there It was securely existing. From It
came the 
mysterious existence of spirits, from It the mysterious existence
of God (Bk. 
vi, Pt. I, Sec. vi, 7)." 
A number of the names of these Intelligences follow, but such
beings are so well 
known to play a great part in the Chinese religion that we need not
multiply 
quotations about them. 
Man is regarded as a trinity, Taoism, says Mr. Legge, recognising
in him the 
spirit, the mind, and the body. This division comes out clearly in
the /Classic 
of Purity, in the teaching that man must get rid of desire to reach
union with 
the One: 
Now the spirit of man loves purity, but his mind disturbs it. The
mind of man 
loves stillness, but his desires draw it away. If he could always
send his 
desires away, his mind of itself would be still. Let his mind be
made clean, and 
his spirit of itself becomes pure ….The reason why men are not able
to attain to 
this is because their minds have not been cleansed, and their
desires have not 
been sent away. If one is able to send the desires away, when he
then looks at 
his mind it is no longer his: when he looks out at his body it is
no longer his 
; and when he looks farther off at external things, they are things
which he has 
nothing to do with ..(i, 3, 4). 
Then, after giving the stages of indrawing to "the condition
of perfect 
stillness," it is asked: 
"In that condition of rest independently of place, how can any
desire arise? And 
when no desire any longer arises there is the true stillness and
rest. That true 
(stillness) becomes (a) constant quality, and responds to external
things 
(without error) ; yea, that true and constant quality holds
possession of the 
nature. In such constant response and constant stillness there is
constant 
purity and rest. He who has this absolute purity enters gradually
into the 
(inspiration of the ) True Tao (i, 5)." 
The supplied words "inspiration of" rather cloud than
elucidate the meaning, for 
entering into the Tao is congruous with the whole idea and with
other 
Scriptures. 
On putting away of desire is laid much stress in Taoism ; a
commentator on the 
Classic of Purity remarks that understanding the Tao depends on
absolute purity, 
and 
The acquiring the Absolute Purity depends entirely on the putting
away of 
Desire, which is the urgent practical lesson of the Treatise. 
The Tao Teh Ching says: 
Always without desire we must be found, 
If its deep mystery we would sound; 
But if desire always within us be, 
Its outer fringe is all that we shall see.( i, 3) 
Reincarnation does not seem to be so distinctly taught as might
have been 
expected, although passages are found which imply that the main
idea was taken 
for granted and that the entity was considered as ranging through
animal as well 
as human births. Thus we have from Chwang-ze the quaint and wise
story of a 
dying man, to whom his friend said: 
"Great indeed is the Creator! What will He now make you to
become? Where will He 
take you to? Will he make you the liver of a rat or the arm of an
insect? Szelai 
replied, "Wherever a parent tells a son to go, east, west,
south or north, he 
simply follows the command …Here now is a great founder, casting
his metal. If 
the metal were to leap up (in the pot) and say, ‘I must be made
into a (sword 
like the ) Moysh,’ the great founder would be sure to regard it as
uncanny. So 
again, when a form is being fashioned in the mould of the womb, if
it were to 
say, ‘I must become a man, I must become a man,’ the Creator would
be sure to 
regard it as uncanny. When we once understand that heaven and earth
are a great 
melting pot and the Creator a great founder, where can we to go to
that shall 
not be right for us? We are born as from a quiet sleep and we die
to a calm 
awaking" (Bk. vi, Pt. I, Sec. vi). 
Turning to the Fifth, the Aryan Race, we have the same teachings
embodied in the 
oldest and greatest Aryan religion – the Brahmanical. The eternal
Existence is 
proclaimed in the Chhandogyopanishad as "One only, without a
second," and it is 
written: 
It willed, I shall multiply for the sake of the universe (vi, ii,
1, 3). 
The Supreme Logos, Brahman, is threefold – Being, Consciousness,
Bliss, and it 
is said: 
From This arise life, mind and all the senses, ether, air, fire ,
water, earth 
the support of all ( Mundakopanishad, ii,3). 
No grander descriptions of Deity can be found anywhere than in the
Hindu 
Scriptures, but they are becoming so familiar that brief quotation
will suffice. 
Let the following serve as specimens of their wealth of gems: 
"Manifest, near, moving in the secret place, the great abode,
herein rests all 
that moves, breathes, and shuts the eyes. Know That as to be
worshipped, being 
and non-being, the best, beyond the knowledge of all creatures.
Luminous, 
subtler than the subtle, in which the worlds and their denizens are
infixed. 
That, this imperishable Brahman ; That, also life and voice and
mind…In the 
golden highest sheath is spotless, partless Brahman ; That the pure
Light of 
lights, known by the knowers of the Self…That deathless Brahman is
before, 
Brahman behind, Brahman to the right and to the left, below, above,
pervading ; 
this Brahman truly is the all. This is the best ( Mundakopanishad ,
II,ii, 
1,2,9,11). 
Beyond the universe, Brahman, the supreme, the great, hidden in all
beings 
according to their bodies, the one Breath of the whole universe,
the Lord, whom 
knowing (men) become immortal. I know that mighty Spirit, the
shining sun beyond 
darkness… I know Him the unfading, the ancient, the Soul of all,
omnipresent by 
His nature, whom the Brahman-knowers call unborn, whom they call
eternal 
(Shvetashvataropanishad, iii. 7,8,21). 
When there is no darkness, no day nor night, no being nor non-being
(there is) 
Shiva even alone ; That the indestructible, That is to be
worshipped by Savriti, 
from That came forth the ancient wisdom. Not above nor below, nor
in the midst, 
can He be comprehended. Nor is there any similitude for Him whose
name is 
infinite glory. Not with the sight is established His form, none
may by the eye 
behold Him ; they who know Him by the heart and by the mind,
dwelling in the 
heart, become immortal (Ibid., iv, 18-20). 
That man in his inner Self is one with the Self of the universe –
"I am That" – 
is an idea that so thoroughly pervades all Hindu thought that man
is often 
referred to as the "divine town of 
nine gates," [ Shvetâshvataropanishad, iii,14. ] God dwelling
in the cavity of 
the heart.[ Ibid., Ii] 
"In one manner is to be seen (the Being) which cannot be proved,
which is 
eternal, without spot, higher than the ether, unborn, the great
eternal 
Soul…This great unborn Soul is the same which abides as the
intelligent (soul) 
in all living creatures, the same which abides as ether in the
heart ; [ The 
"ether in the heart" is a mystical phrase used to
indicate the One, who is said 
to dwell therein.] - in him it sleeps; it is the Subduer of all,
the Ruler of 
all, the sovereign Lord of all ; it does not become greater by good
works nor 
less by evil work. It is the Ruler of all, the sovereign Lord of
all beings, the 
Preserver of all beings, the Bridge, the Upholder of the worlds, so
that they 
fall not to ruin ( Brihadaranyakopanishad, IV, iv, 20,22, Trs. Dr.
E. Röer.) 
When God is regarded as the evolver of the universe, the threefold
character 
comes out very clearly as Shiva, Vishnu, and Brahma or again as
Vishnu sleeping 
under the waters, the Lotus springing from Him, and in the Lotus
Brahma. Man is 
likewise threefold, and in the Mândûkyopanishad the self is
described as 
conditioned by the physical body, the subtle body, and the mental
body, and then 
rising out of all into the One "without duality." From
the Trimurti (Trinity) 
come many Gods, connected with the administration of the universe,
as to whom it 
is said in the Brihadaranyakopanishad. 
"Adore Him, ye Gods, after whom the year by rolling days is
completed, the Light 
of lights, as the Immortal Life (IV, iv, 16)." 
It is hardly necessary to mention the presence in Brâhmanism of the
teaching of 
reincarnation, since its whole philosophy of life turns on this
pilgrimage of 
the Soul through many births and deaths, and not a book could be
taken up in 
which this truth is not taken for granted. By desires man is bound
to this wheel 
of change, and therefore by knowledge, devotion, and the
destruction of desires, 
man must set himself free. When the Soul knows God it is liberated.
( Shvetash, 
I, 8.) The intellect purified by knowledge beholds Him. ( Mund.,
III, I,8 .) 
Knowledge joined to devotion finds the abode of Brahman. ( Mund.,
III, ii,4). 
Whoever knows Brahman, becomes Brahman. ( Mund., III, ii,9 ) When
desires cease 
the mortal becomes immortal and obtains Brahman. ( Kathop., vi,
14). 
Buddhism, as it exists in its northern form, is quite at one with
the most 
ancient faiths, but in the southern form it seems to have let slip
the idea of 
the Logoic Trinity as of the One Existence from which They came
forth. The LOGOS 
in His triple manifestation is: the First LOGOS, Amitâbha, the
Boundless Light ; 
the Second, Avalokiteshvara, or Padmapani (Chenresi) ; the Third,
Manjusri – 
"the representative of creative wisdom, corresponding to
Brahmâ." ( Eitel’s 
Sanskrit Chinese Dictionary, sub voce. ) Chinese Buddhism
apparently does not 
contain the idea of a primordial Existence, beyond the LOGOS, but
Nepalese 
Buddhism postulates Âdi-Buddha, from Whom Amitâbha arises.
Padmapâni is said by 
Eitel to be the representative of compassionate 
partly with Shiva, but as the aspect of the Buddhist Trinity that
sends forth 
incarnations He appears rather to represent the same idea as
Vishnu, to whom He 
is allied by bearing the Lotus (fire and water, or Spirit and
Matter as the 
primary constituents of the universe). 
Reincarnation and Karma are so much the fundamentals of Buddhism
that it is 
hardly worth while to insist on them save to note the way of
liberation, and to 
remark that as the Lord Buddha was a Hindu preaching to Hindus,
Brâhmanical 
doctrines are taken for granted constantly in His teaching, as
matters of 
course. He was a purifier and a reformer, not an iconoclast, and
struck at the 
accretions due to ignorance, not at fundamental truths belonging to
the Ancient 
Wisdom. 
"Those beings who walk in the way of the law that has been
well taught, reach 
the other shore of the great sea of birth and death, that is
difficult to 
cross." (Udanavarga, xxix. 37). 
Desire binds man, and must be gotten rid of: 
"It is hard for one who is held by the fetters of desire to
free himself of 
them, says the Blessed One. The steadfast, who care not for the
happiness of 
desires, cast them off and do soon depart (to Nirvana)….Mankind has
no lasting 
desires: they are impermanent in them who experience them ; free
yourselves then 
from what cannot last, and abide not in the sojourn of death (
Ibid., Ii, 6, 8). 
He who has destroyed desires for (worldly )goods, sinfulness, the
bonds of the 
eye of the flesh, who has torn up desire by the very root, he, I
declare, is a 
Brahmana (Ibid., xxxiii, 68)." 
And a Brâhmana is a man "having his last body,"
(Udânavarga, xxxiii, 41) and is 
defined as one. 
"Who, knowing his former abodes (existences) perceives heaven
and hell, the 
Muni, who has found the way to put an end to birth". (ibid.,
xxxiii,55). 
In the exoteric Hebrew Scriptures, the idea of a Trinity does not
come out 
strongly, though duality is apparent, and the God spoken of is
obviously the 
LOGOS, not the One Unmanifest: 
"I am the Lord and there is none else. I form the light and
create darkness; I 
make peace and create evil ; I am the Lord that doeth all these
things." (Is., 
xlvii, 7) 
Philo, however, has the doctrine of the LOGOS very clearly, and it
is found in 
the Fourth Gospel: 
"In the beginning was the Word [Logos] and the Word was with
God and the Word 
was God….All things were made by Him, and without Him was not
anything made that 
was made. (
In the Kabalah the doctrine of the One, the Three, the Seven, and
then the many, 
is plainly taught: 
The Ancient of the Ancients, the Unknown of the Unknown, has a
form, yet also 
has not any form. It has a form through which the universe is
maintained. It 
also has not any form, as It cannot be comprehended. When It first
took this 
form [Kether, the Crown, the First Logos] It permitted to proceed
from It nine 
brilliant Lights [Wisdom and the Voice, forming with Kether the
Triad, and then 
the seven lower Sephiroth] …It is the Ancient of the Ancients, the
Mystery of 
the Mysteries, the Unknown of the Unknown. 
It has a form which appertains to It, since It appears (through it)
to us, as 
the Ancient Man above all as the Ancient of the Ancients, and as
that which 
there is the Most Unknown among the Unknown. But under that form by
which It 
makes Itself known, It however still remains the Unknown (Issac
Myer’s Qabbalah, 
from the Zohar, pp. 274-275). 
Myer points out that the "form" is "not ‘the Ancient
of the Ancients,’ who is 
the Ain Soph. 
Again: 
"Three Lights are in the Holy Upper which Unite as One ; and
they are the basis 
of the Thorah, and this opens the door to all….Come, see! the
mystery of the 
word. These are three degrees and each exists by itself, and yet
all are One and 
are knotted in One, nor are they separated one from another….Three
come out from 
One, One exists in Three, it is the force between Two, Two
nourishes One. One 
nourishes many sides, thus All is One. (ibid., 373, 375,376). 
Needless to say that the Hebrews held the doctrine of many Gods –
"Who is like 
unto Thee, O Lord, among the Gods?" –and of multitudes of
subordinate 
ministrants, the "Sons of God," the "Angels of the
Lord," the "Ten Angelic 
Hosts."(Exodus, xv,ii.) 
Of the commencement of the universe the Zohar teaches: 
In the beginning was the Will of the King, prior to any existence
which came 
into being through emanation from this Will. It sketched and
engraved the forms 
of all things that were to be manifested from concealment into
view, in the 
supreme and dazzling light of the Quadrant [the Sacred Tetractys]
(Myer’s 
Quabbalah, pp. 194-95). 
Nothing can exist in which the Deity is not immanent, and with
regard to 
Reincarnation it is taught that the Soul is present in the divine
Idea ere 
coming to earth ; if the Soul remained quite pure during its trial
it escaped 
rebirth, but this seems to have been only a theoretical
possibility, and it is 
said: 
All souls are subject to revolution (metempsychosis, a’leen
o’gilgoolah), but 
men do not know the ways of the Holy One: blessed be It! they are
ignorant of 
the way they have been judged in all time, and before they came
into this world 
and when they have quitted it (ibid., p. 198). 
Traces of this belief occur both in the Hebrew and Christian
exoteric 
Scriptures, as in the belief that Elijah would return, and later
that he had 
returned in John the Baptist. 
Turning to glance at 
Trinity, Ra, Osiris-Isis as the dual Second LOGOS, and Horus. The
great hymn to 
Amun-Ra will be remembered: 
The Gods bow before Thy Majesty by exalting the Souls of That which
produceth 
them….and say to Thee: Peace to all emanations from the unconscious
father of 
the conscious Fathers of the Gods…..Thou Producer of beings, we
adore the Souls 
which emanate from Thee. Thou begettest us, O Thou Unknown, and we
greet Thee in 
worshipping each God-Soul which descendeth from Thee and liveth in
us (quoted in 
Secret Doctrine iii, 485, 1893 ed.; v, 463, Adyar Ed.). 
The "conscious Fathers of the Gods" are the LOGOI, the
"unconscious Father" is 
the One Existence, unconscious not as being less but as being
infinitely more 
than what we call consciousness, a limited thing. 
In the fragments of the Book of the Dead we can study the
conceptions of the 
reincarnating of the human Soul, of its pilgrimage towards and its
ultimate 
union with the LOGOS. The famous papyrus of "the scribe Ani,
triumphant in 
peace," is full of touches that remind the reader of the
Scriptures of other 
faiths ; his journey through the underworld, his expectation of
re-entering his 
body (the form taken by reincarnation among the Egyptians), his
identification 
with the LOGOS: 
Saith Osiris Ani: I am the great One, son of the great One ; I am
Fire, the son 
of Fire …I have knit together my bones, I have made myself whole
and sound ; I 
have become young once more ; I am Osiris the Lord of eternity
(xliii, 1, 4 ). 
In Pierret’s recension of The Book of the Dead we find the striking
passage: 
I am the being of mysterious names who prepares for himself
dwellings for 
millions of years (p. 22). Heart, that comest to me from my mother,
my heart 
necessary to my existence on earth …Heart, that comest to me from
my mother, 
heart that is necessary for me for my transformation (pp. 113-114).
In Zoroastrianism we find the conception of the One Existence,
imaged as 
Boundless Space, whence arises the LOGOS, the creator Aûharmazd: 
Supreme in omniscience and goodness, and unrivalled in splendor:
the region of 
light is the place of Aûharmazd (The Bundahis, Sacred Books of the
East, v, 3, 
4; v, 2). 
To him in the Yasna, the chief liturgy of the Zarathustrians,
homage is first 
paid: 
I announce and I (will) complete (my Yasna [worship] to Ahura
Mazda, the 
creator, the radiant and glorious, the greatest and the best, the
most beautiful 
(?) (to our conceptions), the most firm, the wisest, and the one of
all whose 
body is most perfect, who attains his ends the most infallibly,
because of His 
righteous order, to Him who disposes our minds aright, who sends
His 
joy-creating grace afar ; who made us and has fashioned us, and who
has 
nourished and protected us, who is the most bounteous Spirit (Sacred
Books of 
the East, xxxi, pp. 195,196). 
The worshipper then pays homage to the Ameshaspends and other Gods,
but the 
supreme manifested God, the LOGOS, is not here presented as triune.
As with the 
Hebrews, there was a tendency in the exoteric faith to lose sight
of this 
fundamental truth. Fortunately we can trace the primitive teaching,
though it 
disappeared in later times from the popular belief. Dr. Haug, in
his Essays on 
the Parsis (translated by Dr. West and forming vol. v of Trubner’s
Oriental 
Series) states that Ahuramazda – Aûharmazd or Hârmazd – is the
Supreme Being, 
and that from him were produced – 
Two primeval causes, which, though different were united and
produced the world 
of material things as well as that of the spirit (p. 303). 
These were called twins and are everywhere present, in Ahuramazda
as well as in 
man. One produces reality, the other non-reality, and it is these
who in later 
Zoroastrianism became the opposing Spirits of good and evil. In the
earlier 
teachings they evidently formed the Second Logos, duality being his
characteristic mark. 
The "good" and "bad" are merely Light and
Darkness, Spirit and Matter, the 
fundamental "twins" of the Universe, the Two from the
One. 
Criticising the later idea, Dr. Haug says: 
Such is the original Zoroastrian notion of the two creative
Spirits, who form 
only two parts of the Divine being. But in the course of time this
doctrine of 
the great founder was changed and corrupted, in consequence of
misunderstandings 
and false interpretations. Spentômainyush [ the "good
spirit"] was taken as a 
name of Ahuramazda Himself, and then of course Angrômainyush [ the
"evil 
spirit"] by becoming entirely separated from Ahuramazda ; was
regarded as the 
constant adversary of Ahuramazda: thus the Dualism of God and Devil
arose (p. 
205). 
Dr. Haug’s view seems to be supported by the Gâtha Ahunavaiti,
given with other 
Gâthas by "the archangels" to Zoroaster or Zarathustra: 
In the beginning there was a pair of twins, two spirits, each of a
peculiar 
activity ; these are the good and the base …And these two spirits
united created 
the first (the material things) ; one the reality, the other the
non-reality 
…And to succor this life (to increase it) Armaiti came with wealth,
the good and 
true mind ; she, the everlasting one, created the material
world….All perfect 
things are garnered up in the splendid residence of the Good Mind,
the Wise and 
the Righteous, who are known as the best beings (Yas., xxx,
3,4,7,10; Dr. Haug’s 
translation, pp.149-151). 
Here the three LOGOI are seen, Ahuramazda the first, the supreme
Life ; in and 
from him the "twins," the Second LOGOS ; then Armaiti the
Mind, the Creator of 
the Universe, the Third LOGOS. ( Armaiti was a first Wisdom and the
Goddess of 
Wisdom, Later as the creator, She became identified with the earth,
and was 
worshipped as the Goddess of Earth). Later Mithra appears, and in
the exoteric 
faith clouds the primitive truth to some extent ; of him it is
said: 
Whom Ahura Mazda has established to maintain and look over all this
moving world 
; who, never sleeping, wakefully guards the creation of Mazda
(Mihir Yast, 
xxvii, 103: Sacred Books of the East, xviii). 
He was a subordinate God, the Light of Heaven, as Varuna was the
Heaven itself, 
one of the great ruling Intelligences. The highest of these ruling
Intelligences 
were the six Ameshaspends, headed by the Good Thought of
Ahuramazda, Vohûman – 
Who have charge of the whole material creation (Sacred Books of the
East,v. p. 
10 note). 
Reincarnation does not seem to be taught in the books which, so
far, have been 
translated, and the belief is not current among modern Parsis. But
we do find 
the idea of the Spirit in man as a spark that is to become a flame
and to be 
reunited to the Supreme Fire, and this must imply a development for
which 
rebirth is a necessity. Nor will Zoroastrianism ever be understood
until we 
recover the Chaldean Oracles and allied writings, for there is its
real root. 
Travelling westward to 
such abundant learning by G.R.S.Mead in his work Orpheus. The
Ineffable 
Thrice-unknown Darkness was the name given to the One Existence. 
According to the theology of Orpheus, all things originate from an
immense 
principle, to which through the imbecility and poverty of human
conception we 
give a name, though it is perfectly ineffable, and in the
reverential language 
of the Egyptians in a thrice unknown darkness in contemplation of
which all 
knowledge is refunded into ignorance (Thomas Taylor, quoted in
Orpheus, ). 
From this the "Primordial Triad," Universal Good,
Universal Soul, Universal 
Mind, again the Logoic Trinity. Of this Mr. Mead writes: 
The first Triad, which is manifestable to intellect, is but a
reflection of, or 
substitute for the Unmanifestable, and its hypostases are: (a) the
Good, which 
is super-essential; (b) Soul (the World Soul), which is a
self-motive essence; 
and (c) Intellect (or the Mind), which is an impartible, immovable
essence 
(ibid., p. 94). 
After this, a series of ever-descending Triads, showing the
characteristics of 
the first in diminishing splendor until man is reached, who – 
Has in him potentially the sum and substance of the
universe…"The race of men 
and gods is one (Pindar, who was a Pythagorean, quoted by Clemens,
Strom., 
v.709)…Thus man was called the microcosm or little world, to
distinguish him 
from the universe or great world (ibid., p. 271). 
He has the Nous, or real mind, the Logos or rational part, the
Alogos or 
irrational part, the two latter again forming a Triad, and thus
presenting the 
more elaborate septenary division. The man was also regarded as
having three 
vehicles, the physical and subtle bodies and the luciform body or
augoeides, 
that: 
Is the "causal body," or karmic vesture of the soul, in
which its destiny, or 
rather all the seeds of past causation are stored. This is the
"thread-soul," as 
it is sometimes called, the "body" that passes over from
one incarnation to 
another (ibid., p. 284). 
As to reincarnation: 
Together with all the adherents of the Mysteries in every land the
Orphics 
believed in reincarnation (ibid., p. 292). 
To this Mr. Mead brings abundant testimony, and he shows that it
was taught by 
Plato, Empedocles, Pythagoras, and others. Only by virtue could men
escape from 
the life-wheel. 
the teachings of Plato on the One beyond the One, the Unmanifest
Existence: 
Perhaps indeed, Plato leads us ineffably through the one as a
medium to the 
ineffable beyond the one which is now the subject of discussion ;
and this by an 
ablation of the one in the same manner as he leads to the one by an
ablation of 
other things…That which is beyond the one is to be honoured in the
most perfect 
silence…The one indeed wills to be by itself, but with no other ;
but the 
unknown beyond the one is perfectly ineffable, which we acknowledge
we neither 
know, nor are ignorant of, but which has about itself
super-ignorance. Hence by 
proximity to this the one itself is darkened ; for being near to
the immense 
principle, if it be lawful so to speak, it remains as it were in
the adytum of 
the truly mystic silence…The first is above the one and all things,
being more 
simple than either of these (pp.341-343). 
The Pythagorean, Platonic, and Neo-Platonic schools have so many
points of 
contact with Hindu and Buddhist thought that their issue from the
one fountain 
is obvious. R. Garbe, in his work, Die Samkhya Philosophie
(iii,pp.85-105) 
presents many of these points, and his statement may be summarised
as follows: 
The most striking is the resemblance – or more correctly the
identity – of the 
doctrine of the One and Only in the Upanishads and the Eleatic
school. 
Xenophanes’ teaching of the unity of God and the Kosmos and of the 
changelessness of the One, and even more that of Parmenides, who
held that 
reality is ascribable only to the One unborn, indestructible and
omnipresent, 
while all that is manifold and subject to change is but an
appearance, and 
further that Being and Thinking are the same – these doctrines are
completely 
identical with the essential contents of the Upanishads and of the
Vedântic 
philosophy which springs from them. But even earlier still the view
of Thales, 
that all that exists has sprung from Water, is curiously like the
VaidiK 
doctrine that the Universe arose from the waters. Later on
Anaximander assumed 
as the basis (????) of all things an eternal, infinite, and
indefinite 
Substance, from which all definite substances proceed and into
which they return 
– an assumption identical with that which lies at the root of the
Sankhya, viz., 
the Prakrti from which the whole material side of the universe
evolved. 
And his famous saying p??ta ´?eî (panta rhei) expresses the
characteristic view 
of the Sânkhya that all things are ever changing under the
ceaseless activity of 
the three gunas. Empedocles again taught theories of transmigration
and 
evolution practically the same as those of the Sânkhyas, while his
theory that 
nothing can come into being which does not already exist is even
more closely 
identical with a characteristically Sânkhyan doctrine. 
Both Anaxagoras and Democritus also present several points of close
agreement, 
especially the latter’s view as to the nature and position of the
Gods, and the 
same applies, notably in some curious matters of detail, to
Epicurus. But it is, 
however, in the teachings of Pythagoras that we find the closest
and most 
frequent identities of teachings and argumentation, explained as
due to 
Pythagoras himself having visited 
tradition asserts. In later centuries we find some peculiarly
Sânkhyan and 
Buddhist ideas playing a prominent part in Gnostic thought. The
following 
quotation from Lassen, cited by Garbe on p. 97, shows this very
clearly: 
Buddhism in general distinguishes clearly between Spirit and Light,
and does not 
regard the latter as immaterial ; but a view of Light is found
among them which 
is closely related to that of the Gnostics. According to this,
Light is the 
manifestation of Spirit in matter ; the intelligence thus clothed
in Light comes 
into relation with matter, in which the Light can be lessened and
at last quite 
obscured, in which case the Intelligence falls finally into
complete 
unconsciousness. 
Of the highest Intelligence it is maintained that it is neither
Light nor 
Not-Light, neither Darkness nor Not-Darkness, since all those
expressions denote 
relations of the Intelligence to the Light, which indeed in the
beginning was 
free from these connections, but later on encloses the Intelligence
and mediates 
its connection with matter. It follows from this that the Buddhist
view ascribes 
to the highest Intelligence the power to produce light from itself,
and that in 
this respect also there is an agreement between Buddhism and
Gnosticism. 
Garbe here points out that, as regards the features alluded to, the
agreement 
between Gnosticism and Sânkhya is very much closer than that with
Buddhism ; for 
while these views as to the relations between Light and Spirit
pertain to the 
later phases of Buddhism, and are not at all fundamental to, or
characteristic 
of it as such, the Sânkhya teaches clearly and precisely that
Spirit is Light. 
Later still the influence of the Sânkhya thought is very plainly
evident in the 
Neo-Platonic writers ; while the doctrine of the LOGOS or Word,
though not of 
Sânkhyan origin, shows even in its details that it has been derived
from 
where the conception of Vach, the Divine Word, plays so prominent a
part in the 
Brâhmanical system. 
Coming to the Christian religion, contemporaneous with the Gnostic
and 
Neo-Platonic systems, we shall find no difficulty in tracing most
of the same 
fundamental teachings with which we have now become so familiar.
The threefold 
LOGOS appears as the Trinity ; the First LOGOS, the fount of all
life being the 
Father ; the dual-natured Second LOGOS the Son, God-man ; the
Third, the 
creative Mind, the Holy Ghost, whose brooding over the waters of
chaos brought 
forth the worlds. Then comes "the seven Spirits of God"
[Rev. iv. 5.] and the 
hosts archangels and angels. Of the One Existence from which all
comes and into 
which all returns, but little is hinted, the Nature that by
searching cannot be 
found out ; but the great doctors of the Church Catholic always
posit the 
unfathomable Deity, incomprehensible, infinite, and therefore
necessarily but 
One and partless. 
Man is made in the "image of God," [Gen. I, 26-27] and is
consequently triple in 
his nature – Spirit and Soul and body, [1-Thess. V, 23] he is a
"habitation of 
God," [Eph. Ii, 22] the "
Holy Ghost," [ I Cor., vi, 19] – phrases that exactly echo the
Hindu teaching. 
The doctrine of reincarnation is rather taken for granted in the
New Testament 
than distinctly taught ; thus Jesus speaking of John the Baptist,
declares that 
he is Elias "which was for to come." [ Matt. xi., 14]
referring to the words of 
Malachi, " I will send you Elijah the prophet", [ Mal.,
Iv, 5] and again, when 
asked as to Elijah coming before the Messiah, He answered that
"Elias is come 
already and they knew him not." [ Matt. xvii, 12 ].So again we
find the 
disciples taking reincarnation for granted in asking whether
blindness from 
birth was a punishment for a man’s sin and Jesus in answer not
rejecting the 
possibility of ante-natal sin, but only excluding it as causing the
blindness in 
the special instance. [John, ix, 1-13 ] The remarkable phrase
applied to "him 
that overcometh" in Rev. iii, 12, - that he shall be "a
pillar in the temple of 
my God, and he shall go no more out", has been taken as
signifying escape from 
rebirth. From the writings of some of the Christian Fathers a good
case may be 
made our for a current belief in reincarnation ; some argue that
only the 
pre-existence of the Soul is taught, but this view does not seem to
me supported 
by the evidence. 
The unity of moral teaching is not less striking, than the unity of
the 
conceptions of the universe and of the experiences of those who
rose out of the 
prison of the body into the freedom of the higher spheres. It is
clear that this 
body of primeval teaching was in the hands of definite custodians,
who had 
schools in which they taught, disciples who studied their
doctrines. The 
identity of these schools and of their discipline stands out
plainly when we 
study the moral teaching, the demands made on the pupils, and the
mental and 
spiritual states to which they were raised. A caustic division is
made in the 
Tao Teh Ching of the types of scholars: 
Scholars of the highest class when they hear about the Tao,
earnestly carry it 
into practice. Scholars of the middle class, when they have hears about
it, seem 
now to keep it and now to lose it. Scholars of the lowest class,
when they have 
heard about it, laugh greatly at it (Sacred Books of the East,
xxxix, op. Cit., 
xli, 1). 
In the same book we read: 
The sage puts his own person last, and yet it is found in the
foremost place; he 
treats his person as if it were foreign to him, and yet that person
is 
preserved. It is not because he has no personal and private ends
that therefore 
such ends are realised? (vii,2) – He is free from self-display, and
therefore he 
shines; from self-assertion, and therefore he is distinguished ;
from 
self-boasting, and therefore his merit is acknowledged, from
self-complacency, 
and therefore he acquires superiority. It is because he is thus
free from 
striving that therefore no one in the world is able to strive with
him (xxii, 
2). There is no guilt greater than to sanction ambition ; no
calamity greater 
than to be discontented with one’s lot ; no fault greater than the
wish to be 
getting (xlvi,2). To those who are good (to me) I am good ; and to
those who are 
not good (to me) I am also good ; and thus all get to be good. To
those who are 
sincere (with me) I am sincere; and to those who are not sincere
(with me) I am 
also sincere ; and thus (all) get to be sincere (xlix, 1). He who
has in himself 
abundantly the attributes (of the Tâo ) is like an infant.
Poisonous insects 
will not sting him ; fierce beasts will not seize him ; birds of
prey will not 
strike him – ( lv, 1), I have three precious things which I prize
and hold fast. 
The first is gentleness ; the second is economy ; the third is
shrinking from 
taking precedence of others …Gentleness is sure to be victorious,
even in 
battle, and firmly to maintain its ground. Heaven will save its
possessor, by 
his (very) gentleness protecting him (lxvii,2,4). 
Among the Hindus there were selected scholars deemed worthy of
special 
instruction to whom the Guru imparted the secret teachings, while
the general 
rules of right living may be gathered from Manu’s Ordinances, the
Upanishads, 
the Mahâbhârata and many other treatises: 
Let him say what is true, let him say what is pleasing, let him
utter no 
disagreeable truth, and let him utter no agreeable falsehood ; that
is the 
eternal law (Manu, iv, 138). Giving no pain to any creature, let
him slowly 
accumulate spiritual merit (iv, 238). For that twice-born man, by
whom not the 
smallest danger even is caused to created beings, there will be no
danger from 
any (quarter) after he is freed from his body (vi, 40). Let him
patiently bear 
hard words, let him not insult anybody, and let him not become
anybody’s enemy 
for the sake of this (perishable) body. Against an angry man let
him not in 
return show anger, let him bless when he is cursed (vi, 47-48).
Freed from 
passion, fear and anger, thinking on Me, taking refuge in Me,
purified in the 
fire of Wisdom, many have entered My Being (Bhagavad Gitâ , iv,
10). Supreme joy 
is for the Yogi whose Manas is peaceful, whose passion-nature is
calmed, who is 
sinless and of the nature of Brahman (iv, 27). He who beareth no
ill-will to any 
being, friendly and compassionate, without attachment and egoism,
balanced in 
pleasure and pain, and forgiving, ever content, harmonious, with
the self 
controlled, resolute, with Manas and Buddhi dedicated to Me – he,
My devotee, is 
dear to Me (xii,13,14) 
If we turn to the Buddha, we find Him with His Arhats, to whom His
secret 
teachings were given ; while published we have: 
The wise man through earnestness, virtue, and purity makes himself
an island 
which no flood can submerge (Udânavarga, iv, 5 ). The wise man in
this world 
holds fast to faith and wisdom, these are his greatest treasures ;
he cast aside 
all other riches, (x 9). He who bears ill-will to those who bear
ill-will can 
never become pure ; but he who feels no ill-will pacifies those who
hate ; as 
hatred brings misery to mankind, the sage knows no hatred (xiii,
12). Overcome 
anger by not being angered ; overcome evil by good ; overcome
avarice by 
liberality ; overcome falsehoods by truth (xx,18). 
The Zoroastrian is taught to praise Ahuramazda, and then: 
What is fairest, what is pure, what immortal, what brilliant, all
that is good. 
The good spirit we honor, the good kingdom we honor, and the good
law, and the 
good wisdom (Yasna, xxxvii). May there come to this dwelling
contentment, 
blessing, guilelessness, and wisdom of the pure (Yasna, lix).
Purity is the best 
good. Happiness, happiness is to him ; namely, to the best pure in
purity 
(Ashem-vohu). All good thoughts, words, and works are done with
knowledge. All 
evil thoughts, words, and works are not done with knowledge (Mispa
Kumata). ( 
Selected from the Avesta in Ancient Iranian and Zoroastrian Morals,
by 
Dhunjibhoy Jamsetji Medhora). 
The Hebrew had his "schools of the prophets" and his
Kabbalah, and in the 
exoteric books we find the accepted moral teachings: 
Who shall ascend into the hill of the Lord and who shall stand in
His holy 
place? He that hath clean hands and a pure heart ; who hath not
lifted up his 
soul unto vanity, not sworn deceitfully (Ps. xxiv,3,4). What doth
the Lord 
require of thee but to do justly, and to love mercy, and to walk
humbly with thy 
God? (Micah,vi,8). The lip of truth shall be established for ever ;
but a lying 
tongue is but for a moment (Prov. xii, 19). Is not this the fast
that I have 
chosen? to loose the bands of wickedness, to undo the heavy
burdens, and to let 
the oppressed go free, and that ye break every yoke? Is it not to
deal thy bread 
to the hungry and that thou bring the poor that are cast out to thy
home? when 
thou seest the naked that thou cover him, and that thou hide not
thyself from 
thine own flesh? (Isa. lviii,6,7). 
The Christian teacher had His secret instructions for His
disciples, (Matt. 
xiii, 10-17) – and He bade them: 
Give not that which is holy unto the dogs, neither cast ye your
pearls before 
swine (Matt. vii, 6). 
For public teaching we may refer to the beatitudes in the Sermon on
the Mount 
and to such doctrines as: 
I say unto you, love your enemies, bless them that curse you, do
good to them 
that hate you, and pray for them which despitefully use you and
persecute 
you….Be ye therefore perfect, even as your Father which is in
heaven is perfect 
(Matt. v, 44-48). He that findeth his life shall lose it ; and he
that loseth 
his life for my sake shall find it (x,39). Whoever shall humble
himself as this 
little child, the same is greatest in the kingdom of heaven (xviii,
4). The 
fruit of the Spirit is love, joy, peace, long-suffering,
gentleness, goodness, 
faith, meekness, temperance ; against such there is no law (Gal.,
v, 22-23). Let 
us love one another ; for love is of God ; and everyone that loveth
is born of 
God and knoweth God ( I John iv, 7 ). 
The school of the Pythagoras and those of the Neo-Platonists kept
up the 
tradition for 
precise information has been published of the Grecian schools than
of others ; 
the Pythagorean had pledged disciples as well as an outer
discipline, the inner 
circle passing through three degrees during five years of
probation. (For 
details see G.R.S. Mead’s Orpheus, p. 263 et. Seq.). The outer
discipline he 
describes as follows: 
We must first give ourselves up entirely to God. When a man prays
he should 
never ask for any particular benefit, fully convinced that that
will be given 
which is right and proper, and according to the wisdom of God and
not the 
subject of our own selfish desires (Diod. Sic. ix, 41). By virtue
alone does man 
arrive at blessedness, and this is the exclusive privilege of a
rational being 
(Hippodamus, De Felicitate, ii, Orelli, Opusc. Græcor. Sent. et
Moral., Ii, 
284). In himself, of his own nature, man is neither good nor happy,
but he may 
become so by the teaching of the true doctrine (µa??s??? ?a??
p?????a? 
p?t?d?eta?) – (Hippo, ibid.). 
The most sacred duty is filial piety. "God showers his
blessings on him who 
honors and reveres the author of his days," says Pampelus (De
Parentibus, 
Orelli, op. Cit., ii, 345). Ingratitude towards one’s parents is
the blackest of 
all crimes, writes Perictione ( ibid.,p. 350), who is supposed to
have been the 
mother of Plato. The cleanliness and delicacy of all Pythagorean
writings were 
remarkable (Œlian, Hist. Var., xiv,19). In all that concerns
chastity and 
marriage their principles are of the utmost purity. Everywhere the
great teacher 
recommends chastity and temperance ; but at the same time he
directs that the 
married should first become parents before living a life of
absolute celibacy, 
in order that children might be born under favourable conditions
for continuing 
the holy life and succession of the Sacred Science (Iamblichus,
Vit. Pythag., 
and Hierocl., ap. Stob. Serm. xlv, 14). This is exceedingly
interesting, for it 
is precisely the same regulation that is laid down in the Mânava
Dharma Shâstra, 
the great Indian Code. …Adultery was most sternly condemned (Iamb.,
ibid.). 
Moreover, the most gentle treatment of the wife by the husband was
enjoined, for 
had he not taken her as his companion "before the Gods"?
(See Lascaulx. Zur 
Geschichte der Ehe bei den Griechen, in the Mém. De l’Acad. De
Bavière, vii, 
107,sq.). 
Marriage was not an animal union, but a spiritual tie. Therefore,
in her turn, 
the wife should love her husband even more than herself, and in all
things be 
devoted and obedient. It is further interesting to remark that the
finest 
characters among women with which ancient 
school of Pythagoras, and the same is true of the men. 
The authors of antiquity are agreed that this discipline had
succeeded in 
producing the highest examples not only of the purest chastity and
sentiment, 
but also a simplicity of manners, a delicacy, and a taste for
serious pursuits 
which was unparalleled. This is admitted even by Christian writers
(See Justin, 
xx, 4)…Among the members of the school the idea of justice directed
all their 
acts, while they observed the strictest tolerance and compassion in
their mutual 
relationships. For justice is the principle of all virtue, as
Polus, (ap. Stob., 
Serm., viii, ed. Schow, p. 232) teaches ; "’tis justice which
maintains peace 
and balance in the soul ; she is the mother of good order in all
communities, 
makes concord between husband and wife, love between master and
servant.’ The 
word of a Pythagorean: was also his bond. And finally a man should
live so as to 
be ever ready for death ( Hippolytus, Philos., vi). (ibid., p.
263-267). 
The treatment of the virtues in the Neo-Platonic schools is
interesting, and the 
distinction is clearly made between morality and spiritual
development, or as 
Plotinus put it, "The endeavour is not to be without sin, but
to be of God." 
(Select Works of Plotinus, trans. Thomas Taylor, ed., 1895, p.
11).The lowest 
stage was becoming without sin by acquiring the "political
virtues" which made a 
man perfect in conduct (the physical and ethical being below
these), the reason 
controlling and adorning the irrational nature. Above these were
the cathartic, 
pertaining to reason alone, and which liberated the Soul from the
bonds of 
generation ; the theoretic , lifting the Soul into touch with
natures superior 
to itself;and the paradigmatic, giving it a knowledge of true
being: 
Hence he who energises according to the practical virtues is a
worthy man; but 
he who energises according to the cathartic virtues is a demoniacal
man, or is 
also a good demon. (A good spiritual intelligence, as the daimon of
Socrates). 
He who energises according to the intellectual virtues alone is a
God. But he 
who energises according to the paradigmatic virtues is the Father
of the Gods. 
(Note on Intellectual Prudence, pp. 325-332). 
By various practices the disciples were taught to escape from the
body, and to 
rise into higher regions. As grass is drawn from a sheath, the
inner man was to 
draw himself from his bodily casing ( Kathopanishad, vi,17). The
"body of light" 
or "radiant body" of the Hindus is the "luciform
body" of the Neo-Plationists, 
and in this man rises to find the Self: 
Not grasped by the eye, nor by speech, nor by the others senses
(lit., Gods), 
nor by austerity, nor by religious rites ; by serene wisdom, by the
pure essence 
only, doth one see the partless One in meditation. This subtle Self
is to be 
known by the mind in which the fivefold life is sleeping. The mind
of all 
creatures is instinct with [these] lives ; in this, purified,
manifests the Self 
( Mundakopanishad, III, ii, 8,9). 
Then alone can man enter the region where separation is not, where
"the spheres 
have ceased." In G.R.S.Mead’s Introduction to 
Plotinus a description of a sphere which is evidently the Turîya of
the Hindus: 
They likewise see all things, not those with which generation, but
those with 
which essence is present. And they perceive themselves in others.
For all things 
there, are diaphanous; and nothing is dark and resisting, but
everything is 
apparent to every one internally and throughout. For light
everywhere meets with 
light ; since everything contains all things in itself and again
see all things 
in another. So that all things are everywhere and all is all. Each
thing 
likewise is everything. And the splendor there is infinite. For
everything there 
is great, since even that which is small is great. The sun too
which is there is 
all the stars; and again each star is the sun and all the stars. In
each 
however, a different property predominates, but at the same time
all things are 
visible in each. Motion likewise there is pure; for the motion is
not confounded 
by a mover different from it (p. lxxiii). 
A description which is a failure, because the region is one above
describing by 
mortal language, but a description that could only have been
written by one 
whose eyes had been opened. 
A whole volume might easily be filled with the similarities between
the 
religions of the world, but the above imperfect statement must
suffice as a 
preface to the study of Theosophy,
to that which is a fresh and fuller 
presentment to the world of the ancient truths on which it has ever
been fed. 
all these similarities point to a single source, and that is the
Brotherhood of 
the White Lodge, the Hierarchy of Adepts who watch over and guide
the evolution 
of humanity, and who have preserved these truths unimpaired ; from
time to time, 
as necessity arose, reasserting them in the ears of men. From other
worlds, from 
earlier humanities, They came to help our globe, evolved by a
process comparable 
to that now going on with ourselves, and that will be more
intelligible when we 
have completed our present study than it may now appear ; and They
have afforded 
this help, reinforced by the flower of our own humanity, from the
earliest times 
until today. 
Still They teach eager pupils, showing the path and guiding the
disciple’s steps 
; still They may be reached by all who seek Them, bearing in their
hands the 
sacrificial fuel of love, of devotion, of unselfish longing to know
in order to 
serve ; still They carry out the ancient discipline, still unveil
the ancient 
Mysteries. The two pillars of Their Lodge gateway are Love and
Wisdom, and 
through its straight portal can only pass those from whose
shoulders has fallen 
the burden of desire and selfishness. 
A heavy task lies before us, and beginning on the physical plane we
shall climb 
slowly upwards, but a bird’s eye view of the great sweep of
evolution and of its 
purpose may help us, ere we begin our detailed study in the world
that surrounds 
us. A LOGOS, ere a system has begun to be, has in His mind the
whole, existing 
as idea – all forces, all forms, all that in due process shall
emerge into 
objective life. He draws the circle of manifestation within which
He wills to 
energise, and circumscribes Himself to be the life of His universe.
As we watch 
we see strata appearing of successive densities, till seven vast
regions are 
apparent, and in these centres of energy appear whirlpools of
matter that 
separate from each other, until when the processes of separation
and of 
condensation are over – so far as we are here concerned – we see a
central sun, 
the physical symbol of the LOGOS, and seven planetary chains, each
chain 
consisting of seven globes. 
Narrowing down our view to the chain of which our globe is one, we
see 
life-waves sweep round i, forming the kingdoms of nature, the three
elemental, 
the mineral, vegetable, animal, human. Narrowing down our view
still further to 
our own globe and its surroundings, we watch human evolution, and
see man 
developing self-consciousness by a series of many life-periods ;
then centering 
on a single man we trace his growth and see that each life-period
has a 
threefold division that each is linked to all life-periods behind
it reaping 
their results, and to all life-periods before it sowing their
harvests, by a law 
that cannot be broken ; that thus man may climb upwards with each
life-period 
adding to his experience, each life-period lifting him higher in
purity, in 
devotion, in intellect, in power of usefulness, until at last he
stands where 
They stand who are now the Teachers, fit, to pay to his younger
brothers the 
debt he owes to Them. 
THE PHYSICAL PLANE
We have just seen that the source from which a universe proceeds is
a manifested 
Divine Being, to whom in the modern form of the Ancient Wisdom the
name LOGOS, 
or Word has been given. The name is drawn from Greek Philosophy,
but perfectly 
expresses the ancient idea, the Word which emerges from the
Silence, the Voice, 
the Sound, by which the worlds come into being. We must now trace
the evolution 
of spirit-matter, in order that we may understand something of the
nature of the 
materials with which we have to deal on the physical plane, or
physical world. 
For it is in the potentialities wrapped up, involved, in the
spirit-matter of 
the physical world that lies the possibility of evolution. The
whole process is 
an unfolding, self-moved from within and aided by intelligent
beings without, 
who can retard or quicken evolution, but cannot transcend the
capacities 
inherent in the materials. Some idea of these earliest stages of
the world’s 
"becoming" is therefore necessary, although any attempt
to go into minute 
details would carry us far beyond the limits of such an elementary
treatise as 
the present. A very cursory sketch must suffice. 
Coming forth from the depths of the One Existence, from the ONE
beyond all 
thought and all speech, a LOGOS, by imposing on Himself a limit,
circumscribing 
voluntarily the range of His own Being, becomes the manifested God,
and tracing 
the limiting sphere of His activity thus outlines the area of His
universe. 
Within that sphere the universe is born, is evolved, and dies ; it
lives, it 
moves, it has its being in Him ; its matter is His emanation ; its
forces and 
energies are currents of His Life ; He is immanent in every atom,
all-pervading, 
all-sustaining, all-evolving ; He is its source and its end, its
cause and its 
object, its centre and circumference ; it is built on Him as its
sure 
foundation, it breathes in Him as its encircling space ; He is in
everything and 
everything in Him. Thus have the sages of the Ancient Wisdom taught
us of the 
beginning of the manifested worlds. 
From the same source we learn of the Self-unfolding of the LOGOS
into a 
threefold form ; the First LOGOS, the Root of all being ; from Him
the Second, 
manifesting the two aspects of Life and Form, the primal duality,
making the two 
poles of nature between which the web of the universe is to be
woven – 
Life-Form, Spirit-Matter, Positive-Negative, Active-Receptive,
Father-Mother of 
the worlds. Then the Third LOGOS, the Universal Mind, that in which
all 
archetypically exists, the source of beings, the fount of
fashioning energies, 
the treasure house in which are stored up all the archetypal forms
which are to 
be brought forth and elaborated in lower kinds of matter during the
evolution of 
the universe. These are the fruits of past universes, brought over
as seeds for 
the present. 
The phenomenal spirit and matter of any universe are finite in
their extent and 
transitory in their duration, but the roots of spirit and matter
are eternal. 
The root of matter (Mulâprakriti ) has been said by a profound
writer to be 
visible to the LOGOS as a veil thrown over the One existence, the
supreme 
Brahman (Parabrahman) –to use the ancient name. 
It is this "veil" which the LOGOS assumes for the purpose
of manifestation, 
using it for the self-imposed limit which makes activity possible.
From this He 
elaborates the matter of His universe, being Himself its informing,
guiding, and 
controlling life. ( Hence He is called "The Lord of Mâyâ"
in some Eastern 
Scriptures, Mâyâ, or illusion, being the principle of form; form is
regarded as 
illusory, from its transitory nature and perpetual transformations,
the life 
which expresses itself under the veil of form being the reality). 
Of what occurs on the two higher planes of the universe, the
seventh and sixth, 
we can form but the haziest conception. The energy of the LOGOS as
whirling 
motion of inconceivable rapidity "digs holes in space" in
this root matter, and 
this vortex of life encased in a film of the root of matter is the
primary atom; 
these and their aggregations, spread throughout the universe, form
all the 
subdivisions of spirit-matter of the highest or seventh plane. The
sixth plane 
is formed by some of the countless myriads of these primary atoms,
setting up a 
vortex in the coarsest aggregations of their own plane, and this
primary atom 
en-walled with spiral strands of the coarsest combinations of the
seventh plane 
becomes the finest unit of spirit-matter, or atom of the sixth
plane. These 
sixth plane atoms and their endless combinations form the
subdivisions of the 
spirit-matter of the sixth plane. 
The sixth-plane-atom, in its turn, sets up a vortex in the coarsest
aggregations 
of its own plane, and, with these coarsest aggregations as a
limiting wall, 
becomes the finest unit of spirit-matter, or atom, of the fifth
plane. Again, 
these fifth-plane atoms, and their combinations form the
subdivisions of the 
spirit-matter of the fifth plane. The process is repeated to form
successively 
the spirit-matter of the fourth, the third, the second, and the
first planes. 
These are the seven great regions of the universe, so far as their
material 
constituents are concerned. A clearer idea of them will be gained
by analogy 
when we come to master the modifications of the spirit-matter of
our own 
physical world. 
(The student may find the conception clearer if he thinks of the
fifth plane 
atoms as Atma ; those of the fourth plane as Atma enveloped in
Buddhi-matter ; 
those of the third plane as Atma enveloped in Buddhi and
Manas-matter ; those of 
the second plane as Atma enveloped in Buddhi-Manas- and Kama-matter
; those of 
the lowest as Atma enveloped in Buddhi-Manas-Kama and
Sthûla-matter. Only the 
outermost is active in each, but the inner are there, though
latent, ready to 
come into activity on the upward arc of evolution). 
The world "spirit-matter" is used designedly. At implies
the fact that there is 
no such thing as "dead" matter ; all matter is living,
the tiniest particles are 
lives. Science speaks truly in affirming: "No force without
matter, no matter 
without force." They are wedded together in an indissoluble
marriage throughout 
the ages of the life of a universe, and none can wrench them apart.
Matter is 
form, and there is no form which does not express a life ; spirit
is life, and 
there is no life that is not limited by form. Even the LOGOS, the
Supreme Lord, 
has during manifestation the universe as His form, and so down to
the atom. 
This involution of the life of the LOGOS as the ensouling force in
every 
particle, and its successive enwrapping in the spirit-matter of
every plane, so 
that the materials of each plane have within them in a hidden, or
latent 
condition, all the form and force possibilities of all the planes
above them as 
well as those of their own – these two facts make evolution certain
and give to 
the very lowest particle the hidden potentialities which will
render it fit – as 
they become active powers – to enter into the forms of the highest
beings. In 
fact, evolution may be summed up in a phrase: it is latent
potentialities 
becoming active powers. 
The second great wave of evolution, the evolution of form, and the
third great 
wave, the evolution of self-consciousness, will be dealt with later
on. These 
three currents of evolution are distinguishable on our earth in
connection with 
humanity ; the making of the materials, the building of the house,
and the 
growing of the tenant of the house, or, as said above, the evolution
of 
spirit-matter, the evolution of form, the evolution of
self-consciousness.If the 
reader can grasp and retain this idea, he will find a helpful clue
to guide him 
through the labyrinth of facts. 
We can now turn to the detailed examination of the physical plane,
that on which 
our world exists and to which our bodies belong. 
Examining the materials belonging to this plane, we are struck by
their immense 
variety, the innumerable differences of constitution in the objects
around us, 
minerals, vegetables, animals, all differing in their constituents:
matter hard 
and soft, transparent and opaque, brittle and ductile, bitter and
sweet, 
pleasant and nauseous, coloured and colourless. Out of this
confusion three 
subdivisions of matter emerge as a fundamental classification:
matter is solid, 
liquid, gaseous. Further examination shows that these solids,
liquids and gases 
are made up by combinations of much simpler bodies, called by
chemists 
"elements," and that these elements may exist in a solid,
liquid, or gaseous 
condition without changing their respective natures. 
Thus the chemical element oxygen is a constituent of wood, and in
combination 
with other elements forms the solid wood fibres ; it exists in the
sap with 
another element, yielding a liquid combination as water ; and it
exists also in 
it by itself as gas. Under these three conditions it is oxygen.
Further , pure 
oxygen can be reduced from a gas to a liquid, and from a liquid to
a solid, 
remaining pure oxygen all the time, and so with other elements. We
thus obtain 
as three subdivisions, or conditions of matter on the physical
plane, solid, 
liquid, gas. Searching further, we find a fourth condition, ether,
and a minute 
search reveals that this ether exists in four conditions as well
defined as 
those of solid, liquid and gas ; to take oxygen again as an
example: as it may 
be reduced from the gaseous condition to the liquid and the solid,
so it may be 
raised from the gaseous through four etheric stages the last of
which consists 
of the ultimate physical atom, the disintegration of the atom
taking matter out 
of the physical plane altogether, and into the next plane above. 
In the annexed plate three gases are shown in the gaseous and four
etheric 
states ; it will be observed that the structure of the ultimate
physical atom is 
the same for all, and that the variety of the "elements"
is due to the variety 
of ways in which these ultimate physical atoms combine. Thus the
seventh 
subdivision of physical spirit-matter is composed of homogeneous
atoms ; the 
sixth is composed of fairly simple heterogeneous combinations of
these, each 
combination behaving as a unit ; the fifth is composed of more
complex 
combinations, and the fourth of still more complex ones, but in all
cases these 
combinations act as units . 
The third subdivision consists of yet more complicated
combinations, regarded by 
the chemist as gaseous atoms or "elements," and on this
subdivision many of the 
combinations have received special names, oxygen, hydrogen,
nitrogen, chlorine, 
etc., and each newly discovered combination now receives its name ;
the second 
subdivision consists of combinations in the liquid condition,
whether regarded 
as elements such as bromine, or as combinations such as water or
alcohol ; the 
first subdivision is composed of all solids, again whether regarded
as elements, 
such as iodine, gold, lead, etc., or as compounds, such as wood,
stone, chalk, 
and so on. 
The physical plane may serve the student as a model from which by
analogy he may 
gain an idea of the subdivisions of spirit-matter of other planes.
When a 
Theosophist speaks of a plane, he means a region throughout which
spirit-matter 
exists, all whose combinations are derived from a particular set of
atoms; these 
atoms, in turn, are units possessing similar organisations, whose
life is the 
life of the LOGOS veiled in fewer or more coverings according to
the plane, and 
whose form consists of the solid, or lowest subdivision of matter,
of the plane 
immediately above. A plane is thus a division in nature, as well as
a 
metaphysical idea. 
Thus far we have been studying the results in our own physical
world of the 
evolution of spirit-matter in our division of the first or lowest
plane of our 
system. For countless ages the fashioning of materials has been
going on, the 
current of the evolution of spirit-matter, and in the materials of
our globe we 
see the outcome at the present time. But when we begin to study the
inhabitants 
of the physical plane, we come to the evolution of form, ( ) the
building of 
organisms out of these materials. 
When the evolution of materials had reached a sufficiently advanced
state, the 
second great life-wave from the LOGOS gave the impulse to the
evolution of form, 
and He became the organising force (As Âtmâ-Buddhi, indivisible in
action, and 
therefore spoken of as the Monad. All forms have Âtmâ-Buddhi as
controlling 
life.) - of His Universe, countless hosts of entities, entitled
Builders -- ( 
Some are lofty spiritual Intelligences, but the name covers even
the building 
Nature-spirits The subject is dealt with in Chapter XII ) - taking
part in the 
building up of forms out of combinations of spirit-matter. The life
of the LOGOS 
abiding in each form is its central, controlling, and directing
energy. 
This building of forms on the higher planes cannot here be
conveniently studied 
in detail; it may suffice to say that all forms exist as Ideas in
the mind of 
the LOGOS, and that in this second life-wave these were thrown
outwards as 
models to guide the Builders. On the third and second planes the
early 
spirit-matter combinations are designed to give it facility in
assuming shapes 
organised to act as units, and gradually to increase its stability
when shaped 
into an organism. 
This process went on upon the third and second planes, in what are
termed the 
three elemental kingdoms, the combinations of matter formed therein
being called 
generally "elemental essence," and this essence being
moulded into forms by 
aggregations, the forms enduring for a time and then
disintegrating. The 
outpoured life, or Monad, evolved through these kingdoms and
reached in due 
course the physical plane, where it began to draw together the
ethers and hold 
them in filmy shapes, in which life-currents played and into which
the denser 
materials were built, forming the first minerals. In these are
beautifully shown 
– as may be seen by reference to any book on crystallurgy – the
numerical and 
geometrical lines on which forms are constructed, and from them may
be gathered 
plentiful evidence that life is working in all minerals, although
much "cribbed, 
cabined, and confined." The fatigue to which metals are
subject is another sign 
that they are living things, but it is here enough to say that the
occult 
doctrine so regards them, knowing the already-mentioned processes
by which life 
has been involved in them. 
Great stability of form having been gained in many of the minerals,
the evolving 
Monad elaborated greater plasticity of form in the vegetable
kingdom, combining 
this with stability of organisation. These characteristics found a
yet more 
balanced expression in the animal world, and reached their
culmination of 
equilibrium in man, whose physical body is made up of constituents
of most 
unstable equilibrium, thus giving great adaptability, and yet which
is held 
together by a combining central force which resists general
disintegration even 
under the most varied conditions. 
Man’s physical body has two main divisions: the dense body, made of
constituents 
from the three lower levels of the physical plane, solids, liquids,
and gases: 
and the etheric double, violet-gray or blue-gray in colour,
interpenetrating the 
dense body and composed of materials drawn from the four higher
levels. The 
general function of the physical body is to receive contacts from
the physical 
world, and send the report of them inwards, to serve as materials
from which the 
conscious entity inhabiting the body is to elaborate knowledge. Its
etheric 
portion has also the duty of acting as a medium through which the
life-currents 
poured out from the sun can be adapted to the uses of the denser
particles. 
The sun is the great reservoir of the electrical, magnetic, and
vital forces for 
our system, and it pours out abundantly these streams of
life-giving energy. 
They are taken in by the etheric doubles of all minerals,
vegetables, animals, 
and men, and are by them transmuted into the various life-energies
needed by 
each entity. ( When thus appropriated the life is called Prana, and
it becomes 
the life-breath of every creature. Prana is but a name for the
universal life 
while it is taken in by an entity and is supporting its separated
life.) 
The etheric doubles draw in, specialise, and distribute them over
their physical 
counterparts. It has been observed that in vigorous health much
more of the 
life-energies are transmuted than the physical body requires for
its own 
support, and that the surplus is rayed out and is taken up and
utilised by the 
weaker. What is technically called the health aura is the part of
the etheric 
double that extends a few inches from the whole surface of the body
and shows 
radiating lines, like the radii of a sphere, going outwards in all
directions. 
These lines droop when vitality is diminished below the point of
health, and 
resume their radiating character with renewed vigour. It is this
vital energy, 
specialised by the etheric double, which is poured out by the
mesmeriser for the 
restoration of the weak and for the cure of disease, although he
often mingles 
with it currents of a more rarefied kind. Hence the depletion of
vital energy 
shown by the exhaustion of the mesmeriser who prolongs his work to
excess. 
Man’s body is fine or coarse in its texture according to the
materials drawn 
from the physical plane for its composition. Each subdivision of
matter yields 
finer or coarser materials ; compare the bodies of a butcher and of
a refined 
student ; both have solids in them, but solids of such different
qualities. 
Further , we know that a coarse body can be refined, a refined body
coarsened. 
The body is constantly changing ; each particle is a life, and the
lives come 
and go. They are drawn to a body consonant with themselves, they
are repelled 
from one discordant with themselves. All things live in rhythmical
vibrations, 
all seek the harmonious and are repelled by dissonance. 
A pure body repels coarse particles because they vibrate at rates
discordant 
with its own ; a coarse body attracts them because their vibrations
accord with 
its own. Hence if the body changes its rates of vibration, it
gradually drives 
out of it the constituents that cannot fall into the new rhythm,
and fills up 
their places by drawing in from external nature fresh constituents
that are 
harmonious. Nature provides materials vibrating in all possible
ways, and each 
body exercises its own selective action. 
In the earlier building of human bodies this selective action was
due to the 
Monad of form, but now that man is a self-conscious entity he
presides over his 
own building. By his thoughts he strikes the keynote of his music,
and sets up 
the rhythms that are the most powerful factors in the continual
changes in his 
physical and other bodies. As his knowledge increases he learns how
to build up 
his physical body with pure food, and so facilitates the tuning of
it. He learns 
to live by the axiom of purification: "Pure food, pure mind,
and constant memory 
of God." As the highest creature living on the physical plane,
he is the 
vice-regent of the LOGOS thereon, responsible, so far as his powers
extend, for 
its order, peace, and good government ; and this duty he cannot
discharge 
without these three requisites. 
The physical body, thus composed of elements drawn from all the
subdivisions of 
the physical plane, is fitted to receive and to answer impression
from it of 
every kind. Its first contacts will be of the simplest and crudest
sorts, and as 
the life within it thrills out in answer to the stimulus from
without, throwing 
its molecules into responsive vibrations, there is developed all
over the body 
the sense of touch, the recognition of something coming into
contact with it. As 
specialised sense-organs are developed to receive special kinds of
vibrations, 
the value of the body increases as a future vehicle for a conscious
entity on 
the physical plane. The more impressions it can answer to, the more
useful does 
it become ; for only those to which it can answer can reach the
consciousness. 
Even now there are myriads of vibrations pulsing around us in
physical nature 
from the knowledge of which we are shut out because of the
inability of our 
physical vehicle to receive and vibrate in accord with them.
Unimagined 
beauties, exquisite sounds, delicate subtleties, touch the walls of
our prison 
house and pass on unheeded. Not yet is developed the perfect body
that shall 
thrill to every pulse in nature as the aeolian harp to the zephyr. 
The vibrations that the body is able to receive, it transmits to
physical 
centres, belonging to its highly complicated nervous system. The
etheric 
vibrations which accompany all the vibrations of the denser
physical 
constituents are similarly received by the etheric double, and
transmuted to its 
corresponding centres. Most of the vibrations in the dense matter
are changed 
into chemical heat, and other forms of physical energy; the etheric
give rise to 
magnetic and electric action, and also pass on the vibrations to
the astral 
body, whence, as we shall see later, they reach the mind. 
Thus information about the external world reaches the conscious
entity enthroned 
in the body, the Lord of the body, as he is sometimes called. As
the channels of 
information develop and are exercised, the conscious entity grows
by the 
materials supplied to his thought by them, but so little is man yet
developed 
that even the etheric double is not yet sufficiently harmonised to
regularly 
convey to the man impressions received by it independently of its
denser 
comrade, or to impress them on his brain. Occasionally it succeeds
in doing so, 
and then we have the lowest form of clairvoyance, the seeing of the
etheric 
doubles of physical objects, and of things that have etheric bodies
as their 
lowest vesture. 
Man dwells, as we shall see, in various vehicles, physical, astral,
and mental 
and it is important to know and remember that as we are evolving
upwards, the 
lowest of the vehicles, the dense physical, is that which
consciousness first 
controls and rationalises. The physical brain is the instrument of
consciousness 
in waking life on the physical plane, and consciousness works in it
– in the 
undeveloped man – more effectively than in any other vehicle. Its
potentialities 
are less than those of the subtler vehicles, but its actualities
are greater, 
and the man knows himself as " I " in the physical body
ere he finds himself 
elsewhere. Even if he be more highly developed than the average
man, he can only 
show as much of himself down here as the physical organism permits,
for 
consciousness can manifest on the physical plane only so much as
the physical 
vehicle can carry. 
The dense and etheric bodies are not normally separated during
earth life; they 
normally function together, as the lower and higher strings of a
single 
instrument when a chord is struck, but they also carry on separate
though 
coordinated activities. Under conditions of weak health or nervous
excitement 
the etheric double may in great part be abnormally extruded from
its dense 
counterpart ; the latter then becomes very dully conscious , or
entranced, 
according to the less or greater amount of the etheric matter
extruded. 
Anesthetics drive out the greater part of the etheric double, so
that 
consciousness cannot affect or be affected by the dense body, its
bridge of 
communication being broken. In the abnormally organised person
called mediums, 
dislocation of the etheric and dense bodies easily occurs, and the
etheric 
double, when extruded, largely supplies the physical basis for 
"materialisations." 
In sleep, when the consciousness leaves the physical vehicle which
it uses 
during waking life, the dense and etheric bodies remain together,
but in the 
physical dream life they function to some extent independently.
Impressions 
experienced during waking life are reproduced by the automatic
action of the 
body, and both the physical and etheric brains are filled with
disjointed 
fragmentary pictures, the vibrations as it were, jostling each
other, and 
causing the most grotesque combinations. Vibrations from outside
also affect 
both, and combinations often set up during waking life are easily
called into 
activity by currents from the astral world of like nature with
themselves. The 
purity or impurity of waking thoughts will largely govern the
pictures arising 
in dreams, whether spontaneously set up or induced from without. 
At what is called death, the etheric double is drawn away from its
dense 
counterpart by the escaping consciousness ; the magnetic tie
existing between 
them during life earth life is snapped asunder, and for some hours
the 
consciousness remains enveloped in this etheric garb. In this it
sometimes 
appears to those with whom it is closely bound up, as a cloudy
figure, very 
dully conscious and speechless – the wraith. It may also be seen,
after the 
conscious entity has deserted it, floating over the grave where its
dense 
counterpart is buried, slowly disintegrating as time goes on. 
When the time comes for rebirth, the etheric double is built in
advance of the 
dense body, the latter exactly following it in its ante-natal
development. These 
bodies may be said to trace the limitations within which the
conscious entity 
will have to live and work during his life, a subject that will be
more fully 
explained in Chapter IX on Karma. 
THE ASTRAL PLANE
The astral plane is the region of the universe next to the
physical, if the word 
"next" may be permitted in such a connection. Life there
is more active than on 
the physical plane, and form is more plastic. The spirit-matter of
that plane is 
more highly vitalised and finer than any grade of spirit-matter in
the physical 
world. For , as we have seen, the ultimate physical atom, the
constituent of the 
rarest physical ether, has for its sphere-wall innumerable
aggregations of the 
coarsest astral matter. The word "next" is, however,
inappropriate, as 
suggesting the idea that the planes of the universe are arranged as
concentric 
circles, one ending where the next begins. Rather they are
concentric 
interpenetrating spheres, not separated from each other by distance
but by 
difference of constitution. As air permeates water, as ether
permeates the 
densest solid, so does astral matter permeate all physical. The
astral world is 
above us, below us, on every side of us, through us; we live and
move in it, but 
it is intangible, invisible, inaudible, imperceptible, because the
prison of the 
physical body shuts us away from it, the physical particles being
too gross to 
be set in vibration by astral matter. 
In this chapter we shall study the plane in its general aspects,
leaving on one 
side for separate consideration those special conditions of life on
the astral 
plane surrounding the human entities who are passing through it on
their way 
from earth to heaven. ( Devachan, the happy or bright state, is the
Theosophical 
name for heaven. Kâmaloka, the place of desire, is the name given
to the 
conditions of intermediate life on the astral plane). 
The spirit-matter of the astral plane exists in seven subdivisions,
as we have 
seen in the spirit-matter of the physical. There, as here, there
are numberless 
combinations, forming the astral solids, liquids, gases, and
ethers. But most 
material forms there have a brightness, a translucency, as compared
to forms 
here, which have caused the epithet astral, or starry, to be
applied to them – 
an epithet which is, on the whole, misleading, but is too firmly
established by 
use to be changed. As there are no specific names for the
subdivisions of astral 
spirit-matter, we may use the terrestrial designations. The main
idea to be 
grasped is that astral objects are combinations of astral matter,
as physical 
objects are combinations of physical matter, and that the astral
world scenery 
much resembles that of earth in consequence of its being largely
made up of the 
astral duplicates of physical objects. 
One peculiarity, however, arrests and confuses the untrained
observer; partly 
because of the translucency of astral objects, and partly because
of the nature 
of astral vision – consciousness being less hampered by the finer
astral matter 
than when encased in the terrestrial – everything is transparent,
its back is 
visible as its front, its inside as its outside. Some experience is
needed, 
therefore, ere objects are correctly seen, and a person who has
developed astral 
vision, but has not yet had much experience in its use, is apt to
receive the 
most topsy-turvy impressions and to fall into the most astounding
blunders. 
Another striking and at first bewildering characteristic of the
astral world is 
the swiftness with which forms – especially when unconnected with
any 
terrestrial matrix – change their outlines. 
An astral entity will change his whole appearance with the most
startling 
rapidity, for astral matter takes the form under every impulse of
thought, the 
life swiftly remoulding the form to give itself new expression. As
the great 
life-wave of the evolution of form passed downwards through the
astral plane, 
and constituted on that plane the third elemental kingdom, the
Monad drew round 
itself combinations of astral matter, giving to these combinations
– entitled 
elemental essence – a peculiar vitality and the characteristic of
responding to, 
and instantly taking shape under, the impulse of thought
vibrations. 
This elemental essence exists in hundreds of varieties on every
subdivision of 
the astral plane, as though the air became visible here – as indeed
it may seen 
in quivering waves under great heat – and were in constant
undulatory motion 
with changing colours like mother-of-pearl. 
This vast atmosphere of elemental essence is ever answering to
vibrations caused 
by thoughts, feelings, and desires, and is thrown into commotion by
a rush of 
any of these like bubbles in boiling water. ( C.W. Leadbeater,
Astral Plane, p. 
52). The duration of the form depends on the strength of the
impulse to which it 
owes its birth ; the clearness of its outline depends on the
precision of the 
thinking, and the colour depends on the quality – intellectual,
devotional, 
passional – of the thought. 
The vague loose thoughts which are so largely produced by undeveloped
minds 
gather round themselves loose clouds of elemental essence when they
arrive in 
the astral world, and drift about, attracted hither and thither to
other clouds 
of similar nature, clinging round the astral bodies of persons
whose magnetism 
attracts them – either good or evil – and after a while
disintegrating, to again 
form a part of the general atmosphere of elemental essence. While
they maintain 
a separate existence they are living entities, with bodies of
elemental essence 
and thoughts as the ensouling lives, and they are then called
artificial 
elementals, or thought-forms. 
Clear, precise thoughts have each their own definite shapes, with
sharp clean 
outlines, and show an endless variety of designs. They are shaped
by vibrations 
set up by thought, just as on the physical plane we find figures
which are 
shaped by vibrations set up by sound. "Voice-figures"
offer a very fair analogy 
for "thought-figures," for nature, with all her infinite
variety, is very 
conservative of principles, and reproduces the same methods of
working on plane 
after plane in her realms. 
These clearly defined artificial elementals have a longer and much
more active 
life than their cloudy brethren, exercising a far stronger
influence on the 
astral bodies (and through them on the minds) of those to whom they
are 
attracted. They set up in them vibrations similar to their own, and
thus 
thoughts spread from mind to mind without terrestrial expression.
More than 
this: they can be directed by the thinker towards any person he
desires to 
reach, their potency depending on the strength of his will and the
intensity of 
his mental power. 
Among average people the artificial elementals created by feeling
or desire are 
more vigorous and more definite than those created by thought. Thus
an outburst 
of anger will cause a very definitely outlined and powerful flash
of red, and 
sustained anger will make a dangerous elemental, red in colour, and
pointed, 
barbed, or otherwise qualified to injure. Love, according to its
quality, will 
set up forms more or less beautiful in colour and design, all
shades of crimson 
to the most exquisite and soft hues of rose, like the palest
blushes of sunset 
or the dawn, clouds of tenderly strong protective shapes. Many a
Mother’s loving 
prayers go to hover round her son as angel-forms, turning aside
from him evil 
influences that perchance his own thoughts are attracting. 
It is characteristic of these artificial elementals, when they are
directed by 
the will towards any particular person, that they are animated by
the one 
impulse of carrying out the will of their creator. A protective
elemental will 
hover round its object, seeking any opportunity of warding off evil
or 
attracting good – not consciously, but by a blind impulse, as
finding there the 
line of least resistance. 
So, also, an elemental ensouled by a malignant thought will hover
round its 
victim seeking opportunity to injure. But neither the one nor the
other can make 
any impression unless there be in the astral body of the object
something skin 
to themselves, something that can answer accordingly to their
vibrations, and 
thus enable them to attach themselves. If there be nothing in him
of matter 
cognate to their own, then by a law of their nature they rebound
from him along 
the path they pursued in going to him – the magnetic trace they
have left – and 
rush to their creator with a force proportionate to that of their
projection. 
Thus a thought of deadly hatred, failing to strike the object at
which it was 
darted, has been known to slay its sender, while good thoughts sent
to the 
unworthy return as blessings to him that poured them forth. 
A very slight understanding of the astral world will thus act as a
most powerful 
stimulus to right thinking, and will render heavy the sense of
responsibility in 
regard to the thoughts and feelings, and desires that we let loose
into this 
astral realm. Ravening beasts of prey, rending and devouring, are
too many of 
the thoughts with which men people the astral plane. But they err
from 
ignorance, they know not what they do. One of the objects of
theosophical 
teaching, partly lifting up the veil of the unseen world, is to
give men a 
sounder basis for conduct, a more rational appreciation of the
causes of which 
the effects only are seen in the terrestrial world. 
A few of its doctrines are more important in their ethical bearing
than this of 
the creation and direction of thought-forms, or artificial
elementals, for 
through it man learns that his mind does not concern himself alone,
that his 
thoughts do not affect himself alone, but that he is ever sending
out angels and 
devils into the world of men, for whose creation he is responsible,
and for 
whose influences he is held accountable. Let men, then, know the
law, and guide 
their thoughts thereby. 
If, instead of taking artificial elementals separately, we take
them in the 
mass, it is easy to realise the tremendous effect they have in
producing 
national and race feelings, and thus in biasing and prejudicing the
mind. We all 
grow up surrounded by an atmosphere crowded with elementals
embodying certain 
ideas ; national prejudices, national ways of looking at all
questions, national 
types of feelings and thoughts, all these play on us from our
birth, aye, and 
before. We see everything through this atmosphere, every thought is
more or less 
refracted by it, and our own astral bodies are vibrating in accord
with it. 
Hence the same idea will look quite different to the Hindu, an
Englishman, a 
Spaniard, and a Russian ; some conceptions easy to the one will be
almost 
impossible to the other, customs instinctively attractive to the
one are 
instinctively odious to the other. We are all dominated by our
national 
atmosphere, i.e., by that portion of the astral world immediately
surrounding 
us. 
The thoughts of others, cast much in the same mould, play upon us
and call out 
from us synchronous vibrations ; they intensify the points in which
we accord 
with our surroundings and flatten away the differences, and this
ceaseless 
action upon us through the astral body impresses on us the national
half-mark 
and traces channels for mental energies into which they readily
flow. Sleeping 
and waking , these currents play upon us, and our very
unconsciousness of their 
action makes it the more effective. As most people are receptive
rather than 
initiative in their nature, they act almost as automatic
reproducers of the 
thoughts which reach them, and thus the national atmosphere is
continually 
intensified. 
When a person is beginning to be sensitive to astral influences, he
will 
occasionally find himself suddenly overpowered or assailed by a
quite 
inexplicable and seemingly irrational dread, which swoops upon him
with even 
paralysing force. Fight against it as he may, he yet feels it, and
perhaps 
resents it. Probably there are few who have not experienced this
fear to some 
extent, the uneasy dread of an invisible something, the feeling of
a presence, 
of "not being alone." This arises partly from a certain
hostility which animates 
the natural elemental world against the human, on account of the
various 
destructive agencies devised by mankind on the physical plane and
reacting on 
the astral, but is also largely due to the presence of so many
artificial 
elementals of an unfriendly kind, bred by human minds. 
Thoughts of hatred, jealousy, revenge, bitterness, suspicion,
discontent, go out 
by millions crowding the astral plane with artificial elementals
whose whole 
life is made of these feelings. How much also is there of vague
distrust and 
suspicion poured out by the ignorant against all whose ways and
appearance are 
alien and unfamiliar. The blind distrust of all foreigners, the
surly contempt, 
extending in many districts even towards inhabitants of another
country – these 
things also contribute evil influences to the astral world. There
being so much 
of these things among us, we create a blindly hostile army on the
astral plane, 
and this is answered in our own astral bodies by a feeling of
dread, set up by 
the antagonistic vibrations that are sensed, but not understood. 
Outside the class of artificial elementals, the astral world is
thickly 
populated, even excluding, as we do for the present, all the human
entities who 
have lost their physical bodies by death. There are great hosts of
natural 
elementals, or nature-spirits, divided into five main classes –the
elementals of 
the ether, the fire, the air, the water, and the earth ; the last
four groups 
have been termed, in mediaeval occultism, the Salamanders, Sylphs,
Undines, and 
Gnomes (needless to say there are two other classes, completing the
seven, not 
concerning us here, as they are still unmanifested). 
These are the true elementals, or creatures of the elements, earth,
water, air, 
fire and ether, and they are severally concerned in the carrying on
of the 
activities connected with their own element ; they are the channels
through 
which work the divine energies in these several fields, the living
expressions 
of the law in each. At the head of each division is a great Being,
the captain 
of the mighty host, (Called a Deva, or God, by the Hindus. The
student may like 
to have the Sanskrit names of the five Gods of the manifested
elements ; Indra, 
lord of the Akâsha, or ether of space ; Agni, lord of fire ;
Pavana, lord of 
air, Varuna, lord of water ; Kshiti, lord of the earth). the
directing and 
guiding intelligence of the whole department of nature which is
administered and 
energised by the class of elementals under his control. 
Thus Agni the fire-God, is a great spiritual entity concerned with
the 
manifestation of fire on all planes of the universe, and carries on
his 
administration through the host of the fire-elementals. By
understanding the 
nature of these, or knowing the methods of their control, the
so-called miracles 
of magical feats are worked, which from time to time are recorded
in the public 
press, whether they are avowedly the results of magical arts, or
are done by the 
aid of "spirits" – as in the case of the late Mr. Home,
who could unconcernedly 
pick a red-hot coal out of a blazing fire with his fingers and hold
it in his 
hand unhurt. Levitation (the suspension of a heavy body in the air
without 
visible support) and walking on the water have been done by the aid
respectively 
of the elementals of the air and the water, although another method
is more 
often employed. 
As the elements enter into the human body, one or another
predominating 
according to the nature of the person, each human being has
relations with these 
elementals, the most friendly to him being those whose element is
preponderant 
in him. The effects of this fact are often noted, and are popularly
ascribed to 
"luck". A person has " a lucky hand" in making
plants grow, in lighting fires, 
in finding underground water, etc. Nature is ever jostling us with
her occult 
forces, but we are slow to take her hints. Tradition sometimes
hides a truth in 
a proverb or a fable, but we have grown beyond all such
"superstitions." 
We find also on the astral plane, nature-spirits – less accurately
termed 
elementals – who are concerned with the building of forms in the
mineral, 
vegetable, animal, and human kingdoms. There are nature-spirits who
build up 
minerals, who guide the vital energies in plants, and who molecule
by molecule 
form the bodies of the animal kingdom ; they are concerned with the
making of 
the astral bodies of minerals, plants, and animals, as well as with
that of the 
physical. 
These are the fairies and elves of legends, the "little
people" who play so 
large a part in the folk lore of every nation, the charming
irresponsible 
children of nature, whom science had coldly relegated to the
nursery, but who 
will be replaced in their own grade of natural order by the wiser
scientists of 
a later day. Only poets and occultists believe in them just now,
poets by the 
intuition of their genius, occultists by the vision of their
trained inner 
senses. The multitude laugh at both, most of all at the occultists
; but it 
matter not – wisdom shall be justified of her children. 
The play of the life-currents in the etheric doubles of the forms
in the 
mineral, vegetable, and animal kingdoms, awoke out of latency the
astral matter 
involved in the structure of their atomic and molecular
constituents. It began 
to thrill in a very limited way in the minerals, and the Monad of
form, 
exercising his organising power, drew in materials from the astral
world, and 
these were built by the nature-spirits into a loosely constituted
mass, the 
mineral astral body. 
In the vegetable world the astral bodies are a little more
organised, and their 
special characteristic of "feeling" begins to appear.
Dull and diffused 
sensations of well-being and discomfort are observable in most
plants as the 
results of the increasing activity of the astral body. They dimly
enjoy the air, 
the rain, and the sunshine, and gropingly seek them, while they
shrink from 
noxious conditions. Some seek the light and some seek the darkness
; they answer 
to stimuli, and adapt themselves to external conditions, some
showing plainly a 
sense of touch. In the animal kingdom the astral body is more
developed, 
reaching in the higher members of that kingdom a sufficiently
definite 
organisation to cohere for some time after the death of the
physical body, and 
to lead an independent existence on the astral plane. 
The nature-spirits concerned with the building of the animal and
human astral 
bodies have been given the special name of desire-elementals,
(Kâmadevas, they 
are called "desire-gods") because they are strongly
animated by desires of all 
kinds, and constantly build themselves into the astral bodies of
animals and 
men. 
They also use the varieties of elemental essence similar to that of
which their 
own bodies are composed to construct the astral bodies of animals,
those bodies 
thus acquiring, as interwoven parts, the centres of sensation and
of the various 
passional activities. These centres are stimulated into functioning
by impulses 
received by the dense physical organs, and transmitted by the
etheric physical 
organs to the astral body. 
Not until the astral centre is reached does the animal feel
pleasure or pain. A 
stone may be struck, but it will feel no pain ; it has dense and
etheric 
physical molecules, but its astral body is unorganised ; the animal
feels pain 
from a blow because he possesses the astral centres of sensation,
and the 
desire-elementals have woven into him their own nature. 
As a new consideration enters into the work of these elementals
with the human 
astral body, we will finish our survey of the inhabitants of the
astral plane 
ere studying this more complicated astral form. 
The desire-bodies, (Kâmarûpa is the technical name for the astral
body, from 
Kâma, desire, and rûpa, form) or astral bodies, of animals are
found, as has 
just been stated, to lead an independent though fleeting existence
on the astral 
plane after death has destroyed their physical counterparts. In
"civilised" 
countries these animal astral bodies add much to the general
feeling of 
hostility which was spoken of above, for the organised butchery of
animals in 
slaughterhouses and by sport sends millions of these annually into
the astral 
world, full of horror, terror, and shrinking from men. 
The comparatively few creatures that are allowed to die in peace
and quietness 
are lost in the vast hordes of the murdered, and from the currents
set up by 
these there rain down influences from the astral world on the human
and animal 
races which drive them yet further apart and engender
"instinctive" distrust and 
fear on the one side and lust of inflicting cruelty on the other. 
These feelings have been much intensified of late years by the
coldly devised 
methods of the scientific torture called vivisection, the
unmentionable 
barbarities of which have introduced new horrors into the astral
world by their 
reaction on the culprits, (See Chapter III, on "Kâmaloka
.") as well as having 
increased the gulf between man and his "poor relations". 
Apart from what we may call the normal population of the astral
world, there are 
passing travellers in it, led there by their work, whom we cannot
leave entirely 
without mention. Some of these come from our own terrestrial world,
while others 
are visitors from loftier regions. 
Of the former, many are Initiates of various grades, some belonging
to the Great 
White Lodge – the Himâlayan or Tibetan Brotherhood, as it is often
called (It is 
to some members of this Lodge that the Theosophical Society owes
its inception) 
– while others are members of different occult lodges throughout
the world, 
ranging from white through shades of grey to black. ( Occultists
who are 
unselfish and wholly devoted to the carrying out of the Divine
Will, or who are 
aiming to attain these virtues, are called "white". Those
who are selfish and 
are working against the Divine purpose in the universe are called
"black." 
Expanding selflessness, love and devotion are the marks of the one
class: 
contracting selfishness, hatred, and harsh arrogance are the sign
of the other. 
Between these are the classes whose motives are mixed, and who have
not yet 
realised that they must evolve towards the One Self or towards
separated selves 
; these I have called grey. Their members gradually drift into, or
deliberately 
join, one of the two great groups with clearly marked aims). 
All these are men living in physical bodies, who have learned to
leave the 
physical encasement at will, and to function in full consciousness
in the astral 
body. They are of all grades of knowledge and virtue, beneficent
and maleficent, 
strong and weak, gentle and ferocieous. There are also many younger
aspirants, 
still uninitiated, who are learning to use the astral vehicle, and
who are 
employed in works of benevolence or malevolence according to the
path they are 
seeking to tread. 
After these, we have psychics of varying degrees of development,
some fairly 
alert, others dreamy and confused, wandering about while their
physical bodies 
are asleep or entranced. Unconscious of their external
surroundings, wrapped in 
their own thoughts, drawn as it were within their astral shell, are
millions of 
drifting astral bodies inhabited by conscious entities, whose
physical frames 
are sunk in sleep. 
As we shall see presently, the consciousness in its astral vehicle
escapes when 
the body sinks into sleep, and passes on to the astral plane ; but
it is not 
conscious of its surroundings until the astral body is sufficiently
developed to 
function independently of the physical. 
Occasionally is seen on this plane a disciple (A Chelâ, the
accepted pupil of an 
Adept), who has passed through death and is awaiting an almost
immediate 
reincarnation under the direction of his Master. He is, of course,
in the 
enjoyment of full consciousness, and is working like other
disciples who have 
merely slipped off their bodies in sleep. A certain stage (See
chapter XI, on 
"Man’s Ascent") – a disciple is allowed to reincarnate
very quickly after death, 
and under these circumstances he has to await on the astral plane a
suitable 
opportunity for rebirth. 
Passing through the astral plane also are the human beings who are
on their way 
to reincarnation ; they will again be mentioned later on (See
chapter VII, on 
"Reincarnation".) and they concern themselves in no way
with the general life of 
the astral world. The desire-elementals, however, who have affinity
with them 
from their past passional and sensational activities, gather round
them, 
assisting in the building of the new astral body for the coming
earth-life. 
We must now turn to the consideration of the human astral body
during the period 
of existence in this world, and study its nature and constitution
as well as its 
relations with the astral realm. We will take the astral body of
(a) an 
undeveloped man, (b) an average man, and (c) a spiritually
developed man. 
(a) An undeveloped man’s astral body is a cloudy, loosely organised,
vaguely 
outlined mass of astral spirit-matter, containing materials – both
astral matter 
and elemental essence – drawn from all the subdivisions of the
astral plane, but 
with a predominance of substances from the lower, so that it is
dense and coarse 
in texture, fit to respond to all the stimuli connected with the
passions and 
appetites. The colours caused by the rates of vibration are dull,
muddy, and 
dusky – brown, dull reds, dirty greens, are predominant hues. There
is no play 
of light or quickly changing flashing of colours through this
astral body, but 
the various passions show themselves as heavy surges, or, when
violent, as 
flashes ; thus sexual passion will send a wave of muddy crimson,
rage a flash of 
lurid red. 
The astral body is larger than the physical, extending round it in
all 
directions ten to twelve inches in such a case as we are
considering. The 
centres of the organs of sense are definitely marked, and are
active when worked 
on from without ; but in quiescence the life-streams are sluggish,
and the 
astral body, stimulated neither from the physical nor mental
worlds, is drowsy 
and indifferent. ( the student will recognise here the predominance
of the 
tâmasic guna, the quality of darkness or inertness in nature.) 
It is a constant characteristic of the undeveloped state that
activity is 
prompted from without rather from the inner consciousness . A stone
to be moved 
must be pushed ; a plant moves under the attractions of light and
moisture ; an 
animal becomes active when stirred by hunger: a poorly developed
man needs to be 
prompted in similar ways. Not till the mind is partly grown does it
begin to 
initiate action. The centres of higher activities, ( The seven
Chakras, or 
wheels, so named from the whirling appearance they present, like
wheels of 
living fire when in activity.) related to the independent
functioning of the 
astral senses, are scarcely visible. A man at this stage requires
for his 
evolution violent sensations of every kind, to arouse the nature
and stimulate 
it into activity. Heavy blows from the outer world, both of
pleasure and pain, 
are wanted to awaken and spur to action. 
The more numerous and violent the sensations, the more he can be
made to feel, 
the better for his growth. At this stage quality matters little,
quantity and 
vigour are the main requisites. The beginnings of this man’s
morality will be in 
his passions ; a slight impulse of unselfishness in his relations
to wife and 
child or friend, will be the first step upwards, by causing
vibrations in the 
finer matter of his astral body and attracting into it more
elemental essence of 
an appropriate kind. The astral body is constantly changing its
materials under 
this play of the passions, appetites, desires, and emotions. 
All good ones strengthen the finer parts of the body, shake out
some of the 
coarser constituents, draw into it the subtler materials, and
attract round it 
elementals of a beneficent kind who aid in the renovating process.
All evil ones 
have diametrically opposite effects, strengthening the coarser,
expelling the 
finer, drawing in more of the former, and attracting elementals who
help in the 
deteriorating process. 
The man’s moral and intellectual powers are so embryonic in the
case we are 
considering that most of the building and changing of his astral
body may be 
said to be done for him rather than by him. It depends more on his
external 
circumstances than on his own will, for, as just said, it is
characteristic of a 
low stage of development that a man is moved from without and
through the body 
much more than from within and by the mind. It is a sign of
considerable advance 
when a man begins to be moved by the will, by his own energy,
self-determined, 
instead of being moved by desire, i.e., by a response to an
external attraction 
or repulsion. 
In sleep the astral body, enveloping the consciousness, slips out
of the 
physical vehicle, leaving the dense and etheric bodies to slumber.
At this 
stage, however, the consciousness is not awake in the astral body,
lacking the 
strong contacts that spur it while in the physical frame, and the
only things 
that affect the astral body may be elementals of the coarser kinds,
that may set 
up therein vibrations which are reflected to the etheric and dense
brains, and 
induce dreams of animal pleasures. The astral body floats just over
the 
physical, held by its strong attraction, and cannot go far away
from it. 
(b) In the average moral and intellectual man the astral body shows
an immense 
advance on that just described. It is larger in size, its materials
are more 
balanced in quality, the presence of the rarer kinds giving a
certain luminous 
quality to the whole, while the expression of the higher emotions
sends playing 
through it beautiful ripples of colour. Its outline is clear and
definite, 
instead of vague and shifting, as in the former case, and it
assumes the 
likeness of its owner. It is obviously becoming a vehicle for the
inner man, 
with good definite organisation and stability, a body fit and ready
to function, 
and able to maintain itself, apart from the physical. While
retaining great 
plasticity, it yet has a normal form, to which it continuously
recurs when any 
pressure is removed that may have caused it to change its outline. 
Its activity is constant, and hence it is in perpetual vibration,
showing 
endless varieties of changing hues ; also the "wheels"
are clearly visible 
though not yet functioning ( Here the student will note the
predominance of the 
râjasic guna, the quality of activity in nature.) It responds
quickly to all the 
contacts coming to it through the physical body, and is stirred by
the 
influences rained on it from the conscious entity within, memory
and imagination 
stimulating it to action, and causing it to become the prompter of
the body to 
activity instead of only being moved by it. 
Its purification proceeds along the same lines as in the former
case – the 
expulsion of lower constituents by setting up vibrations
antagonistic to them 
and the drawing in of finer materials in their place. But now the
increased 
moral intellectual development of the man puts the building almost
entirely 
under his own control, for he is no longer driven here and there by
stimuli from 
external nature, but reasons, judges, and resists or yields as he
thinks well. 
By the exercise of well-directed thought he can rapidly affect the
astral body, 
and hence its improvement can proceed apace. Nor is it necessary
that he should 
understand the modus operandi in order to bring about the effect,
any more than 
that a man should understand the laws of light in order to see. 
In sleep, this well-developed astral body slips, as usual, from its
physical 
encasement, but is by no means held captive by it, as in the former
case. It 
roams about in the astral world, drifted hither and thither by the
astral 
currents, while the consciousness within it, not yet able to direct
its 
movements, is awake, engaged in the enjoyment of its own mental
images and 
mental activities, and able also to receive impressions through its
astral 
covering, and to change them into mental pictures. In this way a
man may gain 
knowledge when out of the body, and may subsequently impress it on
the brain as 
a vivid dream or vision, or without this link of memory it may
filter through 
into the brain-consciousness. 
(c) The astral body of a spiritually developed man is composed of
the finest 
particles of each subdivision of astral matter, the higher kinds
largely 
predominating in amount. It is therefore a beautiful object in
luminosity and 
colour, hues not known on earth showing themselves under the
impulses thrown 
into it by the purified mind. The wheels of fire are now seen to
deserve their 
names, and their whirling motion denotes the activity of the higher
senses. Such 
a body is, in the full sense of the words, a vehicle of
consciousness, for in 
the course of evolution it has been vivified in every organ and
brought under 
the complete control of its owner. 
When in it he leaves the physical body there is no break in
consciousness ; he 
merely shakes off his heavier vesture, and finds himself
unencumbered by its 
weight. He can move anywhere within the astral sphere with immense
rapidity, and 
is no longer bound by the narrow terrestrial conditions. His body
answers to his 
will, reflects and obeys his thought. His opportunities for serving
humanity are 
thus enormously increased, and his powers are directed by his
virtue and his 
beneficence. The absence of gross particles in his astral body
renders it 
incapable of responding to the promptings of lower objects of
desire, and they 
turn away from him as beyond their attraction. The whole body
vibrates only in 
answer to the higher emotions, his love has grown into devotion,
his energy is 
curbed by patience. 
Gentle, calm, serene, full of power, but with no trace of
restlessness, such a 
man "all the Siddhis stand ready to serve." (Here the
sâttvic guna, the quality 
of bliss and purity in nature, is predominant. Siddhis are
superphysical 
powers.) 
The astral body forms the bridge over the gulf which separates
consciousness 
from the physical brain. Impacts received by the sense organs and
transmitted, 
as we have seen, to the dense and etheric centres, pass thence to
the 
corresponding astral centres ; here they are worked on by the
elemental essence 
and are transmuted into feelings , and are then presented to the
inner man as 
objects of consciousness, the astral vibrations awakening
corresponding 
vibrations in the materials of the mental body. (See chapter IV, on
"The Mental 
Plane.") 
By these successive gradations in fineness of spirit-matter the
heavy impacts of 
terrestrial objects can be transmitted to the conscious entity ;
and, in turn, 
the vibrations set up by his thoughts can pass along the same
bridge to the 
physical brain and there induce physical vibrations corresponding
to the mental. 
This is the regular normal way in which consciousness receives
impressions from 
without, and in turn sends impressions outwards. By this constant
passage of 
vibrations to and fro the astral body is chiefly developed ; the
current plays 
upon it from within and from without, it evolves its organisation,
and subserves 
its general growth. 
By this it becomes larger, finer in texture, more definitely
outlined, and more 
organised interiorly. Trained thus to respond to consciousness, it
gradually 
becomes fit to function as its separate vehicle, and to transmit to
it clearly 
the vibrations received directly from the astral world. Most
readers will have 
had some little experience of impressions coming into consciousness
from 
without, that do not arise from any physical impact, and that are
very quickly 
verified by some external occurrence. 
These are frequently impressions that reach the astral body
directly, and are 
transmitted by it to the consciousness, and such impressions are
often of the 
nature of previsions which very quickly prove themselves to be
true. When the 
man is far progressed, though the stage varies much according to
other 
circumstances, links are set up between the physical and the
astral, the astral 
and mental, so that consciousness works unbrokenly from one state
to the other, 
memory having in it none of the lapses which in the ordinary man
interpose a 
period of unconsciousness in passing from one plane to another. The
man can then 
also freely exercise the astral senses while the consciousness is
working in the 
physical body, so that these enlarged avenues of knowledge become
an appanage of 
his waking consciousness. Objects which were before matters of
faith becomes 
matters of knowledge, and he can personally verify the accuracy of
much of the 
Theosophical teaching as to the lower regions of the invisible
world. 
When man is analysed into "principles," i.e., into modes
of manifesting life, 
his four lower principles, termed the "lower Quaternary,"
are said to function 
on the astral and physical planes. The fourth principle is Kâma,
desire, and it 
is the life manifesting in the astral body and conditioned by it ;
it is 
characterised by the attribute of feeling, whether in the
rudimentary form of 
sensation, or in the complex form of emotion, or in any of the
grades that lie 
between. This is summed up as desire, that which is attracted or
repelled by 
objects, according as they give pleasure or pain to the personal
self. 
The third principle is Prâna, the life specialised for the support
of the 
physical organism. The second principle is the etheric double, and
the first is 
the dense body. These three function on the physical plane. In
H.P.Blavatsky’s 
later classifications she removed both Prâna and the dense physical
body from 
the rank of principles, Prâna as being universal life, and the
dense physical 
body as being the mere counterpart of the etheric, and made of
constantly 
changing materials built into the etheric matrix. Taking this view,
we have the 
grand philosophic conception of the One Life, the One Self,
manifesting as man, 
and presenting varying and transitory differences according to the
conditions 
imposed on it by the bodies which it vivifies; itself remaining the
same in the 
centre, but showing different aspects when looked at from outside,
according to 
the kinds of matter in one body or another. 
In the physical body it is Prâna, energising, controlling,
co-ordinating. In the 
astral body it is Kâma, feeling, enjoying, suffering. We shall find
it in yet 
other aspects, as we pass to higher planes, but the fundamental
idea is the same 
throughout, and it is another of those root-ideas of Theosophy,
which firmly 
grasped, serve as guiding clues in this most tangled world. 
KÂMALOKA
KÂMALOKA, literally the place or habitat of desire, is, as has
already been 
intimated, a part of the astral plane, not divided from it as a
distinct 
locality, but separated off by the conditions of consciousness of
the entities 
belonging to it. (The Hindus call this state Pretaloka, the habitat
of Pretas. A 
Preta is a human being who has lost his physical body, but is still
encumbered 
with the vesture of his animal nature. He cannot carry this on with
him, and 
until it is disintegrated he is kept imprisoned by it.) 
These are human beings who have lost their physical bodies by the
stroke of 
death, and have to undergo certain purifying changes before they
can pass on to 
the happy and peaceful life which belongs to the man proper, to the
human soul. 
(The soul is the human intellect, the link between the Divine
Spirit in man and 
his lower personality. It is the Ego, the individual, the " I
", which develops 
by evolution. In Theosophical parlance, it is Manas, the Thinker.
The mind is 
the energy of this, working within the limitations of the physical
brain, or the 
astral and mental bodies). 
This region represents and includes the conditions described as
existing in the 
various hells, purgatories, and intermediate states, one or other
of which is 
alleged by all the great religions to be the temporary
dwelling-place of man 
after he leaves the body and before he reaches "heaven."
It does not include any 
place of eternal torture, the endless hell still believed in by
some narrow 
religionists being only a nightmare dream of ignorance, hate and
fear. But it 
does include conditions of suffering, temporary and purificatory in
their 
nature, the working out of causes set going in his earth-life by
the man who 
experiences them. These are as natural and inevitable as any
effects caused in 
this world by wrongdoing, for we live in a world of law and every
seed must grow 
up after its own kind. Death makes no sort of difference in a man’s
moral and 
mental nature, and the change of state caused by passing from one
world to 
another takes away his physical body, but leaves the man as he was.
The Kâmalokic condition is found on each subdivision of the astral
plane, so 
that we may speak of it as having seven regions, calling them the
first, second, 
third, up to the seventh, beginning from the lowest and counting
upwards. (Often 
these regions are reckoned the other way, taking the first as the
highest and 
the seventh as the lowest. It does not matter from which end we
count ; and I am 
reckoning upwards to keep them in accord with the planes and
principles.). 
We have already seen that materials from each subdivision of the
astral plane 
enter into the composition of the astral body, and it is a peculiar
rearrangement of these materials, to be explained in a moment,
which separates 
the people dwelling in one region from those dwelling in another,
although those 
in the same region are able to intercommunicate. The regions, being
each a 
subdivision of the astral plane, differ in density, and the density
of the 
external form of the Kâmalokic entity determines the region to
which he is 
limited ; these differences of matter are the barriers that prevent
passage from 
one region to another ; the people dwelling in one can no more come
into touch 
with people dwelling in another than a deep-sea fish can hold a
conversation 
with an eagle – the medium necessary to the life of the one would
be destructive 
to the life of the other. 
When the physical body is struck down by death, the etheric body,
carrying Prâna 
with it and accompanied by the remaining principles – that is, the
whole man, 
except the dense body – withdraws from the "tabernacle of
flesh," as the outer 
body is appropriately called. All the outgoing life-energies draw
themselves 
inwards, and are "gathered up by Prâna," their departure
being manifested by the 
dullness that creeps over the physical organs of the senses. 
They are there, uninjured, physically complete, ready to act as
they have always 
been ; but the "inner Ruler," is going, he who through
them saw, heard, felt, 
smelt, tasted, and by themselves they are mere aggregations of
matter, living 
indeed but without power of perceptive action. Slowly the lord of
the body draws 
himself away, enwrapped in the violet-grey etheric body, and
absorbed in the 
contemplation of the panorama of his past life, which in the death
hour rolls 
before him, complete in every detail. 
In that life-picture are all the events of his life, small and
great ; he sees 
his ambitions with their success or frustration, his efforts, his
triumphs, his 
failures, his loves, his hatreds ; the predominant tendency of the
whole comes 
clearly out, the ruling thought of the life asserts itself, and
stamps itself 
deeply into the soul, marking the region in which the chief part of
his 
post-mortem existence will be spent. 
Solemn the moment when the man stands face to face with his life,
and from the 
lips of his past hears the presage of his future. For a brief space
he sees 
himself as he is, recognises the purpose of life, knows that the
Law is strong 
and just and good. Then the magnetic tie breaks between the dense
and etheric 
bodies, the comrades of a lifetime are disjoined, and – save in
exceptional 
cases – the man sinks into peaceful unconsciousness. 
Quietness and devotion should mark the conduct of all who are
gathered round a 
dying body, in order that a solemn silence may leave uninterrupted
this review 
of the past by the departing man. Clamorous weeping, loud
lamentations, can but 
jar and disturb the concentrated attention of the soul, and to
break with the 
grief of a personal loss into the stillness which aids and soothes
him, is at 
once selfish and impertinent. Religion has wisely commanded prayers
for the 
dying, for these preserve calm and stimulate unselfish aspirations
directed to 
his helping, and these, like all loving thoughts, protect and
shield. 
Some hours after death – generally not more than thirty-six, it is
said – the 
man draws himself out of the etheric body, leaving it in turn as a
senseless 
corpse, and the latter, remaining near its dense counterpart,
shares its fate. 
If the dense body be buried, the etheric double floats over the
grave, slowly 
disintegrating, and the unpleasant feelings many experience in a
churchyard are 
largely due to the presence of these decaying etheric corpses. If
the body is 
burned, the etheric double breaks up quickly, having lost its
nidus, its 
physical centre of attraction, and this is one among many reasons
why cremation 
is preferable to burial, as a way of disposing of corpses. 
The withdrawal of the man from the etheric double is accompanied by
the 
withdrawal from it of Prâna, which thereupon returns to the great
reservoir of 
life universal, while the man, ready now to pass into Kâmaloka,
undergoes a 
rearrangement of his astral body, fitting it for submission to the
purificatory 
changes which are necessary for the freeing of the man himself.
(These changes 
result in the formation of what is called by Hindus the Yâtanâ, or
the suffering 
body, or in the case of very wicked men, in whose astral bodies
there is a 
preponderance of the coarser matter, the Dhruvam, or strong body). 
During earth life the various kinds of astral matter intermingle in
the 
formation of the body, as do the solids, liquids, gases, and ethers
in the 
physical. The change in the arrangement of the astral body after
death consists 
in the separation of these materials, according to their respective
densities, 
into a series of concentric shells – the finest within, the densest
without – 
each shell being made of the materials drawn from one subdivision
only of the 
astral plane. The astral body thus becomes a set of seven
superimposed layers, 
or a seven-shelled encasement of astral matter, in which the man
may not inaptly 
be said to be imprisoned, as only the breaking of these can set him
free. Now 
will be seen the immense importance of the purification of the
astral body 
during earth-life; the man is retained in each subdivision of
Kâmaloka so long 
as the shell of matter pertaining to that subdivision is not
sufficiently 
disintegrated to allow of his escape into the next. 
Moreover, the extent to which his consciousness has worked in each
kind of 
matter determines whether he will be awake and conscious in any
given region, or 
will pass though it in unconsciousness, "wrapped" in rosy
dreams," and merely 
detained during the time necessary for the process of mechanical
disintegration. 
A spiritually advanced man, who has so purified his astral body
that its 
constituents are drawn only from the finest grade of each division
of astral 
matter, merely passes through Kâmaloka without delay, the astral
body 
disintegrating with extreme swiftness, and he goes on to whatever
may be his 
bourne, according to the point he has reached in evolution. A less
developed 
man, but one whose life has been pure and temperate and who has sat
loosely on 
the things of the earth, will wing a less rapid flight through
Kâmaloka, but 
will dream peacefully, unconscious of his surroundings, as his
mental body 
disentangles itself from the astral shells, one after the other, to
awaken only 
when he reaches the heavenly places. 
Others, less developed still, will awaken after passing out of the
lower 
regions, becoming conscious in the division which is connected with
the active 
working of the consciousness during the earth-life, for this will
be aroused on 
receiving familiar impacts, although these be received now directly
through the 
astral body, without the help of the physical. Those who have lived
in the 
animal passions will awake in their appropriate region, each man
literally going 
"to his own place." 
The case of men struck suddenly out of physical life by accident,
suicide, 
murder, or sudden death in any form, differs from those of persons
who pass away 
by failure of the life-energies through disease or old age. If they
are pure and 
spiritually minded they are specially guarded, and sleep out
happily the term of 
their natural life. But in other cases they remain conscious –
often entangled 
in the final scene of earth-life for a time, and unaware that they
have lost the 
physical body – held in whatever region they are related to by the
outermost 
layer of the astral body: their normal Kâmalokic life does not
begin until the 
natural web of earth-life is out-spun, and they are vividly
conscious of both 
their astral and physical surroundings. 
One man who had committed an assassination and had been executed
for his crime 
was said, by one of H.P.Blavatsky’s Teachers, to be living through
the scenes of 
the murder and the subsequent events over and over again in
Kâmaloka, ever 
repeating his diabolical act and going through the terrors of his
arrest and 
execution. 
A suicide will repeat automatically the feelings of despair and
fear which 
preceded his self-murder, and go through the act and the
death-struggle time 
after time with ghastly persistence. A woman who perished in the
flames in a 
wild condition of terror and with frantic efforts to escape,
created such a 
whirls of passions that, five days afterwards, she was still
struggling 
desperately, fancying herself still in the fire and wildly
repulsing all efforts 
to soothe her: while another woman who, with her baby on her
breast, went down 
beneath the whirl of waters in a raging storm, with her heart calm
and full of 
love, slept peacefully on the other side of death, dreaming of
husband and 
children in happy lifelike visions. 
In more ordinary cases, death by accident is still a disadvantage,
brought on a 
person by some serious fault, (Not necessarily a fault committed in
the present 
life. The law of cause and effect will be explained in Chapter IX,
"Karma"), for 
the possession of full consciousness in the lower Kâmalokic
regions, which are 
closely related to the earth, is attended by many inconveniences
and perils. The 
man is full of all the plans and interests that made up his life,
and is 
conscious of the presence of people and things connected with them.
He is almost irresistibly impelled by his longings to try and
influence the 
affairs to which his passions and feelings still cling, and is
bound to the 
earth while he has lost all his accustomed organs of activity ; his
only hope of 
peace lies in resolutely turning away from earth and fixing his
mind on higher 
things, but comparatively few are strong enough to make this
effort, even with 
the help always offered them by workers on the astral plane, whose
sphere of 
duty lies in helping and guiding those who have left his world.
(These workers 
are disciples of some of the great Teachers who guide and help
humanity, and 
they are employed in this special duty of succouring souls in need
of such 
assistance.) 
Too often such sufferers impatient in their helpless inactivity,
seek the 
assistance of sensitives, with whom they can communicate and so mix
themselves 
up once more in terrestrial affairs ; they sometimes seek even to
obsess 
convenient mediums and thus to utilise the bodies of others for
their own 
purposes, so incurring many responsibilities in the future. Not
without occult 
reason have English churchmen been taught to pray: "From
battle, murder, and 
from sudden death, Good Lord, deliver us." 
We may now consider the divisions of Kâmaloka one by one, and so
gain some idea 
of the conditions which the man has made for himself in the
intermediate state 
by the desires which he has cultivated during physical life ; it
being kept in 
mind that the amount of vitality in any given "shell" –
and therefore his 
imprisonment in that shell – depends on the amount of energy thrown
during 
earth-life into the kind of matter of which that shell consists. 
If the lowest passions have been active, the coarsest matter will
be strongly 
vitalised and its amount will also be relatively large. This
principle rules 
through all Kâmalokic regions, so that a man during earth-life can
judge very 
fairly as to the future for himself that he is preparing
immediately on the 
other side of death. 
The first or lowest, division is the one that contains the
conditions described 
in so many Hindu and Buddhist Scriptures under the name of
"hells" of various 
kinds. It must be understood that a man, in passing into one of
these states, is 
not getting rid of the passions and vile desires that have led him
thither ; 
these remain, as part of his character, lying latent in the mind in
a germinal 
state, to be thrown outwards again to form his passional nature
when he is 
returning to birth in the physical world. (See chapter VII, on
"Reincarnation"). 
His presence in the lowest region of Kâmaloka is due to the
existence in his 
kâmic body of matter belonging to that region, and he is held
prisoner there 
until the greater part of that matter has dropped away, until the
shell composed 
of it is sufficiently disintegrated to allow the man to come into
contact with 
the region next above. 
The atmosphere of this place is gloomy, heavy, dreary, depressing
to an 
inconceivable extent. It seems to reek with all the influences most
inimical to 
good, as in truth it does, being caused by the persons whose evil
passions have 
led them to this dreary place. All the desires and feelings at
which we shudder, 
find here the materials for their expression ; it is, in fact, the
lowest slum, 
with all the horrors veiled from physical sight parading their
naked 
hideousness. Its repulsiveness is much increased by the fact that
in the astral 
world character expresses itself in form, and the man who is full
of evil 
passions looks the whole of them ; bestial appetites shape the
astral body into 
bestial forms, and repulsively human animal shapes are the
appropriate clothing 
of brutalised human souls. 
No man can be a hypocrite in the astral world, and cloak foul
thoughts with a 
veil of virtuous seeming ; whatever a man is that he appears to be
in outward 
form and semblance, radiant in beauty if his mind be noble,
repulsive in 
hideousness if his nature be foul. It will readily be understood,
then, how such 
Teachers as the Buddha – to whose unerring vision all worlds lay
open – should 
describe what was seen in these hells in vivid language of terrible
imagery, 
that seems incredible to modern readers only because people forget
that, once 
escaped from the heavy and unplastic matter of the physical world,
all souls 
appear in their proper likenesses and look just what they are .
Even in this 
world a degraded and besotted ruffian moulds his face into most
repellent aspect 
; what then can be expected when the plastic astral matter takes
shape with 
every impulse of his criminal desires, but that such a man should
wear a 
horrifying form, taking on changing elements of hideousness? 
For it must be remembered that the population – if that word may be
allowed – of 
this lowest region consists of the very scum of humanity,
murderers, ruffians, 
violent criminals of all types, drunkards, profligates, the vilest
of mankind. 
None is here, with consciousness awake to its surroundings, save
those guilty of 
brutal crimes, or of deliberate persistent cruelty, or possessed by
some vile 
appetite. The only persons who may be of a better general type, and
yet for a 
while be held here, are suicides, men who have sought by
self-murder to escape 
from the earthly penalties of crimes they had committed, and who
have but 
worsened their position by the exchange. Not all suicides, be it
understood , 
for self-murder is committed from many motives, but only such as
are led up to 
by crime and are then committed in order to avoid the consequences.
Save for the gloomy surroundings and the loathsomeness of a man’s
associates, 
every man here is the immediate creator of his own miseries.
Unchanged, except 
for the loss of the bodily veil, men here show out their passions
in all their 
native hideousness, their naked brutality ; full of fierce
unsatiated appetites, 
seething with revenge, hatred, longings after physical indulgences
which the 
loss of physical organs incapacitates them for enjoying, they roam,
raging and 
ravening, through this gloomy region, crowding round all foul
resorts on earth, 
round brothels and gin-palaces, stimulating their occupants to
deeds of shame 
and violence, seeking opportunities to obsess them, and so to drive
them into 
worse excesses. 
The sickening atmosphere felt round such places comes largely from
these 
earthbound astral entities, reeking with foul passions and unclean
desires. 
Mediums – unless of very pure and noble character – are special
objects of 
attack, and too often the weaker ones, weakened still further by
the passive 
yielding of their bodies for the temporary habitation of other
excarnate souls 
are obsessed by these creatures, and are driven into intemperance
or madness. 
Executed murderers, furious with terror and passionate revengeful
hatred, acting 
over again, as we have said, their crime and recreating mentally
its terrible 
results, surround themselves with an atmosphere of savage
thought-forms, and, 
attracted to any one harbouring revengeful and violent designs,
they egg him on 
into the actual commission of the deed over which he broods.
Sometimes a man may 
be seen constantly followed by his murdered victim, never able to
escape from 
his haunting presence, which hunts him with a dull persistency ,
try he ever so 
eagerly to escape. The murdered person, unless himself of a very
base type, is 
wrapped in unconsciousness, and this very unconsciousness seems to
add a new 
horror to its mechanical pursuit. 
Here also is the hell of the vivisector, for cruelty draws into the
astral body 
the coarsest materials and the most repulsive combinations of the
astral matter, 
and he lives amid the crowding forms of his mutilated victims –
moaning, 
quivering, howling (they are vivified, not by the animal souls but
by elemental 
life) pulsing with hatred to the tormentor – rehearsing his worst
experiments 
with automatic regularity, conscious of all the horror, and yet
imperiously 
impelled to the self-torment by the habit set up during earth-life.
It is well once again, to remember, ere quitting this dreary
region, that we 
have no arbitrary punishments inflicted from outside, but only the
inevitable 
working out of the causes set going by each person. During physical
life they 
yielded to the vilest impulses and drew into, built into, their
astral bodies 
the materials which alone could vibrate in answer to those impulses
; this 
self-built body becomes the prison house of the soul, and must fall
into ruins 
ere the soul can escape from it. 
As inevitably as a drunkard must live in his repulsive soddened
physical body 
here, so must he live in his equally repulsive astral body there.
The harvest 
sown is reaped after its kind. Such is the law in all the worlds,
and it may not 
be escaped. Nor indeed is the astral body there more revolting and
horrible than 
it was when the man was living upon earth and made the atmosphere
around him 
fetid with his astral emanations. But people on earth do not
generally recognise 
its ugliness, being astrally blind. 
Further, we may cheer ourselves in contemplating these unhappy
brothers of ours 
by remembering that their sufferings are but temporary, and are
giving a 
much-needed lesson in the life of the soul. By the tremendous
pressure of 
nature’s disregarded laws they are learning the existence of those
laws, and the 
misery that accrues from ignoring them in life and conduct. The
lesson they 
would not learn during earth-life, whirled away on the torrent of
lusts and 
desires, is pressed on them here, and will be pressed on them in
their 
succeeding lives, until the evils are eradicated and the man has
risen into a 
better life. Nature’s lessons are sharp, but in the long run they
are merciful, 
for they lead to the evolution of the soul and guide it to the
winning of its 
immortality. 
Let us pass to a more cheerful region. The second division of the
astral world 
may be said to be the astral double of the physical, for the astral
bodies of 
all things and of many people are largely composed of the matter
belonging to 
this division of the astral plane, and it is therefore more closely
in touch 
with the physical world than any other part of the astral. The
great majority of 
people make some stay here, and a very large proportion of these
are consciously 
awake in it. These latter are folk whose interests were bound up in
the trivial 
and petty objects of life, who set their hearts on trifles, as well
as those who 
allowed their lower natures to rule them, and who died with the
appetites still 
active and desirous of physical enjoyment. 
Having largely sent their life outwards in these directions, thus
building their 
astral bodies largely of the materials that responded very readily
to material 
impacts, they are held by these bodies in the neighbourhood of
their physical 
attractions. They are mostly dissatisfied, uneasy, restless, with
more or less 
suffering according to the vigour of the wishes they cannot gratify
; some even 
undergo positive pain from this cause, and are long delayed ere
these earthly 
longings are exhausted. 
Many unnecessarily lengthen their stay by seeking to communicate
with the earth, 
in whose interests they are entangled, by means of mediums, who
allow them to 
use their physical bodies for this purpose, thus supplying the loss
of their 
own. From them comes most of the mere twaddle with which every one
is familiar 
who has had experience of public spiritualistic séances, the gossip
and trite 
morality of the petty lodging-house and small shop – feminine, for
the most 
part. As these earth bound souls are generally of small
intelligence, their 
communications are of no more interest- (to those already convinced
of the 
existence of the soul after death) –than was their conversation
when they were 
in the body, and – just as on earth – they are positive in
proportion to their 
ignorance, representing the whole astral world as identical with
their own very 
limited area. There as here: 
They think the rustic cackle of their burgh 
The murmur of the world. 
It is from this region that people who have died with some anxiety
on their 
minds will sometimes seek to communicate with their friends in
order to arrange 
the earthly matter that troubles them ; if they cannot succeed in
showing 
themselves, or in impressing their wishes by a dream on some
friend, they will 
often cause much annoyance by knockings and other noises directly
intended to 
draw attention or caused unconsciously by their restless efforts.
It is a 
charity in such cases for some competent person to communicate with
the 
distressed entity and learn his wishes, as he may thus be freed
from the anxiety 
which prevents him from passing onwards. Souls, while in this
region, may also 
very easily have their attention drawn to the earth, even although
they would 
not spontaneously have turned back to it, and this disservice is
too often done 
to them by the passionate grief and craving for their beloved
presence by 
friends left behind on earth. 
The thought-forms set up by these longings throng round them, and
oftentimes 
arouse them if they are peacefully sleeping, or violently draw
their thoughts to 
earth if they are already conscious. It is especially in the former
case that 
this unwitting selfishness on the part of friends on earth does
mischief to 
their dear ones that they would themselves be the first to regret ;
and it may 
that the knowledge of the unnecessary suffering thus caused to
those who have 
passed through death may, with some, strengthen the binding force
of the 
religious precepts which enjoin submission to the divine law and
the checking of 
excessive and rebellious grief. 
The third and fourth regions of the Kâmalokic world differ but
little from the 
second, and might also be described as etherialised copies of it,
the fourth 
being more refined than the third, but the general characteristics
of the three 
subdivisions being very similar. Souls of somewhat more progressed
types are 
found there, and although they are held there by the encasement
built by the 
activity of their earthly interests, their attention is for the
most part 
directed onwards rather than backwards, and, if they are not
forcibly recalled 
to the concerns of earth-life, they will pass on without very much
delay. 
Still, they are susceptible to earthly stimuli, and the weakening
interest in 
terrestrial affairs may be reawakened by cries from below. Large
numbers of 
educated and thoughtful people, who were chiefly occupied with
worldly affairs 
during their physical lives, are conscious in these regions, and
may be induced 
to communicate through mediums, and, more rarely, seek such
communication 
themselves. Their statements are naturally of a higher type than
those spoken of 
as coming from the second division, but are not marked by any
characteristics 
that render them more valuable than similar statements made by
persons still in 
the body. Spiritual illumination does not come from Kâmaloka. 
The fifth subdivision of Kâmaloka offers many new characteristics.
It presents a 
distinctly luminous and radiant appearance, eminently attractive to
those 
accustomed only to the dull hues of the earth, and justifying the
epithet 
astral, starry, given to the whole plane. Here are situated all the
materialised 
heavens which play so large a part in popular religions all the
world over. 
The happy hunting grounds of the Red Indian, the Valhalla of the
Norsemen, the 
houri-filled paradise of the Muslim, the golden jewelled-gated New
Jerusalem of 
the Christian, the lyceum-filled heaven of the materialistic
reformer, all have 
their places here. Men and women who clung desperately to every
"letter that 
killeth" have here the literal satisfaction of their cravings,
unconsciously 
creating in astral matter by their powers of imagination, fed on
the mere husks 
of the world’s Scriptures, the cloud-built palaces whereof they dreamed.
The crudest religious beliefs find here their temporary cloud-land
realisation, 
and literalists of every faith, who were filled with selfish
longings for their 
own salvation in the most materialistic of heavens, here find an
appropriate, 
and to them enjoyable, home, surrounded by the very conditions in
which they 
believed. The religious and philanthropic busybodies, who cared
more to carry 
out their own fads and impose their own ways on their neighbours
than to work 
unselfishly for the increase of human virtue and happiness, are
here much to the 
fore, carrying on reformatories, refuges, schools, to their own
great 
satisfaction, and much delighted are they still to push an astral
finger into an 
earthly pie with the help of a subservient medium whom they
patronise with lofty 
condescension. 
They build astral churches and schools and houses, reproducing the
materialistic 
heavens they coveted ; and though to keener vision their erections
are 
imperfect, even pathetically grotesque, they find them
all-sufficing. People of 
the same religions flock together and co-operate with each other in
various 
ways, so that communities are formed, differing as widely from each
other as do 
similar communities on earth. 
When they are attracted to the earth they seek, for the most part,
people of 
their own faith and country, chiefly by natural affinity,
doubtless, but also 
because barriers of language still exist in Kâmaloka ; as may be
noticed 
occasionally in messages received in spiritualistic circles. Souls
from this 
region often take the most vivid interest in attempts to establish
communication 
between this and the next world, and the "spirit guides"
of average mediums 
come, for the most part, from this and from the region next above.
They are 
generally aware that there are many possibilities of higher life
before them, 
and that they will, sooner or later, pass away into worlds whence
communication 
with this earth will not be possible. 
The sixth Kâmalokic region resembles the fifth, but is far more
refined, and is 
largely inhabited by souls of a more advanced type, wearing out the
astral 
vesture in which much of their mental energies had worked while
they were in the 
physical body. Their delay is here due to the large part played by
selfishness 
in their artistic and intellectual life, and to the prostitution of
their 
talents to the gratification of the desire-nature in a refined and
delicate way. 
Their surroundings are the best that are found in Kâmaloka, as
their creative 
thoughts fashion the luminous materials of their temporary home
into fair 
landscapes and rippling oceans, snow-clad mountains and fertile
plains, scenes 
that are of fairy-like beauty compared with even the most exquisite
that earth 
can show. Religionists also are found here, of a slightly more
progressed kind 
than those in the division immediately below, and with more
definite views of 
their own limitations. They look forward more clearly to passing
out of their 
present sphere, and reaching a higher state. 
The seventh, the highest, subdivision of Kâmaloka, is occupied
almost entirely 
by intellectual men and women who were either pronouncedly
materialistic while 
on earth, or who are so wedded to the ways in which knowledge is
gained by the 
lower mind in the physical body that they continue its pursuit in
the old ways, 
though with enlarged faculties. One recalls Charles Lamb’s dislike
of the idea 
that in heaven knowledge would have to be gained "by some
awkward process of 
intuition" instead of through his beloved books. Many a
student lives for long 
years, sometimes for centuries – according to H.P.Blavatsky –
literally in the 
astral library, conning eagerly all books that deal with his
favourite subject, 
and perfectly contented with his lot. 
Men who have been keenly set on some line of intellectual
investigation, and 
have thrown off the physical body, with their thirst for knowledge
unslaked, 
pursue their object still with unwearied persistence, fettered by
their clinging 
to the physical modes of study. Often such men are still sceptical
as to the 
higher possibilities that lie before them, and shrink from the
prospect of what 
is practically a second death – the sinking into unconsciousness
ere the soul is 
born into the higher life of heaven. Politicians, statesmen, men of
science, 
dwell for a while in this region, slowly disentangling themselves
from the 
astral body, still held to the lower life by their keen and vivid
interest in 
the movements in which they have played so large a part, and in the
effort to 
work out astrally some of the schemes from which Death snatched
them ere yet 
they had reached fruition. 
To all, however, sooner or later – save to that small minority who
during 
earth-life never felt one touch of unselfish love, of intellectual
aspiration, 
of recognition of something or some one higher than themselves –
there comes a 
time when the bonds of the astral body are finally shaken off,
while the soul 
sinks into brief unconsciousness of its surroundings, like the
unconsciousness 
that follows the dropping off of the physical body, to be awakened
by a sense of 
bliss, intense, immense, fathomless, undreamed of, the bliss of the
heaven-world, of the world to which by its own nature it belongs. 
Low and vile may have been many of its passions, trivial and sordid
many of its 
longings, but it had gleams of a higher nature, broken lights now
and then from 
a purer region, and these must ripen as seeds to the time of their
harvest, and 
however poor and few must yield their fair return. The man passes
on to reap 
this harvest, and to eat and assimilate its fruit. (See Chapter V,
on Devachan). 
The astral corpse, as it is sometimes called, or the
"shell" of the departed 
entity, consists of the fragments of the seven concentric shells
before 
described, held together by the remaining magnetism of the soul.
Each shell in 
turn has disintegrated, until the point is reached when mere
scattered fragments 
of it remain ; these cling by magnetic attraction to the remaining
shells, and 
when one after another has been reduced to this condition, until
the seventh or 
innermost is reached and itself disintegrates, the man himself
escapes, leaving 
behind him these remains. 
The shell drifts about vaguely in the kâmalokic world,
automatically and feebly 
repeating its accustomed vibrations, and as the remaining magnetism
gradually 
disperses, it falls into a more and more decayed condition, and
finally 
disintegrates completely, restoring its materials to the general
mass of astral 
matter, exactly as does the physical body to the physical world. 
This shell drifts wherever the astral currents may carry it, and
may be 
vitalised, if not too far gone, by the magnetism of embodied souls
on earth, and 
so restored to some amount of activity. It will suck up magnetism
as a sponge 
sucks up water, and will then take on an illusory appearance of
vitality, 
repeating more vigorously and vibration to which it was accustomed
; these are 
often set up by the stimulus of thoughts common to the departed
soul and friends 
and relations on earth, and such a vitalised shell may play quite
respectably 
the part of a communicating intelligence; it is however,
distinguishable – apart 
from the use of astral vision – by its automatic repetitions of
familiar 
thoughts, and by the total absence of all originality and of any
traces of 
knowledge not possessed during physical life. 
Just as souls may be delayed in their progress by foolish and
inconsiderate 
friends, so may they be aided in it by wise and well-directed
efforts. Hence all 
religions, which retain any traces of the occult wisdom of their
Founders, 
enjoin the use of "prayers for the dead." These prayers
with their accompanying 
ceremonies are more or less useful according to the knowledge, the
love, and the 
willpower by which they were ensouled. 
They rest on that universal truth of vibration by which the
universe is built, 
modified, and maintained. Vibrations are set up by the uttered sounds,
arranging 
astral matter into definite forms, ensouled by the thought
enshrined in the 
words. These are directed towards the Kâmalokic entity, and,
striking against 
the astral body, hasten its disintegration. With the decay of
occult knowledge 
these ceremonies have become less and less potent, until their
usefulness has 
almost reached a vanishing point. 
Nevertheless they are still sometimes performed by a man of
knowledge, and then 
exert their rightful influence. Moreover, every one can help his
beloved 
departed by sending to them thoughts of love and peace and longing
for their 
swift progress through the Kâmalokic world and their liberation
from astral 
fetters. No one should leave his "dead" to go on a lonely
way, unattended by 
loving hosts of these guardian angel thought-forms, helping them
forward with 
joy. 
THE MENTAL PLANE
The mental plane, as its name implies, is that which belongs to
consciousness 
working as thought ; not of the mind as it works through the brain,
but as it 
works in its own world, unencumbered with physical spirit-matter.
This world is 
the world of the real man. The word "man" comes from the
Sanskrit root "man" and 
this is the root of the Sanskrit verb "to think," so that
man means thinker; he 
is named by his most characteristic attribute, intelligence. 
In English the word "mind" has to stand for the
intellectual consciousness 
itself, and also for the effects produced on the physical brain by
the vibration 
of that consciousness ; but we have now to conceive of the
intellectual 
consciousness as an entity, an individual – a being, the vibrations
of whose 
life are thoughts, thoughts which are images, not words. 
This individual is Manas, or the Thinker ; (Derived from Manas is
the technical 
name, the mânasic plane. Englished as "mental." We might
call it the plane of 
the mind proper, to distinguish its activities from those of the
mind working in 
the flesh.) –he is the Self, clothed in the matter, and working
within the 
conditions, of the higher subdivisions of the mental plane. He
reveals his 
presence on the physical plane by the vibrations he sets up in the
brain and 
nervous system ; these respond to the thrills of his life by
sympathetic 
vibrations, but in consequence of the coarseness of their material
they can 
reproduce only a small section of his vibrations and even that very
imperfectly. 
Just as science asserts the existence of a vast series of etheric
vibrations, of 
which the eye can only see a small fragment, the solar light spectrum,
because 
it can vibrate only within certain limits, so can the physical 
thought-apparatus, the brain and nervous system, think only a small
fragment of 
the vast series of mental vibrations set up by the Thinker in his
own world. 
The most receptive brains respond up to the point of what we call
the great 
intellectual power ; the exceptionally receptive brains respond up
to the point 
of what we call genius ; the exceptionally unreceptive brains
respond only up to 
the point we call idiocy ; but every one sends beating against his
brain 
millions of thought-waves to which it cannot respond, owing to the
density of 
its materials, and just in proportion to its sensitiveness are the
so-called 
mental powers of each. But before studying the Thinker, it will be
well to 
consider his world, the mental plane itself. 
The mental plane is that which is next to the astral, and is
separated from it 
only by differences of materials, just as the astral is separated
from the 
physical. In fact, we may repeat what was said as to the astral and
the physical 
with regard to the mental and the astral. Life on the mental plane
is more 
active than on the astral, and form is more plastic. The
spirit-matter of that 
plane is more highly vitalised and finer than any grade of matter
in the astral 
world. The ultimate atom of astral matter has innumerable
aggregations of the 
coarsest mental matter for its encircling sphere-world, so that the
disintegration of the astral atom yields a mass of mental matter of
the coarsest 
kinds. Under these circumstances it will be understood that the
play of the 
life-forces on this plane will be enormously increased in activity,
there being 
so much less mass to be moved by them. 
The matter is in constant ceaseless motion, taking form under every
thrill of 
life, and adapting itself without hesitation to every changing
motion. 
"Mind-stuff," as it has been called, makes astral
spirit-matter seem clumsy, 
heavy, and lustreless, although compared with the physical
spirit-matter it is 
so fairy-light and luminous. But the law of analogy holds good, and
gives us a 
clue to guide us through this super astral region, the region that
is our 
birthplace and our home, although, imprisoned in a foreign land, we
know it not, 
and gaze at descriptions of it with the eyes of aliens. 
Once again here, as on the two lower planes, the subdivisions of
the 
spirit-matter of the plane are seven in number. Once again, these
varieties 
enter into countless combinations, of every variety of complexity,
yielding the 
solids, liquids, gases, and ethers of the mental plane. The word
"solid" seems 
indeed absurd, when speaking of even the most substantial forms of
mind-stuff ; 
yet as they are dense in comparison with other kinds of mental
materials, and as 
we have no descriptive words save such as are based on physical
conditions, we 
must even use it for lack of a better. 
Enough if we understand that this plane follows the general law and
order of 
Nature, which is, for our globe, the septenary basis, and that the
seven 
subdivisions of matter are of lessening densities, relatively to
each other, as 
the physical solids, liquids, gases, and ethers ; the seventh, or
highest, 
subdivision being composed exclusively of the mental atoms. 
These subdivisions are grouped under two headings, to which the
somewhat 
inefficient and unintelligible epithets "formless" and
"form" have been 
assigned. (Arûpa, without form: rûpa, form. Rûpa is form, shape,
body. ) The 
lower four – the first, second, third, and fourth subdivisions –
are grouped 
together as "with form" ; the higher three – the fifth,
sixth and seventh 
subdivisions – are grouped as "formless." The grouping is
necessary, for the 
distinction is a real one, although one difficult to describe, and
the regions 
are related in consciousness to the divisions in the mind itself –
as will 
appear more plainly a little farther on. 
The distinction may perhaps be best expressed by saying that in the
lower four 
subdivisions the vibrations of consciousness give rise to forms, to
images or 
pictures, and every thought appears as a living shape ; whereas in
the higher 
three, consciousness, though still, of course, setting up
vibrations, seems 
rather to send them out as a mighty stream of living energy, which
does not body 
itself into distinct images while it remains in this higher region,
but which 
steps up a variety of forms all linked by some common condition
when it rushes 
into the lower worlds. 
The nearest analogy that I can find for the conception I am trying
to express is 
that of abstract and concrete thoughts ; an abstract idea of a
triangle has no 
form, but connotes any plane figure contained within three right
lines, the 
angles of which make two right angles ; such an idea, with
conditions but 
without shape, thrown into the lower world, may give birth to a
vast variety of 
figures, right-angled, isosceles, scalene, of any colour and size,
but all 
filling the conditions – concrete triangles each one with a definite
shape of 
its own. The impossibility of giving in words a lucid exposition of
the 
difference in the action of consciousness in the two regions is due
to the fact 
that words are the symbols of images and belong to the workings of
the lower 
mind in the brain, and are based wholly upon those workings ; while
the 
"formless" region belongs to the Pure reason, which never
works within the 
narrow limits of language. 
The mental plane is that which reflects the Universal Mind in
Nature, the plane 
which in our little system corresponds with that of the Great Mind
in the 
Kosmos. (Mahat, the Third LOGOS, or Divine Creative Intelligence,
the Brahmâ of 
the Hindus, the Mandjusri of the Northern Buddhists, the Holy
Spirit of the 
Christians.) In its higher regions exist all the archetypal ideas
which are now 
in course of concrete evolution, and in its lower the working out
of these into 
successive forms, to be duly reproduced in the astral and physical
worlds. 
Its materials are capable of combining under the impulse of thought
vibrations, 
and can give rise to any combination which thought can construct ;
as iron can 
be made into a spade for digging or into a sword for slaying, so
can mind-stuff 
be shaped into thought-forms that help or injure ; the vibrating
life of the 
Thinker shapes the materials around him, and according to his
volitions so is 
his work. In that region thought and action, will and deed, are one
and the same 
thing – spirit-matter here becomes the obedient servant of the
life, adapting 
itself to every creative motion. 
These vibrations, which shape the matter of the plane into
thought-forms, give 
rise also from their swiftness and subtlety to the most exquisite
and constantly 
changing colours, waves of varying shades like the rainbow hues of 
mother-of-pearl, etherialised and brightened to an indescribable
extent, 
sweeping over and through every form, so that each presents a
harmony of 
rippling, living, luminous, delicate colours, including many not
ever known to 
earth. 
Words can give no idea of the exquisite beauty and radiance shown
in 
combinations of this subtle matter, instinct with life and motion.
Every seer 
who has witnessed it, Hindu, Buddhist, Christian, speaks in
rapturous terms of 
its glorious beauty, and ever confesses his utter inability to
describe it; 
words seem but to coarsen and deprave it, however deftly woven in
its praise. 
Thought-forms naturally play a large part among the living
creatures that 
function on the mental plane. They resemble those with which we are
already 
familiar in the astral world, save that they are far more radiant
and more 
brilliantly coloured, are stronger, more lasting, and more fully
vitalised. As 
the higher intellectual qualities become more clearly marked, these
forms show 
very sharply defined outlines, and there is a tendency to a
singular perfection 
of geometrical figures accompanied by an equally singular purity of
luminous 
colour. But, needless to say at the present stage of humanity,
there is a vast 
preponderance of cloudy and irregularly shaped thoughts, the
production of the 
ill-trained minds of the majority. 
Rarely beautiful artistic thoughts are also here encountered, and
it is little 
wonder that painters who have caught, in dreamy vision, some
glimpse of their 
ideal, often fret against their incapacity to reproduce its glowing
beauty in 
earth’s dull pigments. These thought-forms are built out of the
elemental 
essence of the plane, the vibrations of the thought throwing the
elemental 
essence into a corresponding shape, and this shape having the
thought as its 
informing life. Thus again we have "artificial
elementals" created in a way 
identical with that by which they come into being in the astral
regions. All 
that is said in Chapter II of their generation and of their
importance may be 
repeated of those of the mental plane, with here the additional
responsibility 
on their creators of the greater force and permanence belonging to
those of this 
higher world. 
The elemental essence of the mental plane is formed by the Monad in
the stage of 
its descent immediately preceding its entrance into the astral
world, and it 
constitutes the second elemental kingdom, existing on the four lower
subdivisions of the mental plane. The three higher subdivisions,
the "formless," 
are occupied by the first elemental kingdom, the elemental essence
there being 
thrown by thought into brilliant coruscations, coloured streams,
and flashes of 
living fire, instead of into definite shapes, taking as it were its
first 
lessons in combined action, but not yet assuming definite
limitations of forms. 
On the mental plane, in both its great divisions, exist numberless 
Intelligences, whose lowest bodies are formed of the luminous
matter and 
elemental essence of that plane – Shining ones who guide the
processes of 
natural order, overlooking the hosts of lower entities before
spoken of, and 
yielding submission in their several hierarchies to their great
overlords of the 
seven Elements. (These are the Arûpa and Rûpa Devas of the Hindus
and the 
Buddhists, the "Lords of the heavenly and the earthly" of
the Zoroastrians, the 
Archangels and Angels of the Christians and Mahomedans). 
They are, as may readily be imagined, beings of vast knowledge, of
great power, 
and most splendid in appearance, radiant, flashing creatures,
myriad-hued, like 
rainbows of changing supernal colours, of stateliest mien, calm
energy 
incarnate, embodiments of resistless strength. The description of
the great 
Christian Seer leaps to mind, when he wrote of a mighty angel:
"A rainbow was 
upon his head, and his face was imperial as it were the sun, and
his feet as 
pillars of fire.( Revelation, x, 1). "As the sound of many
waters" are their 
voices, as echoes from the music of the spheres. They guide natural
order, and 
rule the vast companies of the elementals of the astral world, so
that their 
cohorts carry on ceaselessly the processes of nature with
undeviating regularity 
and accuracy. 
On the lower mental plane are seen many Chelâs at work in their
mental bodies, 
(Usually called Mâyâvi Rûpa, or illusory body, when arranged for
independent 
functioning in the mental world.) --- freed for a time from their
physical 
vestures. When the body is wrapped in deep sleep the true man, the
Thinker, may 
escape from it, and work untrammelled by its weight in these higher
regions. 
From here he can aid and comfort his fellowmen by acting directly
on their 
minds, suggesting helpful thoughts, putting before them noble
ideas, more 
effectively and speedily than he can do when encased in the body.
He can see 
their needs more clearly and therefore can supply them more
perfectly, and it is 
his highest privilege and joy thus to minister to his struggling
brothers, 
without their knowledge of his service or any ideas of theirs as to
the strong 
arm that lifts their burden, or the soft voice that whispers solace
in their 
pain. 
Unseen, unrecognised, he works, serving his enemies as gladly and
as freely as 
his friends, dispensing to individuals the stream of beneficent
forces that are 
poured down from the great Helpers in higher spheres. Here also are
sometimes 
seen the glorious figures of the Masters, though for the most part
They reside 
on the highest level of the "formless" division of the
mental plane ; and other 
Great Ones may also sometimes come hither on some mission of
compassion 
requiring such lower manifestation. 
Communication between intelligences functioning consciously on this
plane, 
whether human or non-human, whether in or out of the body, is
practically 
instantaneous, for it is with:the "speed of thought."
Barriers of space have 
here no power to divide, and any soul can come into touch with any
one by merely 
directing his attention to him. 
Not only is communication thus swift, but it is also complete, if
the souls are 
at about the same stage of evolution ; no words fetter and obstruct
the 
communion, but the whole thought flashes from the one to the other,
or, perhaps 
more exactly, each sees the thought as conceived by the other. The
real barriers 
between souls are the differences of evolution ; the less evolved
can know only 
as much of the more highly evolved as his is able to respond to ;
the limitation 
can obviously be felt only by the higher one, as the lesser has all
that he can 
contain. 
The more evolved a soul, the more does he know of all around him,
the nearer 
does he approach to realities ; but the mental plane has also its
veils of 
illusion, it must be remembered, though they be far fewer and
thinner than those 
of the astral and the physical worlds. Each soul has its own mental
atmosphere, 
and, as all impressions must come through this atmosphere, they are
all 
distorted and coloured. The clearer and purer, the atmosphere, and
the less it 
is coloured by the personality, the fewer are the illusions that
can befall it. 
The three highest subdivisions of the mental plane are the habitat
of the 
Thinker himself, and he dwells on one or other of these, according
to the stage 
of his evolution. The vast majority live on the lowest level, in
various stages 
of evolution ; a comparatively few of the highly intellectual dwell
on the 
second level, the Thinker ascending thither – to use a phrase more
suitable to 
the physical than to the mental plane – when the subtler matter of
that region 
preponderates in him, and thus necessitates the change ; there is
of course, no 
"ascending," no change of place, but he receives the
vibrations of that subtler 
matter, being able to respond to them, and he himself is able to
send out forces 
that throw its rare particles into vibration. 
The student should familiarise himself with the fact that rising in
the scale of 
evolution does not move him from place to place, but renders him
more and more 
able to receive impressions. Every sphere is around us, the astral,
the mental, 
the buddhic, the nirvânic, and worlds higher yet, the life of the
supreme God ; 
we need not stir to find them, for they are here; but our dull
unreceptivity 
shuts them out more effectively than millions of miles of mere
space. 
We are conscious only of that which affects us, which stirs us to
responsive 
vibration, and as we become more and more receptive, as we draw
into ourself 
finer and finer matter, we come into contact with subtler and
subtler worlds. 
Hence, rising from one level to another means that we are weaving
our vestures 
of finer materials and can receive through them the contacts of
finer worlds ; 
and it means further that in the Self within these vestures diviner
powers are 
waking from latency into activity, and are sending out their
subtler thrills of 
life. 
At the stage now reached by the Thinker, he is fully conscious of
his 
surroundings and is in possession of the memory of his past. He
knows the bodies 
he is wearing, through which he is contacting the lower planes, and
he is able 
to influence and guide them to a great extent. He sees the
difficulties, the 
obstacles, they are approaching – the results of past careless
living – and he 
sets himself to pour into them energies by which they may be better
equipped for 
their task. 
His direction is sometimes felt in the lower consciousness as an
imperiously 
compelling force that will have its way, and that impels to a
course of action 
for which all the reasons may not be clear to the dimmer vision
caused by the 
mental and astral garments. Men who have done great deeds have
occasionally left 
on record their consciousness of an inner and compelling power,
which seemed to 
leave them no choice save to do as they had done. They were then
acting as the 
real man ; the Thinkers, that are the inner men, were doing the
work consciously 
through the bodies that then were fulfilling their proper functions
as vehicles 
of the individual. To these higher powers all will come as
evolution proceeds. 
On the third level of the upper region of the mental plane dwell
the Egos of the 
Masters, and of the Initiates who are Their Chelâs, the Thinkers
having here a 
preponderance of the matter of this region in their bodies. From
this world of 
subtlest mental forces the Masters carry on Their beneficent work
for humanity, 
raining down noble ideals, inspiring thoughts, devotional
aspirations, streams 
of spiritual and intellectual help for men. 
Every force there generated, rays out in myriad directions, and the
noblest, 
purest souls catch most readily these helpful influences. A
discovery flashes 
into the mind of the patient searcher into Nature’s secrets ; a new
melody 
entrances the ear of the great musician ; the answer to a long
studied problem 
illumines the intellect of a lofty philosopher ; a new energy of
hope and love 
suffuses the heart of an unwearied philanthropist. Yet men think
that they are 
left uncared for, although the very phrases they use ; "the
thought occurred to 
me; the idea came to me; the discovery flashed on me "
unconsciously testify to 
the truth known to their inner selves though the outer eyes be blind.
Let us now turn to the study of the Thinker and his vestures as
they are found 
in men on earth. The body of the consciousness, conditioning it in
the four 
lower subdivisions of the mental plane – the mental body, as we
term it – is 
formed of combinations of the matter of these subdivisions. The
Thinker, the 
individual, Human Soul – formed in the way described in the latter
part of this 
chapter – when he is coming into incarnation, first radiates forth
some of his 
energy in vibrations that attract round him, and clothe him in,
matter drawn 
from the four lower subdivisions of his own plane. 
According to the nature of the vibrations are the kinds of matter
they attract ; 
the finer kinds answer the swifter vibrations and take form under
their impulse 
; the coarser kinds similarly answer the slower ones ; just as a
wire will 
sympathetically sound out a note – i.e., a given number of
vibrations – coming 
from a wire similar in weight and tension to itself, but will
remain dumb amid a 
chorus of notes from wires dissimilar to itself in these respects,
so do the 
different kinds of matter assort themselves in answer to different
kinds of 
vibrations. Exactly according to the vibrations sent out by the
Thinker will be 
the nature of the mental body that he thus draws around him, and
this mental 
body is what is called the lower mind, the lower Manas, because it
is the 
Thinker clothed in the matter of the lower subdivisions of the
mental plane and 
conditioned by it in his further working. 
None of his energies which are too subtle to move this matter, too
swift for its 
response, can express themselves through it ; he is therefore
limited by it, 
conditioned by it, restricted by it in his expression of himself.
It is the 
first of his prison-houses during his incarnate life, and while his
energies are 
acting within it he is largely shut off from his own higher world,
for his 
attention is with the outgoing energies and his life is thrown with
them into 
the mental body, often spoken as a vesture, or sheath, or vehicle –
any 
expression will serve which connotes the idea that the Thinker is
not the mental 
body, but formed it and uses it in order to express as much of
himself as he can 
in the lower mental region. 
It must not be forgotten that his energies, still pulsing outwards,
draw round 
him also the coarser matter of the astral plane as his astral body
; and during 
his incarnate life the energies that express themselves through the
lower kinds 
of mental matter are so readily changed by it into the slower
vibrations that 
are responded to by astral matter that the two bodies are
continually vibrating 
together, and become very closely interwoven ; the coarser the
kinds of matter 
built into the mental body, the more intimate becomes this union,
so that the 
two bodies are sometimes classed together and even taken as one.(
Thus the 
Theosophist will speak of Kâma Manas, meaning the mind as working
in and with 
the desire nature, affecting and affected by the animal nature. The
Vedântin 
classes the two together, and speaks of the Self as working in the 
Manomayakosha, the sheath composed of the lower mind, emotions, and
passions. 
The European psychologist makes "feelings" one section of
his tripartite 
division of "mind", and includes under feelings both
emotions and sensations.) 
When we come to study Reincarnation we shall find this fact
assuming vital 
importance. 
According to the stage of evolution reached by the man will be the
type of 
mental body he forms on his way to become again incarnate, and we
may study, as 
we did with the astral body, the respective mental bodies of three
types of men 
– a) an undeveloped man ; b) an average man ; c) a spiritually
advanced man. 
  In the undeveloped man the
mental body is but little perceptible, a small 
  amount of unorganised
mental matter, chiefly from the lowest subdivisions of 
  the plane, being all that
represents it. This is played on almost entirely 
  from the lower bodies,
being set vibrating feebly by the astral storms raised 
  by the contacts with
material objects through the sense organs. Except when 
  stimulated by these astral
vibrations it remains almost quiescent, and even 
  under their impulses its
responses are sluggish. No definite activity is 
  generated from within,
these blows from the outer world being necessary to 
  arouse any distinct
response. 
  The more violent the blows,
the better for the progress of the man, for each 
  responsive vibration aids
in the embryonic development of the mental body. 
  Riotous pleasure, anger,
rage, pain, terror, all these passions, causing 
  whirlwinds in the astral
body, awaken faint vibrations in the mental, and 
  gradually these vibrations,
stirring into commencing activity the mental 
  consciousness, cause it to
add something of its own to the impressions made on 
  it from without. 
  We have seen that the
mental body is so closely mingled with the astral that 
  they act as a single body,
but the dawning mental faculties add to the astral 
  passions a certain strength
and quality not apparent in them when they work as 
  purely animal qualities.
The impressions made on the mental body are more 
  permanent than those made
on the astral, and they are consciously reproduced 
  by it. Here memory and the
organ of imagination begin, and the latter 
  gradually moulds itself,
the images from the outer world working on the matter 
  of the mental body and
forming its materials into their own likeness. 
  These images, born of the
contacts of the senses, draw round themselves the 
  coarsest mental matter; the
dawning powers of consciousness reproduce these 
  images, and thus accumulate
a store of pictures that begin to stimulate action 
  initiated from within, from
the wish to experience again through the outer 
  organs the vibrations that
were found pleasant, and to avoid those productive 
  of pain. 
  The mental body then begins
to stimulate the astral, and to arouse in it the 
  desires that, in the animal,
slumber until awakened by a physical stimulus ; 
  hence we see in the
undeveloped man a persistent pursuit of 
  sense-gratification never
found in the lower animals, a lust, a cruelty, a 
  calculation, to which they
are strangers. The dawning powers of the mind, 
  yoked to the service of the
senses, make of man a far more dangerous and 
  savage brute than any
animal, and the stronger and more subtle forces inherent 
  in the mental-spiritual
matter lend to the passion-nature an energy and a 
  keenness that we do not
find in the animal world. 
  But these very excesses
lead to their own correction by the sufferings which 
  they cause, and these
resultant experiences play upon the consciousness and 
  set up new images on which
the imagination works. These stimulate the 
  consciousness to resist
many of the vibrations that reach it by way of the 
  astral body from the
external world, and to exercise its volition in holding 
  the passions back instead
of giving them free rein. 
  Such resistant vibrations
are set up in, and attract towards, the mental body, 
  finer combinations of
mind-stuff and tend also to expel from it the coarser 
  combinations that vibrate
responsively to the passional notes set up in the 
  astral body ; by this
struggle between the vibrations set up by passion-images 
  and the vibrations set up
by the imaginative reproduction of past experiences, 
  the mental body grows,
begins to develop a definite organisation, and to 
  exercise more and more
initiative as regards external activities. 
  While the earth life is
spent gathering experiences, the intermediate life is 
  spent assimilating them, as
we shall see in detail in the following chapter, 
  so that in each return to
earth the Thinker has an increased stock of 
  faculties to take shape as
his mental body. Thus the undeveloped man, whose 
  mind is the slave of his
passions, grows into the average man, whose mind is a 
  battleground in which
passions and mental powers wage war with varying 
  success, about balanced in
their forces, but who is gradually gaining the 
  mastery over his lower
nature. 
  In the average man, the
mental body is much increased in size, shows a certain 
  amount of organisation, and
contains a fair proportion of matter drawn from 
  the second, third, and
fourth subdivisions of the mental plane. The general 
  law which regulates all the
building up and modifying of the mental body may 
  here be fitly studied,
though it is the same principle already seen working in 
  the lower realms of the
astral and physical worlds. 
  Exercise increases, disuse
atrophies and finally destroys. Every vibration set 
  up in the mental body
causes changes in its constituents, throwing out of it, 
  in the part affected, the
matter that cannot vibrate sympathetically, and 
  replacing it by suitable
materials drawn from the practically illimitable 
  store around. The more a
series of vibrations is repeated, the more does the 
  part affected by them
increase in development ; hence, it may be noted in 
  passing, the injury done to
the mental body by over-specialisation of mental 
  energies. 
  Such mistaken direction of
these powers causes a lopsided development of the 
  mental body ; it becomes
proportionately over developed in the region in which 
  these forces are
continually playing and proportionately undeveloped in other 
  parts, perhaps equally
important. A harmonious and proportionate all-round 
  development is the object
to be sought, and for this we need a calm 
  self-analysis and a
definite direction of means to ends. A knowledge of this 
  law, further explains
certain familiar experiences, and affords a sure hope of 
  progress. When a new study
is commenced, or a change in favour of high 
  morality is initiated, the
early stages are found to be fraught with 
  difficulties ; sometimes
the effort is even abandoned because the obstacles in 
  the way of its success
appear to be insurmountable. 
  At the beginning of any new
mental undertaking, the whole automatism of the 
  mental body opposes it ;
the materials habituated to vibrate in a particular 
  way, cannot accommodate
themselves to the new impulses, and the early stage 
  consists chiefly of sending
out thrills of force which are frustrated, so far 
  as setting up vibrations in
the mental body are concerned, but which are the 
  necessary preliminary to
any such sympathetic vibrations, as they shake out of 
  the body the old refractory
materials and draw into it the sympathetic kinds. 
  During this process, the
man is not conscious of any progress; he is conscious 
  only of the frustration of
his efforts and of the dull resistance he 
  encounters. Presently, if
he persists, as the newly attracted materials begin 
  to function, he succeeds
better in his attempts, and at last, when all the old 
  materials are expelled and
the new are working, he finds himself succeeding 
  without an effort, and his
object is accomplished. 
  The critical time is during
the first stage ; but if he trust in the law, as 
  sure in its working as
every other law in Nature, and persistently repeat his 
  efforts, he must succeed ;
and a knowledge of this fact may cheer him when 
  otherwise he would be
sinking in despair. In this way, then, the average man 
  may work on, finding with
joy that as he steadily resists the promptings of 
  the lower nature he is
conscious they are losing their power over him, for he 
  is expelling from his
mental body all the materials that are capable of being 
  thrown into sympathetic
vibrations. Thus the mental body gradually comes to be 
  composed of the finer
constituents of the four lower subdivisions of the 
  mental plane, until it has
become radiant and exquisitely beautiful form which 
  is the mental body of the –
  Spiritually developed man.
From this body all the coarser combinations have 
  been eliminated, so that
the objects of the senses no longer find in it, or in 
  the astral body connected
with it, materials that respond sympathetically to 
  their vibrations. It
contains only the finer combinations belonging to each of 
  the four subdivisions of
the lower mental world, and of these again the 
  materials of the third and
fourth sub-planes very much predominate in its 
  composition over the
materials of the second and first, making it responsive 
  to all the higher workings
of the intellect, to the delicate contacts of the 
  higher arts, to all the
pure thrills of loftier emotions. 
  Such a body enables the
Thinker who is clothed in it to express himself much 
  more fully in the lower
mental region and in the astral and physical worlds ; 
  its materials are capable
of a far wider range of responsive vibrations, and 
  the impulses from a loftier
realm mould it into nobler and subtler 
  organisation. Such a body
is rapidly becoming ready to reproduce every impulse 
  from the Thinker which is
capable of expression on the lower subdivisions of 
  the mental plane ; it is
growing into a perfect instrument for activities in 
  this lower mental world. 
  A clear understanding of
the nature of the mental body would much modify 
  modern education, and would
make it far more serviceable to the Thinker than 
  it is at present. The
general characteristics of this body depend on the past 
  lives of the Thinker on
earth, as will be thoroughly understood when we have 
  studied Reincarnation and
Karma. The body is constituted on the mental plane, 
  and its materials depend on
the qualities that the Thinker has garnered within 
  himself as the results of
his past experiences. 
  All that education can do
is to provide such external stimuli as shall arouse 
  and encourage the growth of
the useful faculties he already possesses, and 
  stunt and help in the
eradication of those that are undesirable. The drawing 
  out of these inborn
faculties, and not the cramming of the mind with facts, is 
  the object of true
education. 
  Nor need memory be
cultivated as a separate faculty, for memory depends on 
  attention – that is on the
steady concentration of the mind on the subject 
  studied – and on the
natural affinity between the subject and the mind. If the 
  subject be liked – that is,
if the mind has a capacity for it – memory will 
  not fail, provided due
attention be paid. Therefore education should cultivate 
  the habit of steady
concentration, of sustained attention, and should be 
  directed according to the
inborn faculties of the pupil. 
  Let us now pass into the
"formless" divisions of the mental plane, the region 
  which is man’s true home
during the cycle of his reincarnations, into which he 
  is born, a baby soul, an
infant Ego, an embryonic individuality, when he 
  begins his purely human
evolution.( See Chapters VII and VIII, on 
  "Reincarnation").
  The outline of this Ego,
the Thinker, is oval in shape, and hence H.P. 
  Blavatsky speaks of this
body of Manas which endures throughout all his 
  incarnations as the Auric
Egg. Formed of the matter of the three highest 
  subdivisions of the mental
plane, it is exquisitely fine, a film of rarest 
  subtlety, even at its first
inception ; and, as it develops, it becomes a 
  radiant object of supernal
glory and beauty, the shining One, as it has been 
  aptly named. ( This is the
Augœides of the Neo-Platonists, the "spiritual 
  body" of St. Paul). 
  What is this Thinker? He is
the divine Self, as already said, limited, or 
  individualised, by this
subtle body drawn from the materials of the "formless" 
  region of the mental plane.
(The Self, working in the Vignyânamayakosha, the 
  sheath of discriminative
knowledge, according to the Vedântic classification). 
  This matter – drawn around
a ray of the Self, a living beam of the one Light 
  and Life of the universe –
shuts off this ray from its Source, so far as the 
  external world is
concerned, encloses it within a filmy shell of itself, and 
  so makes it "an
individual." The life is the Life of the LOGOS, but all the 
  powers of that Life are
lying latent, concealed ; everything is there 
  potentially, germinally, as
the tree is hidden within the tiny germ in the 
  seed. 
  This seed is dropped into
the soil of human life that its latent forces may be 
  quickened into activity by
the sun of joy and the rain of tears, and he fed by 
  the juices of the life-soil
that we call experience, until the germ grows into 
  a mighty tree, the image of
its generating Sire. Human evolution is the 
  evolution of the Thinker;
he takes on bodies on the lower mental and astral, 
  and the physical planes,
wears then through earthly, astral, lower mental 
  life, dropping them
successively at the regular stages of this life-cycle as 
  he passes from world to
world, but ever storing up within himself the fruits 
  he has gathered by their
use on each plane. 
  At first, as little
conscious as a baby’s earthly body, he almost slept 
  through life after life,
till the experiences playing on him from without 
  awakened some of his latent
forces into activity; but gradually he assumed 
  more and more part in the
direction of his life, until, with manhood reached, 
  he took his life into his
own hands, and an ever-increasing control over his 
  future destiny. 
The growth of the permanent body which, with the divine
consciousness, forms the 
Thinker is extremely slow. Its technical name is the causal body,
because he 
gathers up within it the results of all experiences, and these act
as causes, 
moulding future lives. It is the only permanent one among the
bodies during 
incarnation, the mental, the astral, and physical bodies being
reconstituted for 
each fresh life ; as each perishes in turn, it hands on its harvest
to the one 
above it, and thus all the harvests are finally stored in the
permanent body ; 
when the Thinker returns to incarnation he sends out his energies,
constituted 
of these harvests, on each successive plane, and thus draws round
him a anew 
body after body suitable to his past. 
The growth of the causal body itself, as said, is very slow, for it
can vibrate 
only in answer to impulses that can be expressed in the very subtle
matter of 
which it is composed, thus weaving them into the texture of its
being. Hence the 
passions, which play so large a part in the early stages of human
evolution, 
cannot directly affect its growth. The Thinker can work into
himself only the 
experiences that can be reproduced in the vibrations of the causal
body, and 
these must belong to the mental region, and be highly intellectual
or loftily 
moral in their character ; other wise its subtle matter can give no
sympathetic 
vibration in answer. 
A very little reflection will convince any one how little material,
suitable for 
the growth of this lofty body, he affords by his daily life ; hence
the slowness 
of evolution, the little progress made. The Thinker should have
more of himself 
to put out in each successive life, and, when this is the case,
evolution goes 
swiftly forward. Persistence in evil courses reacts in a kind of
indirect way on 
the causal body, and does more harm than the mere retardation of
growth ; it 
seems after a long time to cause a certain incapacity to respond to
the 
vibrations set up by the opposite good, and thus to delay growth
for a 
considerable period after the evil has been renounced. 
Directly to injure the causal body, evil of a highly intellectual
and refined 
kind is necessary, the "spiritual evil" mentioned in the
various Scriptures of 
the world. This is fortunately rare, rare as spiritual good, and
found only 
among the highly progressed, whether they be following the
Right-hand or the 
Left-hand Path. (The Right-hand Path is that which leads to divine
manhood, to 
Adeptship used in the service of the worlds. The Left-hand Path is
that which 
also leads to Adeptship, but to Adeptship that is used to frustrate
the progress 
of evolution and is turned to selfish individual ends. They are
sometimes called 
the White and Black Paths respectively.) 
The habitat of the Thinker, of the Eternal Man, is on the fifth
subplane, the 
lowest level of the "formless" region of the mental
plane. The great masses of 
mankind are here, scarce yet awake, still in the infancy of their
life. The 
Thinker develops consciousness slowly, as his energies, playing on
the lower 
planes, there gather experience, which is indrawn with these
energies as they 
return to him treasure-laden with the harvest of life. This eternal
Man, the 
individualised Self, is the actor in every body that he wears ; it
is his 
presence that gives the feeling of " I " alike to body
and mind, the " I " being 
that which is self-conscious and which, by illusion, identifies
itself with that 
vehicle in which it is most actively energising. 
To the man of the senses the " I " is the physical body
and the desire nature ; 
he draws from these his enjoyment, and he thinks of these as
himself, for his 
life is in them. To the scholar the " I " is the mind,
for in its exercise lies 
his joy and therein his life is concentrated. Few can rise to the
abstract 
heights of spiritual philosophy, and feel this Eternal Man as
" I ", with memory 
ranging back over past lives and hopes ranging forward over future
births. 
The physiologists tell us that if we cut the finger we do not
really feel the 
pain there where the blood is flowing, but that pain is felt in the
brain, and 
is by imagination thrown outwards to the place of the injury ; the
feeling of 
pain in the finger is, they say an illusion ; it is put by
imagination at the 
point of contact with the object causing the injury ; so also will
a man feel 
pain in an amputated limb, or rather in the space the limb used to
occupy. 
Similarly does the one " I ", the Inner Man, feel
suffering and joy in the 
sheaths which enwrap him, at the points of contact with the external
world, and 
feels the sheath to be himself, knowing not that this feeling is an
illusion, 
and that he is the sole actor and experiencer in each sheath. 
Let us now consider, in this light, the relations between the
higher and lower 
mind and their action on the brain. The mind, Manas, the Thinker,
is one, and is 
the Self in the causal body; it is the source of innumerable
energies, of 
vibrations of innumerable kinds. These it sends out, raying
outwards from 
itself. The subtlest and finest of these are expressed in the
matter of the 
causal body, which alone is fine enough to respond to them ; they
form what we 
call the Pure Reason, whose thoughts are abstract, whose method of
gaining 
knowledge is intuition ; its very "nature is knowledge,"
and it recognises truth 
at sight as congruous with itself. 
Less subtle vibrations pass outwards, attracting the matter of the
lower mental 
region, and these are the Lower Manas, or lower mind – the coarser
energies of 
the higher expressed in denser matter ; these we call the
intellect, comprising 
reason, judgement, imagination, comparison, and the other mental
faculties ; its 
thoughts are concrete, and its method is logic ; it argues, it
reasons, it 
infers. These vibrations, acting through astral matter on the
etheric brain, and 
by that on the dense physical brain, set up vibrations therein,
which are the 
heavy and slow reproductions of themselves – heavy and slow,
because the 
energies lose much of their swiftness in moving the heavier matter.
This feebleness of response when a vibration is initiated in a rare
medium and 
then passes into a dense one is familiar to every student of
physics. Strike a 
bell in air and it sounds clearly ; strike it in hydrogen, and let
the hydrogen 
vibrations have to set up the atmospheric waves, and how faint the
result. 
Equally feeble are the workings of the brain in response to the
swift and subtle 
impacts of the mind ; yet that is all that the vast majority know
as their 
"consciousness." 
The immense importance of the mental workings of this
"consciousness" is due to 
the fact that it is the only medium whereby the Thinker can gather
the harvest 
of experience by which he grows. While it is dominated by the
passions it runs 
riot, and he is left unnourished and therefore unable to develop ;
while it is 
occupied wholly in mental activities concerned with the outer
world, it can 
arouse only his lower energies; only as he is able to impress on it
the true 
object of its life, does it commence to fulfil its most valuable
functions of 
gathering what will arouse and nourish his higher energies. 
As the Thinker develops he becomes more and more conscious of his
own inherent 
powers, and also of the workings of his energies on the lower planes,
of the 
bodies which those energies have drawn around him. He at last
begins to try to 
influence them, using his memory of the past to guide his will, and
these 
impressions we call "conscience" when they deal with
morals and "flashes of 
intuition " when they enlighten the intellect. 
When these impressions are continuous enough to be normal, we speak
of their 
aggregate as "genius." The higher evolution of the
Thinker is marked by his 
increasing control over his lower vehicles, by their increasing
susceptibility 
to his influence, and their increasing contributions to growth.
Those who would 
deliberately aid in this evolution may do so by a careful training
of the lower 
mind and of the moral character, by steady and well directed
effort. 
The habit of quiet, sustained, and sequential thought, directed to
non-worldly 
subjects, of meditation, of study, develops the mind-body and
renders it a 
better instrument ; the effort to cultivate abstract thinking is
also useful, as 
this raises the lower mind towards the higher, and draws into it
the subtlest 
materials of the lower mental plane. 
In these and cognate ways all may actively co-operate in their own
higher 
evolution, each step forward making the succeeding steps more
rapid. No effort, 
not even the smallest, is lost, but is followed by its full effect,
and every 
contribution gathered and handed inwards is stored in the
treasure-house of the 
causal body for future use. Thus evolution, however slow and
halting, is yet 
ever onwards, and the divine Life, ever unfolding in every soul,
slowly subdues 
all things to itself. 
DEVACHAN
The word Devachan is the theosophical name for heaven, and,
literally 
translated, means the shining land, or the Land of the Gods. (
Devasthan, the 
place of the Gods, is the Sanskrit equivalent. It is the Svarga of
the Hindus ; 
the Sukhâvati of the Buddhists ; the Heaven of the Zoroastrians and
Christians, 
and of the less materialised among the Mohammedans). It is a
specially guarded 
part of the mental plane, whence all sorrow and all evil are
excluded by the 
action of the great spiritual Intelligences who superintend human
evolution ; 
and it is inhabited by human beings who have cast off their
physical and astral 
bodies, and who pass into it when their stay in Kâmaloka is
completed. 
The devachanic life consists of two stages, of which the first is
passed in the 
four lower subdivisions of the mental plane, in which the Thinker
still wears 
the mental body and is conditioned by it, being employed in assimilating
the 
materials gathered by it during the earth-life from which he has
just emerged. 
The second stage is spent in the "formless world," the
Thinker escaping from the 
mental body, and living in his own unencumbered life in the full
measure of the 
self-consciousness and knowledge to which he has attained. 
The total length of time spent in Devachan depends upon the amount
of material 
for the devachanic life which the soul has brought with it from its
life on 
earth. The harvest of the fruit for consumption and assimilation in
Devachan 
consists of all the pure thoughts and emotions generated during
earth-life, all 
the intellectual and moral efforts and aspirations, all the
memories of useful 
work and plans for human service – everything which is capable of
being worked 
into mental and moral faculty, thus assisting in the evolution of
the soul. 
Not one is lost, however feeble, however fleeting ; but selfish
animal passions 
cannot enter, there being no material in which they can be
expressed. Nor does 
all the evil in the past life, though it may largely preponderate
over the good, 
prevent the full reaping of whatever scant harvest of good there
may have been ; 
the scantiness of the harvest may render the devachanic life very
brief, but the 
most depraved, if he has had any faint longings after the right,
any stirrings 
of tenderness, must have a period of devachanic life in which the
seed of good 
may put forth its tender shoots, in which the spark of good may be
gently fanned 
into a tiny flame. 
In the past, when men lived with their hearts largely fixed on
heaven and 
directed their lives with a view to enjoying its bliss, the period
spent in 
Devachan was very long, lasting sometimes for many thousands of
years ; at the 
present time, men’s minds being so much more centred on earth, and
so few of 
their thoughts comparatively being directed towards the higher
life, their 
devachanic periods are correspondingly shortened. 
Similarly, the time spent in the higher and lower regions of the
mental plane ( 
Called technically the Arûpa and Rûpa Devachan – existing on the
arûpa and rûpa 
levels of the mental plane ) respectively is proportionate to the
amount of 
thought generated severally in the mental and causal bodies ; All
the thoughts 
belonging to the personal self, to the life just closed – with all
its 
ambitions, interests, loves, hopes, and fears – all these have
their fruition in 
the Devachan where forms are found ; while those belonging to the
higher mind, 
to the regions of abstract, impersonal thinking, have to be worked
out in the 
"formless" devachanic region. The majority of people only
just enter that lofty 
region to pass swiftly out again ; some spend there a large portion
of their 
devachanic existence ; a few spend there almost the whole. 
Ere entering into any details let us try to grasp some of the
leading ideas 
which govern the devachanic life, for it is so different from
physical life that 
any description of it is apt to mislead by its very strangeness.
People realise 
so little of their mental life, even as led in the body, that when
they are 
presented with a picture of mental life out of the body they lose
all sense of 
reality, and feel as though they had passed into a world of dream. 
The first thing to grasp is that mental life is far more intense,
vivid, and 
nearer to reality than the life of the senses. Everything we see
and touch and 
hear and taste and handle down here is two removes farther from the
reality than 
everything we contact in Devachan. We do not even see things as
they are, but 
the things that we see down here have two more veils of illusion
enveloping 
them. Our sense of reality here is an entire delusion ; we know
nothing of 
things, of people, as they are ; all that we know of them are the
impressions 
they make on our senses, and the conclusions, often erroneous,
which our reason 
deduces from the aggregate of these impressions. Get and put side
by side the 
ideas of a man held by his father, his closest friend, the girl who
adores him, 
his rival in business, his deadliest enemy, and a casual
acquaintance, and see 
how incongruous the pictures. 
Each can only give the impressions made on his own mind, and how
far are they 
from the reality of what the man is, seen by the eyes that pierces
all veils and 
behold the whole man. We know of each of our friends the
impressions they make 
on us, and these are strictly limited by our capacity to receive ;
a child may 
have as his father a great statesman of lofty purpose and imperial
aims, but 
that guide of nation’s destinies is to him only his merriest play
fellow, his 
most enticing storyteller. 
We live in the midst of illusions, but we have the feeling of
reality, and this 
yields us content. In Devachan we shall also be surrounded by
illusions – 
though, as said, two removes nearer to reality – and there also we
shall have a 
similar feeling of reality which will yield us content. 
The illusions of earth, though lessened, are not escaped from in
the lower 
heavens, though contact is more real and more immediate. For it
must never be 
forgotten that these heavens are part of a great evolutionary
scheme, and, until 
man has found the real Self, his own unreality makes him subject to
illusions. 
One thing however, which produces the feeling of reality in
earth-life and of 
unreality when we study Devachan, is that we look at earth-life
from within, 
under the full sway of its illusions, while we contemplate Devachan
from 
outside, free for the time from its veil of Mâyâ. 
In Devachan the process is reversed, and its inhabitants feel their
own life to 
be the real one and look on the earth-life as full of the most
patent illusions 
and misconceptions. On the whole, they are nearer to the truth than
the physical 
critics of their heaven-world. 
Next, the Thinker – being clad only in the mental body and being in
the 
untrammelled exercise of its powers – manifests the creative nature
of these 
powers in a way and to an extent that down here we can hardly
realise. On earth 
a painter, a sculptor, a musician, dreams, dreams of exquisite
beauty, creating 
their visions by the powers of the mind ; but when they seek to
embody them in 
the coarse materials of earth they fall far short of the mental
creation. The 
marble is too resistant for perfect form, the pigments to muddy for
perfect 
colour. 
In heaven, all they think, is at once reproduced in form, for the
rare and 
subtle matter of the heaven-world is mind stuff, the medium in
which the mind 
normally works when free from passion, and it takes shape with
every mental 
impulse. Each man, therefore, in a very real sense, makes his own
heaven, and 
the beauty of his surroundings is definitely increased, according
to the wealth 
and energy of his mind. As the soul develops his powers, his heaven
grows more 
and more subtle and exquisite; all the limitations in heaven are
self-created, 
and heaven expands and deepens with the expansion and deepening of
the soul. 
While the soul is weak and selfish, narrow and ill-developed, his
heaven shares 
these pettinesses; but it is always the best that is in the soul,
however poor 
that best may be. As the man evolves, his devachanic lives become
fuller, 
richer, more and more real, and advanced souls come into ever
closer and closer 
contact with each other, enjoying wider and deeper intercourse. 
A life on earth, thin, feeble, vapid, and narrow, mentally and
morally, produces 
a comparatively thin, feeble, vapid and narrow life in Devachan,
where only the 
mental and the moral survive. We cannot have more than we are, and
our harvest 
is according to our sowing. "Be not deceived; God is not
mocked ; for whatsoever 
a man soweth, that,"- and neither more nor less, - "shall
he also reap." Our 
indolence and greediness would fain reap where we have not sown,
but in this 
universe of law, the Good Law, mercifully just, brings to each the
exact wages 
of his work. 
The mental impressions, or mental pictures, we make of our friends
will dominate 
us in Devachan. Round each soul throng those he loved in life, and
every image 
of the loved ones that live in the heart becomes a living companion
of the soul 
in heaven. And they are unchanged. They will be to us there as they
were here, 
and no otherwise. The outer semblance of our friend as it affected
our senses, 
we form out of mind-stuff in Devachan by the creative powers of the
mind; what 
was here a mental picture is there – as in truth it was here,
although we knew 
it not – an objective shape in living mind-stuff, abiding in our
own mental 
atmosphere ; only what is dull and dreamy here is forcibly living
and vivid 
there. 
And with regard to the true communion, that of the soul with soul?
That is 
closer, nearer, dearer than anything we know here, for, as we have
seen, there 
is no barrier on the mental plane between soul and soul; exactly in
proportion 
to the reality of the soul-life in us is the reality of
soul-communion there ; 
the mental image of our friend is our own creation ; his form is as
we knew and 
loved it ; and his soul breathes through that form to ours just to
the extent 
that his soul and ours can throb in sympathetic vibration. 
But we can have no touch with those we knew on earth if the ties
were only of 
the physical or astral body, or if they and we were discordant in
the inner life 
; therefore into our Devachan no enemy can enter, for sympathetic
accord of 
minds and hearts can alone draw men together there. Separateness of
heart and 
mind means separation in the heavenly life, for all that is lower
than the heart 
and mind can find no means of expression there. With those who are
far beyond us 
in evolution we come into contact just as far as we can respond to
them ; great 
ranges of their being will stretch beyond our ken, but all that we
can touch is 
ours. Further, these greater ones can and do aid us in the heavenly
life, under 
conditions we shall study presently, helping us to grow towards
them, and thus 
be able to receive more and more. There is then no separation by
space or time, 
but there is separation by absence of sympathy, by lack of accord
between hearts 
and minds. 
In heaven we are with all whom we love and with all whom we admire,
and we 
commune with them to the limit of our capacity, or, if we are more
advanced, of 
theirs. We meet them in the forms we loved on earth, with perfect
memory of our 
earthly relationships, for heaven is the flowering of all earth’s
buds, and the 
marred and feeble loves of earth expand into beauty and power
there. The 
communion being direct, no misunderstandings of words or thoughts
can arise ; 
each sees the thought his friend creates, or as much of it as he
can respond to. 
Devachan, the heaven-world, is a world of bliss, of joy unspeakable.
But it is 
much more than this, much more than a rest for the weary. In
Devachan all that 
was valuable in the mental and moral experiences of the Thinker
during the life 
just ended is worked out, meditated over, and is gradually
transmuted into 
definite mental and moral faculty, into powers which he will take
with him to 
his next rebirth. He does not work into the mental body the actual
memory of the 
past, for the mental body will, in due course, disintegrate ; the
memory of the 
past abides only in the Thinker himself, who has lived through it
and who 
endures. But these facts of past experiences are worked into mental
capacity, so 
that if a man has studied a subject deeply the effects of that
study will be the 
creation of a special faculty to acquire and master that subject
when it is 
first presented to him in another incarnation. 
He will be born with a special aptitude for that line of study, and
will pick it 
up with great facility. Everything thought upon earth is thus
utilised in 
Devachan ; every aspiration is worked up into power ; all
frustrated efforts 
become faculties and abilities ; struggles and defeats reappear as
materials to 
be wrought into instruments of victory ; sorrows and errors shine
luminous as 
precious metals to be worked up into wise and well-directed
volitions. 
Schemes of beneficence, for which power and skill to accomplish
were lacking in 
the past, are in Devachan worked out in thought, acted out, as it
were, stage by 
stage, and the necessary power and skill are developed as faculties
of the mind 
to be put into use in a future life on earth, when the clever and
earnest 
student shall be reborn as a genius, when the devotee shall be
reborn as a 
saint. Life then, in Devachan, is no mere dream, no lotus-land of
purposeless 
idling ; it is the land in which the mind and heart develop,
unhindered by gross 
matter and by the trivial cares, where weapons are forged for
earth’s fierce 
battlefields, and where the progress of the future is secured. 
When the Thinker has consumed in the mental body all the fruits
belonging to it 
of his earthly life, he shakes it off and dwells unencumbered in
his own place. 
All the mental faculties which express themselves on the lower
levels are drawn 
within the causal body – with the germs of the passional life that
were drawn 
into the mental body when it left the astral shell to disintegrate
in Kâmaloka – 
and these become latent for a time, lying within the causal body,
forces which 
remain concealed for lack of material in which to manifest. (The
thoughtful 
student may here find a fruitful suggestion on the problem of
continuing 
consciousness after the cycle of the universe is trodden. Let him
place Îshvara 
in the place of the Thinker, and let the faculties that are the
fruits of a life 
represent the human lives that are the fruits of a Universe. He may
then catch 
some glimpse of what is necessary for consciousness, during the
interval between 
universes). 
The mental body, the last of the temporary vestures of the true
man, 
disintegrates, and its materials return to the general matter of
the mental 
plane, whence they were drawn when the Thinker last descended into
incarnation. 
Thus the causal body alone remains, the receptacle and
treasure-house of all 
that has been assimilated from the life that is over. The Thinker
has finished a 
round of his long pilgrimage and dwells for a while in his own
native land. 
His condition as to consciousness depends entirely on the point he
has reached 
in evolution. In his early stages of life he will merely sleep,
wrapped in 
unconsciousness, when he has lost his vehicles on the lower planes.
His life 
will pulse gently within him, assimilating any little results from
his closed 
earth-existence that may be capable of entering into his substance
; but he will 
have no consciousness of his surroundings. But as he develops, this
period of 
his life becomes more and more important, and occupies a greater
proportion of 
his Devachanic existence. 
He becomes self-conscious, and thereby conscious of his
surroundings – of the 
not-self – and his memory spreads before him the panorama of his
life, 
stretching backwards into the ages of the past. He sees the causes
that worked 
out their effects in the last of his life-experiences, and studies
the causes he 
has set going in this latest incarnation. He assimilates and works
into the 
texture of the causal body all that was noblest and loftiest in the
closed 
chapter of his life, and by his inner activity he develops and
co-ordinates the 
materials in his causal body. He comes into direct contact with
great souls, 
whether in or out of the body at the time, enjoys communion with
them, learns 
from their riper wisdom and longer experience. 
Each succeeding devachanic life is richer and deeper ; with his
expanding 
capacity to receive, knowledge flows into him in fuller tides ;
more and more he 
learns to understand the workings of the law, the conditions of
evolutionary 
progress, and thus returns to earth-life each time with greater
knowledge, more 
effective power, his vision of the goal of life becoming ever
clearer and the 
way to it more plain before his feet. 
To every Thinker, however unprogressed, there comes a moment of
clear vision 
when the time arrives for his return to the life of the lower
worlds. For a 
moment he sees his past and the causes working from it into the
future, and the 
general map of his next incarnation is also unrolled before him.
Then the clouds 
of lower matter surge round him and obscure his vision, and the
cycle of another 
incarnation begins with the awakening of the powers of the lower
mind, and their 
drawing round him, by their vibrations, materials from the lower
mental plane to 
form the new mental body for the opening chapter of his
life-history. This part 
of our subject, however, belongs in its detail to the chapters on
reincarnation. 
We left the soul asleep, (See Chapter III., On Kâmaloka, ) having
shaken off the 
last remains of his astral body, ready to pass out of Kâmaloka into
Devachan, 
out of purgatory into heaven. The sleeper awakens to a sense of joy
unspeakable, 
of bliss immeasurable, of peace that passeth understanding. Softest
melodies are 
breathing round him, tenderest hues greet his opening eyes, the
very air seems 
music and colour, the whole being is suffused with light and
harmony. 
Then through the golden haze dawn sweetly the faces loved on earth,
etherialised 
into the beauty which expresses their noblest, loveliest emotions,
unmarred by 
the troubles and the passions of the lower worlds. Who may tell the
bliss of 
that awakening, the glory of that first dawning of the
heaven-world? 
We will now study the conditions in detail of the seven
subdivisions of 
Devachan, remembering that in the four lower we are in the world of
form, and a 
world, moreover, in which every thought presents itself at once as
a form. This 
world of form belongs to the personality, and every soul is
therefore surrounded 
by as much of his past life as has entered into his mind and can be
expressed in 
pure mind-stuff. 
The first, or lowest, region is the heaven of the least progressed
souls, whose 
highest emotion on earth was a narrow, sincere, and sometimes
selfish love for 
family and friends. Or it may be that they felt some loving
admiration for some 
one they met on earth who was purer and better than themselves, or
felt some 
wish to lead a higher life, or some passing aspiration towards
mental and moral 
expansion. 
There is not much material here out of which faculty can be
moulded, and their 
life is but very slightly progressive ; their family affections
will be 
nourished and a little widened, and they will be reborn after a
while with a 
somewhat improved emotional nature, with more tendency to recognise
and respond 
to a higher ideal. Meanwhile they are enjoying all the happiness
they can 
receive; their cup is but a small one, but it is filled to the brim
with bliss, 
and they enjoy all that they are able to conceive of heaven. Its
purity, its 
harmony, play on their undeveloped faculties and woo them to awaken
into 
activity, and the inner stirrings begin which must precede any
manifested 
budding. 
The next division of devachanic life comprises men and women of
every religious 
faith whose hearts during their earthly lives had turned with
loving devotion to 
God, under any name, under any form. The form may have been narrow,
but the 
heart rose up in aspiration, and here finds the object of its
loving worship. 
The concept of the Divine which was formed by their mind when on
earth here 
meets them in the radiant glory of devachanic matter, fairer,
diviner, than 
their wildest dreams. 
The Divine One limits Himself to meet the intellectual limits of
His worshipper, 
and in whatever form the worshipper has loved and worshipped Him,
in that form 
He reveals Himself to his longing eyes, and pours out on him the
sweetness of 
His answering love. The souls are steeped in religious ecstasy,
worshipping the 
One under the forms their piety sought on earth, losing themselves
in the 
raptures of devotion, in communion with the Object they adore. No
one finds 
himself a stranger in the heavenly places, the Divine veiling
Himself in the 
familiar form. Such souls grow in purity and in devotion under the
sun of this 
communion, and return to earth with these qualities much
intensified. Nor is all 
their devachanic life spent in this devotional ecstasy, for they
have full 
opportunities of maturing every other quality they may possess of
heart and 
mind. 
Passing onwards to the third region, we come to those noble and
earnest beings 
who were devoted servants of humanity while on earth, and largely
poured out 
their love to God in the form of works for man. They are reaping
the reward of 
their good deeds by developing larger powers of usefulness and
increased wisdom 
in their direction. Plans of wider beneficence unroll themselves
before the mind 
of the philanthropist, and like an architect, he designs the future
edifice 
which he will build in a coming life on earth ; he matures the
schemes which he 
will then work out into actions, and like a creative God plans his
universe of 
benevolence, which shall be manifested in gross matter when the
time is ripe. 
These souls will appear as the great philanthropists of yet unborn
centuries, 
who will incarnate on earth with innate dower of unselfish love and
of power to 
achieve. 
Most varied in character, perhaps, of all the heavens is the
fourth, for here 
the powers of the most advanced souls find their exercise, so far
as they can be 
expressed in the world of form. Here the kings of art and of
literature are 
found, exercising all their powers of form, of colour, of harmony,
and building 
greater faculties with which to be reborn when they return to
earth. Noblest 
music, ravishing beyond description, peals forth from the mightiest
monarchs of 
harmony that the earth has known, as Beethoven, no longer deaf,
pours out his 
imperial soul in strains of unexampled beauty, making even the
heaven world more 
melodious as he draws down harmonies from higher spheres, and sends
them 
thrilling through the heavenly places. Here also we find the
masters of painting 
and of sculpture, learning new hues of colour, new curves of
undreamed beauty. 
And here also are others who failed, though greatly aspiring, and
who are here 
transmuting longings into powers, and dreams into faculties, that
shall be 
theirs in another life. Searchers into Nature are here, and they
are learning 
her hidden secrets ; before their eyes are unrolling systems of
worlds with all 
their hidden mechanism, woven series of workings of unimaginable
delicacy and 
complexity ; they shall return to earth as great "discoverers,"
with unerring 
intuitions of the mysterious ways of Nature. 
In this heaven also are found students of the deeper knowledge, the
eager, 
reverent pupils who sought the Teachers of the race, who longed to
find a 
Teacher, and patiently worked at all that had been given out by
some one of the 
great spiritual Masters who have taught humanity. Here their
longings find their 
fruition, and Those they sought, apparently in vain, are now their
instructors ; 
the eager souls drink in the heavenly wisdom, and swift their
growth and 
progress as they sit at their Master’s feet. As teachers and as
light-bringers 
shall they be born again on earth, born with the birthmark of the
teacher’s high 
office upon them. 
Many a student on earth, all unknowing of these subtler workings,
is preparing 
himself a place in this fourth heaven, as he bends with a real
devotion over the 
pages of some teacher of genius, over the teachings of some
advanced soul. He is 
forming a link between himself and the teacher he loves and
reverences, and in 
the heaven-world that soul-tie will assert itself, and draw
together into 
communion the souls it links. As the sun pours down its rays into
many rooms, 
and each room has all it can contain of the solar beams, so in the
heaven-world 
do these great souls shine into hundreds of mental images of
themselves created 
by their pupils, fill them with life, with their own essence, so
that each 
student has his master to teach him and yet shuts out none other
from his aid. 
Thus, for periods long in proportion to the materials gathered for
consumption 
upon earth, dwell men in these heaven-worlds of form, where all
good that the 
last personal life had garnered finds its full fruition, its full
working out 
into minutest detail. Then as we have seen, when everything is
exhausted, when 
the last drop has been drained from the cup of joy, the last crumb
eaten of the 
heavenly feast, all that has been worked up into faculty, that is
of permanent 
value, is drawn within the causal body, and the Thinker shakes off
him and the 
then disintegrating body through which he has found expression on
the lower 
levels of the devachanic world. Rid of this mental body, he is in
his own world, 
to work up whatever of his harvest can find material suitable for
it in that 
high realm. 
A vast number of souls touch the lowest level of the formless world
as it were 
but for a moment, taking brief refuge there, since all lower
vehicles have 
fallen away. But so embryonic are they that they have as yet no
active powers 
that there can function independently, and they become unconscious
as the mental 
body slips away into disintegration. Then, for a moment, they are
aroused to 
consciousness, and a flash of memory illumines their past and they
see its 
pregnant causes ; and a flash of foreknowledge illumines their
future, and they 
see such effects as will work out in the coming life. This is all
that very many 
are as yet able to experience of the formless world. For, here
again, as ever, 
the harvest is according to the sowing, and how should they who
have sowed 
nothing for that lofty region expect to reap any harvest therein? 
But many souls have during their earth-life, by deep thinking and
noble living, 
sown much seed, the harvest of which belongs to this fifth
devachanic region, 
the lowest of the three heavens of the formless world. Great is now
their reward 
for having so risen above the bondage of the flesh and of passion,
and they 
begin to experience the real life of man, the lofty existence of
the soul 
itself, unfettered by vestures belonging to the lower worlds. They
learn truths 
by direct vision, and see the fundamental causes of which all
concrete objects 
are the results; they study the underlying unities, whose presence
is marked in 
the lower worlds by the variety of irrelevant details. 
Thus they gain a deep knowledge of law, and learn to recognise its
changeless 
workings below results apparently the most incongruous, thus
building into the 
body that endures firm unshakable convictions, that will reveal
themselves in 
earth-life as deep intuitive certainties of the soul, above and
beyond all 
reasoning. Here also the man studies his own past, and carefully
disentangles 
the causes he has set going ; he marks their interaction, the
resultants 
accruing from them, and sees something of their working out in the
lives yet in 
the future. 
In the sixth heaven are more advanced souls, who during earth-life
had felt but 
little attraction for its passing shows, and who had devoted all
their energies 
to the higher intellectual and moral life. For them there is no
veil upon the 
past, their memory is perfect and unbroken, and they plan the
infusion into 
their next life of energies that will neutralise many of the forces
that are 
working for hindrance, and strengthen many of those that are
working for good. 
This clear memory enables them to form definite and strong
determinations as to 
actions which are to be done and actions which are to be avoided,
and these 
volitions they will be able to impress on their lower vehicles in
their next 
birth, making certain classes of evils impossible, contrary to what
is felt to 
be the deepest nature, and certain kinds of good inevitable, the
irresistible 
demands of a voice that will not be denied. 
These souls are born into the world with high and noble qualities
which render a 
base life impossible, and stamp the babe from its cradle as one of
the pioneers 
of humanity. The man who has attained to this sixth heaven sees
unrolled before 
him the vast treasures of the Divine Mind in creative activity and
can study the 
archetypes of all forms that are being gradually evolved in the
lower worlds. 
There he may bathe himself in the fathomless ocean of the Divine
Wisdom, and 
unravel the problems connected with the working out of those
archetypes, the 
partial good that seems as evil to the limited vision of men
encased in flesh. 
In this wider outlook, phenomena assume their due relative proportions,
and he 
sees the justification of the divine ways, no longer to him
"past finding out" 
so far as they are concerned with the evolution of the lower
worlds. 
The questions over which on earth he pondered, and whose answers
ever eluded his 
eager intellect, are here solved by an insight that pierces through
phenomenal 
veils and sees the connecting links which make the chain complete.
Here also the 
soul is in the immediate presence of, and in full communion with,
the greater 
souls that have evolved in our humanity, and, escaped from the
bonds which make 
"the past" of earth, he enjoys "the
ever-present" of an endless and unbroken 
life. 
Those we speak of here as "the mighty dead" are there the
glorious living, and 
the soul enjoys the high rapture of their presence, and grows more
like them as 
their strong harmony attunes his vibrant nature to their key. 
Yet higher, lovelier, gleams the seventh heaven, where Masters and
Initiates 
have their intellectual home. No soul can dwell there ere yet is
has passed 
while on earth through the narrow gateway of Initiation, the strait
gate that 
"leadeth unto life" unending. ( See Chapter XI, on
"Man’s Ascent." The Initiate 
has stepped out of the ordinary line of evolution, and is treading
a shorter and 
steeper road to human perfection). 
That world is the source of the strongest intellectual and moral
impulses that 
flow down to earth ; thence are poured forth the invigorating
streams of the 
loftiest energy. The intellectual life of the world has there its
root; thence 
genius receives its purest inspirations. To the souls that dwell
there it 
matters little whether, at the time, they be or be not connected
with the lower 
vehicles ; they ever enjoy their lofty self-consciousness and their
communion 
with those around them ; whether, when "embodied" they
suffuse their lower 
vehicles with as much of this consciousness as they can contain is
a matter for 
their own choice – they can give or withhold as they will. 
And more and more their volitions are guided by the will of the
Great Ones, 
whose will is one with the will of the LOGOS, the will which seeks
ever the good 
of the worlds. For here are being eliminated the last vestiges of
separateness – 
( Ahamkâra, the " I " making principle, necessary in
order that self 
consciousness may be evolved, but transcended when its work is
over) – in all 
who have not yet reached final emancipation – all, that is, who are
not yet 
Masters – and, as these perish, the will becomes more and more
harmonised with 
the will that guides the worlds. 
Such is an outline of the "seven heavens" into one or
other of which men pass in 
due time after the "change that men call death." For
death is only a change that 
gives the soul a partial liberation, releasing him from the
heaviest of his 
chains. It is but a birth into a wider life, a return after a brief
exile on 
earth to the soul’s true home, a passing from a prison into the
freedom of the 
upper air. Death is the greatest of earth’s illusions ; there is no
death, but 
only changes in life’s conditions. Life is continuous, unbroken,
unbreakable ; 
"unborn, eternal, constant," it perishes not with the
perishing of the bodies 
that clothe it. We might as well think that the sky is falling when
a pot is 
broken, as imagine that the soul perishes when the body falls to
pieces. ( A 
simile used in the Bhagavad Purâna). 
The physical, astral and mental planes are "the three
worlds" though which lies 
the pilgrimage of the soul, again and again repeated. In these
three worlds 
revolves the wheel of human life, and souls are bound to that wheel
throughout 
their evolution, and are carried by it to each of these worlds in
turn. We are 
now in a position to trace a complete life-period of the soul, the
aggregate of 
these periods making up its life, and we can also distinguish
clearly the 
difference between personality and individuality. 
A soul when its stay in the formless world of Devachan is over,
begins a new 
life-period by putting forth the energies which function in the
form-world of 
the mental plane, these energies being the resultant of the
preceding 
life-periods. These passing outwards, gather round themselves, from
the matter 
of the four lower mental levels, such materials as are suitable for
their 
expression, and thus the new mental body for the coming birth is
formed. The 
vibration of these mental energies arouses the energies which
belong to the 
desire-nature, and these begin to vibrate ; as they awake and throb,
they 
attract to themselves suitable materials for their expression from
the matter of 
the astral world, and these form the new astral body for the
approaching 
incarnation. 
Thus the Thinker becomes clothed with his mental and astral
vestures, exactly 
expressing the faculties evolved during the past stage of his life.
He is drawn, 
by forces which will be explained later, (See Chapter VII , on
"Reincarnation") 
to the family which is to provide him with a suitable physical
encasement, and 
becomes connected with this encasement through his astral body. 
During prenatal life the mental body becomes involved with the
lower vehicles, 
and this connection becomes closer and closer through the early
years of 
childhood, until at the seventh year they are as completely in
touch with the 
Thinker himself as the stage of evolution permits. He then begins
to slightly 
control his vehicles, if sufficiently advanced, and what we call
conscience is 
his monitory voice. In any case, he gathers experience through these
vehicles, 
and during the continuance of earth-life, stores the gathered
experience in its 
own proper vehicle, in the body connected with the plane to which
the experience 
belongs. 
When the earth-life is over the physical body drops away, and with
it his power 
of contacting the physical world, and his energies are therefore
confined to the 
astral and mental planes. In due course, the astral body decays,
and the 
outgoings of his life are confined to the mental plane, the astral
faculties 
being gathered up and laid by within himself as latent energies. 
Once again, in due course, its assimilative work completed, the
mental body 
disintegrates, its energies in turn becoming latent in the Thinker,
and he 
withdraws his life entirely into the formless devachanic world, his
own native 
habitat. Thence, all experiences of his life period in the three
worlds being 
transmuted into faculties and powers for future use, are contained
within 
himself, he anew commences his pilgrimage and treads the cycle of another
life-period with increased power and knowledge. 
The personality consists of the transitory vehicles through which
the Thinker 
energises in the physical, astral, and lower mental worlds, and of
all the 
activities connected with these. These are bound together by the
links of memory 
caused by impressions made on the three lower bodies ; and, by the 
self-identification of the Thinker with his three vehicles, the
personal " I " 
is set up. In the lower stages of evolution this " I " is
in the physical and 
passional vehicles, in which the greatest activity is shown, later
it is in the 
mental vehicle, which then assumes predominance. 
The personality with its transient feeling, desires, passions, thus
forms a 
quasi-independent entity, though drawing all its energies from the
Thinker it 
enwraps, and as its qualifications, belonging to the lower worlds,
are often in 
direct antagonism to the permanent interests of the "Dweller
in the body," 
conflict is set up in which victory inclines sometimes to the
temporary 
pleasure, sometimes to the permanent gain. The life of the
personality begins 
when the Thinker forms his new mental body, and it endures until
that mental 
body disintegrates at the close of its life in the form-world of
Devachan. 
The individuality consists of the Thinker himself, the immortal
tree that puts 
out all these personalities as leaves, to last through the spring,
summer and 
autumn of human life. All that the leaves take in and assimilate
enriches the 
sap that courses through their veins, and in the autumn this is
withdrawn into 
the parent trunk, and the dry leaf falls and perishes. The Thinker
alone lives 
forever ; he is the man for whom "the hour never
strikes," the eternal youth who 
as the Bhagavad Gitâ has it, puts on and casts off bodies as a man
puts on new 
garments and throws off the old. 
Each personality is a new part for the immortal Actor, and he
treads the stage 
of life over and over again, only in the life-drama each character
he assumes is 
the child of the preceding ones and the father of those to come, so
that the 
life-drama is a continuous history, the history of the Actor who
plays the 
successive parts. 
To the three worlds that we have studied is confined the life of
the Thinker, 
while he is treading the earlier stages of human evolution. A time
will come in 
the evolution of humanity when its feet will enter loftier realms,
and 
reincarnation will be of the past. But while the wheel of rebirth
and death is 
turning, a man is bound thereon by desires that pertain to the
three worlds, his 
life is led in these three regions. 
To the realms that lie beyond we now may turn, albeit but little
can be said of 
them that can be either useful or intelligible. Such little as may
be said, 
however, is necessary for the outlining of the Ancient Wisdom. 
THE BUDDHIC AND NIRVÂNIC PLANES
We have seen that man is an intelligent self-conscious entity, the
Thinker, clad 
in bodies belonging to the lower mental, astral and physical planes
; we have 
now to study the Spirit which is his innermost Self, the source
whence he 
proceeds. 
This Divine spirit, a ray from the LOGOS, partaking of His own
essential Being, 
has the triple nature of the LOGOS Himself, and the evolution of
man as man 
consists in the gradual manifestation of these three aspects, their
development 
from latency into activity, man thus repeating in miniature the
evolution of the 
universe. 
Hence he is spoken of as the microcosm, the universe being the
macrocosm; he is 
called the mirror of the universe, the image, or reflection, of God
; ( "Let us 
make man in our image, after our likeness." – Gen. I, 26. ) –
and hence also the 
ancient axiom, "As above, so below." It is this in-folded
deity that is the 
guarantee of man’s final triumph ; this is the hidden motive power
that makes 
evolution at once possible and inevitable, the upward-lifting force
that slowly 
overcomes every obstacle and every difficulty. It was this Presence
that Matthew 
Arnold dimly ( ) sensed when he wrote of the "Power, not
ourselves, that makes 
for righteousness," but he erred in thinking "not
ourselves," for it is the very 
innermost Self of all – truly not our separated selves, but our
Self. (Âtma, the 
reflection of Paramâtmâ.) 
This Self is the One, and hence is spoken of as the Monad – ( It is
called the 
Monad, whether it be the Monad of spirit-matter, Âtma ; or the
Monad of form or 
the human Monad, Âtma-Buddhi-Manas. In each it is a unit and acts
as a unit, 
whether the unit be one-faced, two-faced, or three-faced) – and we
shall need to 
remember that this Monad is the outbreathed life of the LOGOS,
containing within 
itself germinally, or in a state of latency, all the divine powers
and 
attributes. 
These powers are brought into manifestation by the impacts arising
from contact 
with the objects of the universe into which the Monad is thrown ;
the friction 
caused by these gives rise to responsive thrills from the life
subjected to 
their stimuli, and one by one the energies of the life pass from
latency into 
activity. The human Monad – as it is called for the sake of
distinction – shows 
as we have already said, the three aspects of Deity, being the
perfect image of 
God, and in the human cycle these three aspects are developed one
after the 
other. 
These aspects are the three great attributes of the Divine Life as
manifested in 
the universe, existence, bliss, and intelligence – ( Satchitânanda
is often used 
in the Hindu Scriptures as the abstract name of Brahman, the
Trimûrti being the 
concrete manifestation of these) –the three LOGOI severally showing
these forth 
with all the perfection possible within the limits of
manifestation. 
In man, these aspects are developed in the reversed order –
intelligence, bliss, 
existence – "existence" implying the manifestation of the
divine powers. In the 
evolution of man that we have so far studied we have been watching
the 
development of the third aspect of the hidden deity – the
development of 
consciousness as intelligence. Manas, the Thinker, the human Soul,
is the image 
of the Universal Mind, of the Third LOGOS, and all his long
pilgrimage on the 
three lower planes is devoted to the evolution of this third
aspect, the 
intellectual side of the divine nature in man. 
While this is proceeding, we may consider the other divine energies
as rather 
brooding over the man, the hidden source of his life, than as
actively 
developing their forces within him. They play within themselves,
unmanifest. 
Still, the preparation of these forces for manifestation is slowly
proceeding; 
they are being roused from that unmanifested life that we speak of
as latency by 
the ever-increasing energy of the vibrations of the intelligence,
and the 
bliss-aspect begins to send outwards its first vibrations – faint
pulsings of 
its manifested life thrill forth. 
This bliss-aspect is named in theosophical terminology Buddhi, a
name derived 
from the Sanskrit word for wisdom, and it belongs to the fourth, or
buddhic 
plane of our universe, the plane, in which there is still duality,
but were 
there is no separation. Words fail me to convey the idea, for words
belong to 
the lower planes where duality and separation are ever connected,
yet some 
approach to the idea may be gained. 
It is a state in which each is himself, with a clearness and vivid
intensity 
which cannot be approached on lower planes, and yet in which each
feels himself 
to include all others, to be one with them, inseparate and
inseparable. (The 
reader should refer back to the Introduction, p. 36, and reread the
description 
given by Plotinus of this state, commencing: "They likewise
see all things." And 
he should note the phrases, "Each likewise is
everything," and "In each, however 
a different quality predominates.) 
Its nearest analogy on earth is the condition between two persons
who are united 
by a pure, intense love, which makes them feel as one person,
causing them to 
think, feel, act, live as one, recognising no barrier, no
difference, no mine 
and thine, no separation. (It is for this reason that the bliss of
divine love 
has in many Scriptures been imaged by the profound love of husband
and wife, as 
in the Bhagavad Purâna of the Hindus, the Song of Solomon of the
Hebrews and 
Christians. This is also the love of the Sufi mystics, and indeed
of all 
mystics.) 
It is a faint echo from this plane which makes men seek happiness
by union 
between themselves and the object of their desire, no matter what
that object 
may be. Perfect isolation is perfect misery ; to be stripped naked
of 
everything, to be hanging in the void of space, in utter solitude,
nothing 
anywhere save the lone individual, shut out from all, shut into the
separated 
self – imagination can conceive no horror more intense. The
antithesis to this 
is union, and perfect union is perfect bliss. 
As this bliss-aspect of the Self begins to send outwards its
vibrations, these 
vibrations, as on the planes below, draw round themselves the
matter of the 
plane on which they are functioning, and thus is formed gradually
the buddhic 
body, or bliss-body, as it is appropriately termed.
(Ânandamayakosha, or 
bliss-sheath, of the Vedântins. It is also the body of the sun, the
solar body, 
of which a little is said in the Upanishads and elsewhere.) 
The only way in which the man can contribute to the building of
this glorious 
form is by cultivating pure, unselfish, all-embracing, beneficent
love, love 
"that seeketh not its own" – that is, love that is
neither partial, nor seeks 
any return for its outflowing. This spontaneous outpouring of love
is the most 
marked of the divine attributes, the love that gives everything,
that asks 
nothing. Pure love brought the universe into being, pure love
maintains it, pure 
love draws it upwards towards perfection, towards bliss. 
And wherever man pours out love on all who need it, making no
difference, 
seeking no return, from pure spontaneous joy in the outpouring,
there that man 
is developing the bliss-aspect of the Deity within him, and is
preparing that 
body of beauty and joy ineffable into which the Thinker will rise,
casting away 
the limits of separateness, to find himself, and yet one with all
that lives. 
This "the house not made with hands, eternal in the
heavens," whereof wrote St. 
Paul, the great Christian Initiate ; and he raised charity, pure
love, above all 
other virtues, because by that alone can man on earth contribute to
that 
glorious dwelling. For a similar reason is separateness called
"the great 
heresy" by the Buddhist, and "union" is the goal of
the Hindu ; liberation is 
the escape from the limitations that keep us apart, and selfishness
is the 
root-evil, the destruction whereof is the destruction of all pain. 
The fifth plane, the Nirvânic, is the plane of the highest human
aspect of the 
God within us, and this aspect is named by theosophists Âtmâ, or
the Self. It is 
the plane of pure existence, of divine powers in their fullest
manifestation in 
our fivefold universe – what lies beyond on the sixth and seventh
planes is 
hidden in the unimaginable light of God. 
This âtmic, or nirvânic, consciousness, the consciousness belonging
to life on 
the fifth plane, is the consciousness attained by those lofty Ones,
the first 
fruits of humanity, who have already completed the cycle of human
evolution, and 
who are called Masters. (Known as Mahâtmâs, great Spirits, and
Jivanmuktas, 
liberated souls, who remain connected with physical bodies for the
helping of 
humanity. Many other great Beings also live on the nirvânic plane.)
They have 
solved in Themselves the problem of uniting the essence of
individuality with 
non-separateness, and live, immortal Intelligences, perfect in
wisdom, in bliss, 
in power. 
When the human Monad comes forth from the LOGOS, it is as though
from the 
luminous ocean of Âtmâ a tiny thread of light was separated off
from the rest by 
a film of buddhic matter, and from this hung a spark which becomes
enclosed in 
an egg-like casing of matter belonging to the formless levels of
the mental 
plane. 
"The spark hangs from the flame by the finest thread of
Fohat." ( Book of Dzyan, 
Stanza vii, 5, ; Secret Doctrine, vol. I, p. 66, 1893 ed. ; p. 98
Adyar Edition) 
As evolution proceeds, this luminous egg grows larger and more
opalescent, and 
the tiny thread becomes a wider and wider channel through which
more and more of 
the âtmic life pours down. Finally, they merge – the third with the
second, and 
the twain with the first, as flame merges with flame and no
separation can be 
seen. 
The evolution of the fourth and fifth planes belongs to a future
period of our 
race, but those who choose the harder path of swifter progress may
tread it even 
now, as will be explained later. (see Chapter XI, on "Man’s
Ascent.") On that 
path the bliss body is quickly evolved, and a man begins to enjoy
the 
consciousness of that loftier region, and knows the bliss which
comes from the 
absence of separative barriers, the wisdom which flows in when the
limits of the 
intellect are transcended. Then is the wheel escaped from which
binds the soul 
in the lower worlds, and then is the first foretaste of the liberty
which is 
found perfected on the nirvânic plane. 
The nirvânic consciousness is the antithesis of annihilation; it is
existence 
raised to a vividness and intensity inconceivable to those who know
only the 
life of the senses and the mind. As the farthing rush-light to the
splendour of 
the sun at noon, so is the nirvânic to the earth-bound
consciousness, and to 
regard it as an annihilation because the limits of the earthly
consciousness 
have vanished, is as though a man, knowing only the rush-light,
should say that 
light could not exist without a wick immersed in tallow. That
Nirvâna is, has 
been born witness to in the past in the Scriptures of the world by
Those who 
enjoy it and live its glorious life, and is still borne witness to
by others of 
our race who have climbed that lofty ladder of perfected humanity,
and who 
remain in touch with earth that the feet of our ascending race may
mount its 
rungs unfalteringly. 
In Nirvâna dwell the mighty Beings who accomplished Their own human
evolution in 
past universes, and who came forth with the LOGOS when He
manifested Himself to 
bring this universe into existence. They are His ministers in the
administration 
of the worlds, the perfect agents of His will. The Lords of all the
hierarchies 
of the Gods and lower ministrants that we have seen working on the
lower planes 
have here Their abiding-place, for Nirvâna is the heart of the
universe, whence 
all its life-currents proceed. Hence the Great Breath comes forth,
the life of 
all, and thither it is indrawn when the universe has reached its
term. There is 
the Beatific Vision for which mystics long, there the unveiled
Glory, the 
Supreme Goal. 
The Brotherhood of Humanity – nay, the Brotherhood of all things –
has its sure 
foundation on the spiritual planes, the âtmic and buddhic, for here
alone is 
unity, and here alone perfect sympathy is found. The intellect is
the separative 
principle in man, that marks off the " I " from the
" not I ," that is conscious 
of itself, and sees all else as outside itself and alien. It is the
combative, 
struggling, self-assertive principle, and from the plane of the
intellect 
downwards the world presents a scene of conflict, bitter in
proportion as the 
intellect mingles in it. Even the passion-nature is only
spontaneously combative 
when it is stirred by the feeling of desire and finds anything
standing between 
itself and the object of its desires; it becomes more and more
aggressive as the 
mind inspires its activity, for then it seeks to provide for the
gratification 
of future desires, and tries to appropriate more and more from the
stores of 
Nature. 
But the intellect is spontaneously combative, its very nature being
to assert 
itself as different from others, and here we find the root of
separateness, the 
ever-springing source of divisions among men. 
But unity is at once felt when the buddhic plane is reached, as
though we 
stepped from a separate ray, diverging from all other rays, into
the sun itself, 
from which radiate all the rays alike. 
A being standing in the sun, suffused with its light, and pouring
it forth, 
would feel no difference between ray and ray, but would pour forth
along one as 
readily and easily as along another. And so with the man who has
once 
consciously attained the buddhic plane ; he feels the brotherhood
that others 
speak of as an ideal, and pours himself out into any one who wants
assistance, 
giving mental, moral, astral, physical help exactly as it is
needed. 
He sees all beings as himself, and feels that all he has is theirs
as much as 
his; nay, in many cases, as more theirs than his, because their
need is greater, 
their strength being less. So do the elder brothers in a family
bear the family 
burdens, and shield the little ones from suffering and privation ;
to the spirit 
of brotherhood weakness is a claim for help and loving protection,
not an 
opportunity for oppression. 
Because They had reached this level and mounted even higher, the
great Founders 
of religions have ever been marked by Their overwelling compassion
and 
tenderness, ministering to the physical as well as to the inner
wants of men, to 
every man according to his need. The consciousness of this inner
unity, the 
recognition of the One Self dwelling equally in all, is the one
sure foundation 
of Brotherhood ; all else save this is frangible. 
This recognition, moreover, is accompanied by the knowledge that
the stage in 
evolution reached by different human and non-human beings depends
chiefly on 
what we may call their age. Some began their journey in time very
much later 
than others, and, though the powers in each be the same, some have
unfolded far 
more of those powers than others, simply because they have had a
longer time for 
the process than their younger brethren. As well blame and despise
the seed 
because it is not yet a flower, the bud because it is not yet the
fruit, the 
babe because it is not yet the man, and blame and despise the
germinal and baby 
souls around us because they have not yet developed to the stage we
ourselves 
occupy. We do not blame ourselves because we are not yet as Gods ;
in time we 
shall stand where our elder Brothers are standing. 
Why should we blame the still younger souls who are not yet as we?
The very word 
brotherhood connotes identity of blood and inequality of
development ; and it 
therefore represents exactly the link between all creatures in the
universe – 
identity of the essential life, and difference in the stages
reached in the 
manifestation of that life. 
We are one in our origin, one in the method of our evolution, one in
our goal, 
and the differences of age and stature but give opportunity for the
growth of 
the tenderest and closest ties. All that a man would do for his
brother of the 
flesh, dearer to him than himself, is the measure of what he owes
to each who 
shares with him the one Life. Men are shut out from their brothers’
hearts by 
differences of race, of class, of country ; the man who is wise by
love rises 
above all these petty differences, and sees all drawing their life
from the one 
source, all as part of his family. 
The recognition of this Brotherhood intellectually, and the
endeavour to live it 
practically, are so stimulative of the higher nature of man, that
it was made 
the one obligatory object of the Theosophical Society, the single
"article of 
belief" that all who would enter its fellowship must accept.
To live it, even to 
a small extent, cleanses the heart and purifies the vision ; to
live it 
perfectly would be to eradicate all stain of separateness, and to
let the pure 
shining of the Self irradiate us, as a light through flawless
glass. 
Never let it be forgotten that this Brotherhood is, whether men
ignore it or 
deny it. Man’s ignorance does not change the laws of nature, nor
vary by one 
hair’s breadth her changeless, irresistible march. Her laws crush
those who 
oppose them, and break into pieces everything which is not in
harmony with them. 
Therefore can no nation endure that outrages Brotherhood, no
civilisation can 
last that is built on its antithesis. We have not to make
brotherhood ; it 
exists. We have to attune our lives into harmony with it, if we
desire that we 
and our works shall not perish. 
It may seem strange to some that the buddhic plane – a thing to
them misty and 
unreal – should thus influence all planes below it, and that its
forces should 
ever break into pieces all that cannot harmonise itself with them
in the lower 
worlds. Yet so it is, for this universe is an expression of
spiritual forces, 
and they are the guiding, moulding energies pervading all things,
and slowly, 
surely, subduing all things to themselves. 
Hence this Brotherhood, which is a spiritual unity, is a far more
real thing 
than any outward organisation ; it is a life and not a form,
"wisely and sweetly 
ordering all things." It may take innumerable forms, suitable
to the times, but 
the life is one ; happy they who see its presence, and make
themselves the 
channels of its living force. 
The student has now before him the constituents of the human
constitution, and 
the regions to which these constituents respectively belong; so a
brief summary 
should enable him to have a clear idea of this complicated whole. 
The human Monad is Âtma-Buddhi-Manas, or, as sometimes translated,
the Spirit, 
the Spiritual Soul, and Soul, of man. The fact that these three are
but aspects 
of the Self makes possible man’s immortal existence, and though
these three 
aspects are manifested separately and successively, their
substantial unity 
renders it possible for the Soul to merge itself in the spiritual
Soul, giving 
to the latter the precious essence of individuality, and for this
individualised 
Spiritual Soul to merge itself in the Spirit, colouring it – if the
phrase may 
be permitted with the hues due to individuality, while leaving
uninjured its 
essential unity with all other rays of the LOGOS and with the LOGOS
Himself. 
These three form the seventh, sixth and fifth principles of man,
and the 
materials which limit and encase them, i.e., which make their manifestation
and 
activity possible, are drawn respectively from the fifth
(nirvânic), the fourth 
(buddhic), and the third (mental), planes of our universe. The
fifth principle 
further takes to itself a lower body on the mental plane, in order
to come into 
contact with the phenomenal worlds, and thus intertwines itself
with the fourth 
principle, the desire-nature, or Kâma, belonging to the second or
astral plane. 
Descending to the first, the physical plane, we have the third,
second and first 
principles – the specialised life, or Prâna ; the etheric double,
its vehicle ; 
the dense body, which contacts the coarser materials of the
physical world. We 
have already seen that sometimes Prâna is not regarded as a
"principle," and 
then the interwoven desire and mental bodies take rank together as
Kâma Manas ; 
the pure intellect is called the Higher Manas, and the mind apart
from desire 
Lower Manas. 
The most convenient conception of man is perhaps that which most
closely 
represents the facts as to the one permanent life and the various
forms in which 
it works and which condition its energies, causing the variety in
manifestation. 
Then we see the Self as the one Life, the source of all energies,
and the forms 
as the buddhic, causal, mental, astral, and physical (etheric and
dense) bodies. 
( Linga Sharira was the name originally given to the etheric body,
and must not 
be confused with the Linga Sharira of Hindu philosophy. Sthula
Sharira is the 
Sanskrit name for the dense body.) 
It will be seen that the difference is merely a question of names,
and that the 
sixth, fifth, fourth, and third "principles" are merely
Âtmâ working in the 
Buddhic, causal, mental and astral bodies, while the second and
first 
"principles " are the two lowest bodies themselves. This
sudden change in the 
method of naming is apt to cause confusion in the mind of the
student, and as 
H.P. Blavatsky, our revered teacher, expressed much dissatisfaction
with the 
then current nomenclature as confused and misleading, and desired
others and 
myself to try and improve it, the above names, as descriptive,
simple, and 
representing the facts, are here adopted. 
The various subtle bodies of man that we have now studied form in
their 
aggregate what is usually called the "aura" of the human
being. This aura has 
the appearance of an egg-shaped luminous cloud, in the midst of
which is the 
dense physical body, and from its appearance it has often been
spoken of as 
though it were nothing more than such a cloud. What is usually
called the aura 
is merely such parts of the subtle bodies as extend beyond the
periphery of the 
dense physical body ; each body is complete in itself, and
interpenetrates those 
that are coarser than itself ; it is larger or smaller according to
its 
development, and all that part of it that overlaps the surface of
the dense body 
is termed the aura. The aura is thus composed of the overlapping
portions of the 
etheric double, the desire body, the mental body, the causal body,
and in rare 
cases the buddhic body, illuminated by the Âtmic radiance. 
It is sometimes dull, coarse and dingy ; sometimes magnificently
radiant in 
size, light, and colour ; it depends entirely on the stage of
evolution reached 
by the man, on the development of his different bodies, on the
moral and mental 
character he has evolved. All his varying passions, desires, and
thoughts are 
herein written in form, in colour, in light, so that "he that
runs may read " if 
he has eyes for such script. Character is stamped thereon as well
as fleeting 
changes, and no deception is there possible as in the mask we call
the physical 
body. The increase in size and beauty of the aura is the
unmistakable mark of 
the man’s progress, and tells of the growth and purification of the
Thinker and 
his vehicles. 
REINCARNATION
We are now in a position to study one of the pivotal doctrines of
the Ancient 
Wisdom, the doctrine of reincarnation. Our view of it will be
clearer and more 
in congruity with natural order, if we look at it as universal in
principle, and 
then consider the special case of the reincarnation of the human
soul. 
In studying it, this special case is generally wrenched from its
place in 
natural order, and is considered as a dislocated fragment, greatly
to its 
detriment. For all evolution consists of an evolving life, passing
from form to 
form as it evolves, and storing up in itself the experiences gained
through the 
forms ; the reincarnation of the human soul is not the introduction
of a new 
principle into evolution, but the adaptation of the universal
principle to meet 
the conditions rendered necessary by the individualisation of the
continuously 
evolving life. 
Mr. Lafcadio Hearn ( "Mr. Hearn has lost his way in expressing
– but not, I 
think, in his inner view – in part of his exposition of the
Buddhist statement 
of this doctrine, and his use of the word "Ego" will
mislead the reader of his 
very interesting chapter on this subject, if the distinction
between real and 
illusory ego is not readily kept in mind.") has put this point
well in 
considering the bearing of the idea of the pre-existence on the
scientific 
thought of the West. He says: - 
"With the acceptance of the doctrine of evolution, old forms
of thought crumbled 
; new ideas everywhere arose to take the place of worn-out dogmas ;
and we now 
have the spectacle of a general intellectual movement in directions
strangely 
parallel with Oriental philosophy. The unprecedented rapidity and
multiformity 
of scientific progress during the last fifty years could not have
failed to 
provoke an equally unprecedented intellectual quickening among the 
non-scientific. " 
"That the highest and most complex organisms have been
developed from the lowest 
and simplest ; that a single physical basis of life is the
substance of the 
whole living world ; that no line of separation can be drawn
between the animal 
and vegetable ; that the difference between life and non-life is
only a 
difference of degree, not of kind ; that matter is not less
incomprehensible 
than mind, while both are but varying manifestations of one and the
same unknown 
reality – these have already become the commonplaces of the new
philosophy." 
"After the first recognition even by theology of physical
evolution, it was easy 
to predict that the recognition of psychical evolution could not be
indefinitely 
delayed ; for the barrier erected by old dogma to keep men from
looking backward 
had been broken down. And today for the student of scientific psychology
the 
idea of pre-existence passes out of the realm of theory into the
realm of fact, 
proving the Buddhist explanation of the universal mystery quite as
plausible as 
any other." 
"None but very hasty thinkers,’ wrote the late Professor
Huxley, ‘will reject it 
on the ground of inherent absurdity. Like the doctrine of evolution
itself, that 
of transmigration has its roots in the world of reality ; and it
may claim such 
support as the great argument from analogy is capable of
supplying." (Evolution 
and Ethics, p. 61, ed. 1894 – Kokoro, Hints and Echoes of Japanese
Inner Life, 
by Lafcadio Hearn, pp. 237-39 london, 1896)." 
Let us consider the Monad of form, Âtma-Buddhi. In this Monad, the
outbreathed 
life of the LOGOS, lie hidden all the divine powers, but, as we
have seen, they 
are latent, not manifest and functioning. They are to be gradually
aroused by 
external impacts, it being of the very nature of life to vibrate in
answer to 
vibrations that play upon it. 
As all possibilities of vibrations exist in the Monad, any
vibration touching it 
will arouse its corresponding vibratory powers, and in this way one
force after 
another will pass from the latent to the active state. (From the
static to the 
kinetic condition, the physicist would say.) Herein lies the secret
of evolution 
; the environment acts on the form of the living creature – and all
things, be 
it remembered, live – and this action, transmitted through the
enveloping form 
to the life, the Monad, within it, arouses responsive vibrations
which thrill 
outwards from the Monad through the form, throwing its particles,
in turn, into 
vibrations, and rearranging them into a shape corresponding, or
adapted, to the 
initial impact. 
This is the action and reaction between the environment and the
organism, which 
have been recognised by all biologists, and which are considered by
some as 
giving a sufficient mechanical explanation of evolution. Their
patient and 
careful observation of these actions and reactions yields, however,
no 
explanation why the organism should thus react to stimuli, and the
Ancient 
Wisdom is needed to unveil the secret of evolution, by pointing to
the Self in 
the heart of all forms, the hidden mainspring of all the movements
of nature. 
Having grasped this fundamental idea of a life containing the
possibility of 
responding to every vibration that can reach it from the external
universe, the 
actual response being gradually drawn forth by the play upon it of
external 
forces, the next fundamental idea to be grasped is that of the
continuity of 
life and forms. 
Forms transmit their peculiarities to other forms that proceed from
them, these 
other forms being part of their own substance, separated off to
lead an 
independent existence. By fission, by budding, by extrusion of
germs, by 
development of the offspring within the maternal womb, a physical
continuity is 
preserved, every new form being derived from a preceding form and
reproducing 
its characteristics. ( The student might wisely familiarise himself
with the 
researches of Weissman on the continuity of germ-plasm.) 
Science groups these facts under the name of the law of heredity,
and its 
observations on the transmission of form are worthy of attention,
and are 
illuminative of the workings of Nature in the phenomenal world. But
it must be 
remembered that it applies only to the building of the physical
body, into which 
enter the materials provided by the parents. 
Her more hidden workings, those workings of life without which form
could not 
be, have received no attention, not being susceptible of physical
observation, 
and this gap can only be filled by the teachings of the Ancient
Wisdom, given by 
Those who of old used superphysical powers of observation, and
verifiable 
gradually by every pupil who studies patiently in Their schools. 
There is continuity of life as well as continuity of form, and it
is the 
continuing life – with ever more and more of its latent energies
rendered active 
by the stimuli received through successive forms – which resumes
into itself the 
experiences obtained by its incasings in form ; for when the form
perishes, the 
life has the record of those experiences in the increased energies
aroused by 
them, and is ready to pour itself into the new forms derived from
the old, 
carrying with it this accumulated store. 
While it was in the previous form, it played through it, adapting
it to express 
each newly awakened energy; the form hands on these adaptations,
inwrought into 
its substance, to the separated part of itself that we speak of as
its 
offspring, which, beings of its substance, must needs have the
peculiarities of 
that substance; the life pours itself into that offspring with all
its awakened 
powers, and moulds it yet further ; and so on and on. 
Modern science is proving more and more clearly that heredity plays
an 
ever-decreasing part in the evolution of the higher creatures, that
mental and 
moral qualities are not transmitted from parents to offspring, and
that the 
higher qualities the more patent is this fact ‘ the child of the
genius is 
oft-times a dolt; commonplace parents give birth to a genius. 
A continuing substratum there must be, in which mental and moral
qualities 
inhere, in order that they may increase, else would Nature, in this
most 
important department of her work, show erratic uncaused production
instead of 
orderly continuity. On this science is dumb, but the Ancient Wisdom
teaches that 
this continuing substratum is the Monad, which is the receptacle of
all results, 
the storehouse in which all experiences are garnered as
increasingly active 
powers. 
These two principles firmly grasped – of the Monad with
potentialities becoming 
powers, and of the continuity of the life form – we can proceed to
the 
continuity of life and form – we can proceed to study their working
out in 
detail, and we shall find that they solve many of the perplexing
problems of 
modern science, as well as the yet more heart-searching problems confronted
by 
the philanthropist and the sage. 
Let us start by considering the monad as it is first subjected to
the impacts 
from the formless levels of the mental plane, the very beginning of
the 
evolution of form. Its first faint responsive thrillings draw round
it some of 
the matter of that plane, and we have the gradual evolution of the
first 
elemental kingdom, already mentioned. (See chapter IV, on "The
Mental Plane"). 
The great fundamental types of the Monad are seven in number,
sometimes imaged 
as like the seven colours of the solar spectrum, derived from the
three primary. 
("As above, so below." We instinctively remember the
three LOGOI and the seven 
primeval Sons of the Fire ; in Christian Symbolism, the Trinity and
the "Seven 
Spirits that are before the throne" ; or in Zoroastrian,
Ahuramazda and the 
seven Ameshaspentas.) 
Each of these types has its own colouring of characteristics, and
this colouring 
persists throughout the aeonian cycle of its evolution, affecting
all the series 
of living things that are animated by it. Now begins the process of
subdivision 
in each of these types, that will be carried on, subdividing and
ever 
subdividing, until the individual is reached. 
The currents set up by the commencing outward-going energies of the
Monad – to 
follow one line of evolution will suffice ; the other six are like
unto it in 
principle – have but brief form-life, yet whatever experience can
be gained 
through them is represented by an increasedly responsive life in
the Monad who 
is their source and cause ; as this responsive life consists of
vibrations that 
are often incongruous with each other, a tendency towards
separation is set up 
within the Monad, the harmoniously vibrating forces grouping
themselves together 
for, as it were, concerted action, until various sub-Monads, if the
epithet may 
for a moment be allowed, are formed, alike in their main
characteristics, but 
differing in details, like shades of the same colour. 
These become, by impacts from the lower levels of the mental plane,
the Monads 
of the second elemental kingdom, belonging to the form region of
that plane, and 
the process continues, the Monad ever adding to its power to
respond, each Monad 
being the inspiring life of countless forms, through which it receives
vibrations, and, as the forms disintegrate, constantly vivifying
new forms ; the 
process of subdivision also continues from the cause already
described. 
Each Monad thus continually incarnates itself in forms, and garners
within 
itself as awakened powers all the results obtained through the
forms it 
animates. We may well regard these Monads as the souls of groups of
forms; and 
as evolution proceeds, these forms show more and more attributes,
the attributes 
being the powers of the monadic group-soul manifested through the
forms in which 
it is incarnated. 
The innumerable sub-Monads of this second elemental kingdom
presently reach a 
stage of evolution at which they begin to respond to the vibrations
of astral 
matter, and they begin to act on the astral plane, becoming the
Monads of the 
third elemental kingdom, and repeating in this grosser world all
the processes 
already accomplished on the mental plane. 
They become more and more numerous as monadic group-souls, showing
more and more 
diversity in detail, the number of forms animated by each becoming
less as the 
specialised characteristics become more and more marked. Meanwhile,
it may be 
said in passing, the ever-flowing stream of life from the LOGOS
supplies new 
Monads of form on the higher levels, so that the evolution proceeds
continuously, and as the more-evolved Monads incarnate in the lower
worlds their 
place is taken by the newly emerged Monads in the higher. 
By this ever-repeated process of the reincarnation of the Monads,
or Monadic 
group-soul, in the astral world, their evolution proceeds, until
they are ready 
to respond to the impacts upon them from physical matter. When we
remember that 
the ultimate atoms of each plane have their sphere-walls composed
of the 
coarsest matter of the plane immediately above it, it is easy to
see how the 
Monads become responsive to impacts from one plane after another. 
When, in the first elemental kingdom, the Monad had become
accustomed to thrill 
responsively to the impacts of matter of that plane, it would soon
begin to 
answer to vibrations received through the coarsest forms of that
matter from the 
matter of the plane next below. So, in its coatings of matter that
were the 
forms composed of the coarsest materials of the material plane, it
would become 
susceptible to vibrations of astral atomic matter ; and, when
incarnated in 
forms of the coarsest astral matter, it would similarly become
responsive to 
atomic physical ether, the sphere-walls of which are constituted of
the grossest 
astral materials. 
Thus the Monad may be regarded as reaching the physical plane ; and
there it 
begins, or, more accurately, all these monadic group-souls begin,
to incarnate 
themselves in filmy physical forms, the etheric doubles of the
future dense 
minerals of the physical world. Into these filmy forms the
nature-spirits build 
the denser physical materials, and thus minerals of all kinds are
formed, the 
most rigid vehicles in which the evolving life in-closes itself,
and through 
which the least of its powers can express themselves. Each monadic
group-soul 
has its own mineral expressions, the mineral forms in which it is
incarnated, 
and the specialisation has now reached a high degree. These Monadic
group-souls 
are sometimes called in their totality the mineral Monad or the
Monad 
incarnating in the mineral kingdom. 
From this time forward the awakened energies of the Monad play a
less passive 
part in evolution. They begin to seek expression actively to some
extent when 
once aroused into functioning, and to exercise a distinctly
moulding influence 
over the forms in which they are imprisoned. As they become too
active for their 
mineral embodiment, the beginnings of the more plastic forms of the
vegetable 
kingdom manifest themselves, the nature-spirits aiding this
evolution throughout 
the physical kingdoms. In the mineral kingdom there had already
been shown a 
tendency towards the definite organisation of form, the laying down
of certain 
lines ( The axes of growth which determine form. They appear
definitely in 
crystals ) along which the growth proceeded. This tendency governs
henceforth 
all the building of forms, and is the cause of the exquisite
symmetry of natural 
objects, with which every observer is familiar. 
The monadic group-souls in the vegetable kingdom undergo division
and 
subdivision with increasing rapidity, in consequence of the still
greater 
variety of impacts to which they are subjected, the evolution of
families, 
genera, and species being due to this invisible subdivision. 
When any genus, with its generic monadic group-soul, is subjected
to very 
varying conditions, i.e., when the forms connected with it receive
very 
different impacts, a fresh tendency to subdivide is set up in the
Monad, and 
various species are evolved, each having its own specific
group-soul. 
When Nature is left to her own working the process is slow,
although the 
nature-spirits do much towards the differentiation of species ; but
when man has 
been evolved, and when he begins his artificial systems of
cultivation, 
encouraging the play of one set of forces, warding off another,
then this 
differentiation can be brought about with considerable rapidity,
and specific 
differences are readily evolved. So long as actual division has not
taken place 
in the monadic group-soul, the subjection of the forms to similar
influences may 
again eradicate the separative tendency, but when that division is
completed the 
new species are definitely and firmly established , and are ready
to send out 
offshoots of their own. 
In some of the longer-lived members of the vegetable kingdom the
element of 
personality begins to manifest itself, the stability of the
organism rendering 
possible this foreshadowing of individuality. With a tree, living
for scores of 
years, the recurrence of similar conditions causing similar
impacts, the seasons 
ever returning year after year, the consecutive motions caused by
them, the 
rising of the sap, the putting forth of leaves, the touches of the
wind, of the 
sunbeams, of the rain – all these outer influences with their
rhythmical 
progression – set up responsive thrillings in the monadic
group-soul, and, as 
the sequence impresses itself by continual repetition, the
recurrence of one 
leads to the dim expectation of its oft-repeated successor. Nature
evolves no 
quality suddenly, and these are the first faint adumbrations of
what will later 
be memory and anticipation. 
In the vegetable kingdom also appear the foreshadowings of
sensation, evolving 
in its higher members to what the Western psychologist would term
"massive" 
sensations of pleasure and discomfort. (The "massive"
sensation is one that 
pervades the organism and is not felt especially in any one part
more than in 
others. It is the antithesis of the "acute.") It must be
remembered that the 
Monad has drawn round itself materials of the planes through which
it has 
descended, and hence is able to contact impacts, from those planes,
the 
strongest and those most nearly allied to the grossest forms of
matter being the 
first to make themselves felt. 
Sunshine and the chill of its absence at last impress themselves on
the monadic 
consciousness ; and its astral coating, thrown into faint
vibrations, gives rise 
to the slight massive kind of sensation spoken of. Rain and drought
affecting 
the mechanical constitution of the form, and its power to convey
vibrations to 
the ensouling Monad – are another of the "pairs of
opposites," the play of which 
arouses the recognition of difference, which is the root alike of all
sensation, 
and later of all thought. Thus by their repeated
plant-reincarnations the 
monadic group-souls in the vegetable kingdom evolve, until those
that ensoul the 
highest members of the kingdom are ready for the next step. 
This step carries them into the animal kingdom, and here they
slowly evolve in 
their physical and astral vehicles a very distinct personality. The
animal, 
being free to move about, subjects itself to a greater variety of
conditions 
than can be experienced by the plant, rooted to a single spot, and
this variety, 
as ever, promotes differentiation. 
The monadic group-soul, however, which animates a number of wild
animals of the 
same species or subspecies, while it receives a great variety of
impacts, since 
they are for the most part repeated continually and are shared by
all the 
members of the group, differentiates but slowly. 
These impacts aid in the development of the physical and astral
bodies, and 
through them the monadic group-soul gathers much experience. When
the form of a 
member of the group perishes, the experience gathered through that
form is 
accumulated in the monadic group-soul, and may be said to colour it
; the 
slightly increased life of the monadic group-soul, poured into all
the forms 
which compose its group, shares among all the experiences of the
perished form, 
and in this way continually repeated experiences, stored up in the
monadic 
group-soul, appear as instincts, "accumulated hereditary
experiences" in the new 
forms. 
Countless birds having fallen a prey to hawks, chicks just out of
the egg will 
cower at the approach of one of the hereditary enemies, for the
life that is 
incarnated in them knows the danger, and the innate instinct is the
expression 
of its knowledge. In this way are formed the wonderful instincts
that guard 
animals from innumerable habitual perils, while a new danger finds
them 
unprepared and only bewilders them. 
As animals come under the influence of man, the monadic group-souls
evolves with 
greatly increased rapidity, and, from causes similar to those which
affect 
plants under domestication, subdivision of the incarnating life is
more readily 
brought about. Personality evolves and becomes more and more
strongly marked ; 
in the earlier stages it may almost be said to be compound – a
whole flock of 
wild creatures will act as though moved by a single personality, so
completely 
are the forms dominated by the common soul, it, in turn, being
affected by the 
impulse from the external world. 
Domesticated animals of the higher types, the elephants, the horse,
the cat, the 
dog, show a more individualised personality – two dogs, for
instance, may act 
very differently under the impact of the same circumstances. The
monadic 
group-soul incarnates in a decreasing number of forms as it
gradually approaches 
the point at which complete individualisation will be reached. The
desire-body, 
or Kâmic vehicle, becomes considerably developed, and persists for
some time 
after the death of the physical body, leading an independent
existence in 
Kâmaloka. At last the decreasing number of forms animated by a
monadic 
group-soul comes down to unity, and it animates a succession of
single forms – a 
condition differing from human reincarnation only by the absence of
Manas, with 
its causal and mental bodies. 
The mental matter brought down by the monadic group-souls begins to
be 
susceptible to impacts from the mental plane, and the animal is
then ready to 
receive the third great outpouring of the life of the LOGOS – the
tabernacle is 
ready for the reception of the human Monad. 
The human Monad is, as we have seen, triple in its nature, its
three aspects 
being denominated, respectively, the Spirit, the spiritual Soul,
and the human 
Soul, Âtma-Buddhi-Manas. Doubtless, in the course of eons of
evolution, the 
upwardly evolving Monad of form might have unfolded Manas by
progressive growth, 
but both in the human race in the past, and in the animals of the
present, such 
has not been the course of Nature. 
When the house was ready the tenant was sent down ; from the higher
planes of 
being the âtmic life descended, veiling itself in Buddhi, as a
golden thread ; 
and its third aspect, Manas, showing itself in the higher levels of
the formless 
world of the mental plane, germinal Manas within the form was
fructified, and 
the embryonic causal body was formed by the union. This is the
individualisation 
of the spirit, the incasing of it in form, and this spirit incased
in the causal 
body is the soul, the individual, the real man. This is his birth
hour; for 
though his essence be eternal, unborn and undying, his birth in
time as an 
individual is definite. 
Further, this outpoured life reaches the evolving forms not
directly, but by 
intermediaries. The human race having attained the point of
receptivity, certain 
great Ones, called Sons of Mind – (Manasaputra is the technical
name, being 
merely the Sanskrit for Sons of Mind.) – cast into men the monadic
spark of 
Âtma-Buddhi-Manas, needed for the formation of the embryonic soul. 
And some of these great Ones actually incarnated in human forms, in
order to 
become the guides and teachers of infant humanity. These Sons of
Mind had 
completed Their own intellectual evolution in other worlds, and
came to this 
younger world, our earth, for the purpose of thus aiding in the
evolution of the 
human race. They are in truth, the spiritual fathers of the bulk of
our 
humanity. Other intelligences of much lower grade, men who had
evolved in 
preceding cycles in another world, incarnated among the descendants
of the race 
that received its infant souls in the way just described. As this
race evolved, 
the human tabernacles improved, and myriads of souls that were
awaiting the 
opportunity of incarnation, that they might continue their
evolution, took birth 
among its children. 
These partially evolved souls are also spoken of in the ancient
records as Sons 
of Mind, for they were possessed of mind, although comparatively it
was but 
little developed – childish souls we may call them, in
distinguishment from the 
embryonic souls of the bulk of humanity, and the mature souls of
the great 
Teachers. 
These child-souls, by reason of their more evolved intelligence,
formed the 
leading types of the ancient world, the classes higher in
mentality, and 
therefore in the power of acquiring knowledge, that dominated the
masses of less 
developed men in antiquity. And thus arose, in our world, the
enormous 
differences in mental and moral capacity which separate the most
highly evolved 
from the least evolved races, and which, even within the limits of
single race, 
separate the lofty philosophic thinker from the well-nigh animal
type of the 
most depraved of his own nation. These differences are but
differences of the 
stage of evolution, of the age of the soul, and they have been
found to exist 
throughout the whole of history of humanity on this globe. Go back
as far as we 
may in historic records, and we may find lofty intelligence and
debased 
ignorance side by side, and the occult records, carrying us
backwards, tell a 
similar story of the early millennia of humanity. 
Nor should this distress us, as though some had been unduly
favoured and others 
unduly burdened for the struggle of life. The loftiest soul had its
childhood 
and its infancy, albeit in previous worlds, where other souls were
as high above 
it as others are below it now ; the lowest soul shall climb to
where our highest 
are standing, and souls yet unborn shall occupy its present place
in evolution. 
Things seem unjust because we wrench our world out of its place in
evolution, 
and set it apart in isolation, with no forerunners and no
successors. It is our 
ignorance that sees the injustice ; the ways of Nature are equal,
and she brings 
to all her children infancy, childhood, and manhood. Nor hers the
fault if our 
folly demands that all souls shall occupy the same stage of
evolution at the 
same time, and cries "Unjust!" if the demand be not
fulfilled. 
We shall best understand the evolution of the soul, if we take it
up at the 
point where we left it, when animal-man was ready to receive, and
did receive, 
the embryonic soul. To avoid a possible misapprehension, it may be
well to say 
that there were not henceforth two Monads in man – the one that had
built the 
human tabernacle, and the one that descended into that tabernacle,
and whose 
lowest aspect was the human soul. 
To borrow a simile again from H. P. Blavatsky, as two rays of the
sun may pass 
through a hole in a shutter, and mingling together form but one ray
though they 
had been twain, so is it with these rays from the Supreme Sun, the
divine Lord 
of our universe. The second ray, as it entered into the human
tabernacle, 
blended with the first, merely adding to it fresh energy and
brilliance, and the 
human Monad, as a unit, began its mighty task of unfolding the
higher powers in 
man of that divine Life whence it came. 
The embryonic soul, the Thinker, had at the beginning for its
embryonic mental 
body the mind-stuff envelope that the Monad of form had brought
with it, but had 
not yet organised into any possibility of functioning. It was the
mere germ of a 
mental body, attached to a mere germ of a causal body, and for many
a life the 
strong desire-nature had its will with the soul, whirling it along
the road of 
its own passions and appetites, and dashing up against it all the
furious waves 
of its own uncontrolled animality. 
Repulsive as this early life of the soul may at first seem to some
when looked 
at from the higher stage that we have now attained, it was a
necessary one for 
the germination of the seeds of mind. Recognition of difference,
the perception 
that one thing is different from another, is a preliminary
essential to thinking 
at all. And, in order to awaken this perception in the as yet
unthinking soul, 
strong and violent contrasts had to strike upon it, so as to force
differences 
upon it – blow after blow of riotous pleasure, blow after blow of
crushing pain. 
The external world hammered on the soul through the desire nature,
till 
perceptions began to be slowly made, and, after countless
repetitions, to be 
registered. The little gains made in each life were stored up by
the Thinker, as 
we have already seen, and thus slow progress was made. 
Slow progress, indeed, for scarcely anything was thought, and hence
scarcely 
anything was done in the way of organising the mental body. Not
until many 
perceptions had been registered in it as mental images was there
any material on 
which mental action, initiated from within, could be based ; this
would begin 
when two or more of these mental images were drawn together, and
some inference, 
however elementary, was made from them. That inference was the
beginning of 
reasoning, the germ of all the systems of logic which the intellect
of man has 
since evolved or assimilated. These inferences would at first all
be made in the 
service of the desire-nature, for the increasing of pleasure, the
lessening of 
pain ; but each one would increase the activity of the mental body,
and would 
stimulate it into more ready functioning. 
It will readily be seen that at this period of his infancy man had
no knowledge 
of good or of evil; right and wrong for him had no existence. The
right is that 
which is in accordance with the divine will, which helps forward
the progress of 
the soul, which tends to the strengthening of the higher nature of
man and to 
the training and subjugation of the lower, the wrong is that which
retards 
evolution, which retains the soul in the lower stages after he has
learned the 
lessons they have to teach, which tends to the mastery of the lower
nature over 
the higher, and assimilates man to the brute he should be
outgrowing instead of 
to the God he should be evolving. 
Ere man could know what was right, he had to learn the existence of
the law, and 
this he could only learn by following all that attracted him in the
outer world, 
by grasping every desirable object, and then by learning from
experience, sweet 
or bitter, whether his delight was in harmony or in conflict with
the law. Let 
us take an obvious example, the taking of pleasant food, and see
how infant man 
might learn therefrom the presence of a natural law. At the first
taking, his 
hunger was appeased, his taste was gratified, and only pleasure
resulted from 
the experience, for his action was in harmony with law. On another
occasion, 
desiring to increase pleasure, he ate overmuch and suffered in
consequence, for 
he transgressed against the law. A confusing experience to the
dawning 
intelligence, how the pleasurable became painful by excess. 
Over and over again he would be led by desire into excess, and each
time he 
would experience the painful consequences, until at last he learned
moderation, 
i.e., he learned to conform his bodily acts in this respect to
physical law; for 
he found that there were conditions which affected him and which he
could not 
control, and that only by observing them could physical happiness
be insured. 
Similar experiences flowed in upon him through all the bodily
organs, with 
undeviating regularity ; his outrushing desires brought him
pleasure or pain 
just as they worked with the laws of Nature or against them, and,
as experience 
increased, it began to guide his steps, to influence his choice, It
was not as 
though he had to begin his experience anew with every life, for on
each new 
birth he brought with him mental faculties a little increased, and 
ever-accumulating store. 
I have said that the growth in these early days was very slow, for
there was but 
the dawning of mental action, and when the man left his physical
body at death 
he passed most of his time in Kâmaloka, sleeping through a brief
devachanic 
period of unconscious assimilation of any minute mental experience
not yet 
sufficiently developed for the active heavenly life that lay before
him after 
many days. 
Still, the enduring causal body was there, to be the receptacle of
his 
qualities, and to carry them on for further development into his
next life on 
earth. The part played by the monadic group-soul in the earlier
stages of 
evolution is played in man by the causal body, and it is this
continuing entity 
who, in all cases, makes evolution possible. Without him, the
accumulation of 
mental and moral experiences, shown as faculties, would be as
impossible as 
would be the accumulation of physical experiences, shown as racial
and family 
characteristics without the continuity of physical plasm. 
Souls without a past behind them, springing suddenly into existence,
out of 
nothing, with marked mental and moral peculiarities, are a
conception as 
monstrous as would be the corresponding conception of babies
suddenly appearing 
from nowhere, unrelated to anybody, but showing marked racial and
family types. 
Neither man nor his physical vehicle is uncaused, or caused by the
direct power 
of the LOGOS ; here, as in so many other cases, the invisible
things are clearly 
seen by their analogy with the visible, the visible being, in very
truth, 
nothing more than the images, the reflections, of things unseen.
Without a 
continuity in the physical plasm, there would be no means for the
evolution of 
physical peculiarities ; without the continuity of the
intelligence, there would 
be no means for the evolution of mental and moral qualities. In
both cases, 
without continuity, evolution would be stopped at its first stage,
and the world 
would be a chaos of infinite and isolated beginnings instead of a
cosmos 
continually becoming. 
We must not omit to notice that in these early days much variety is
caused in 
the type and in the nature of individual progress by the
environment which 
surrounds the individual. Ultimately all the souls have to develop
all their 
powers, but the order in which these powers are developed depends on
the 
circumstances amid which the soul is placed. Climate, the fertility
or sterility 
of nature, the life of the mountain or of the plain, of the inland
forest or the 
ocean shore – these things and countless others will call into
activity one set 
or another of the awakening mental energies. 
A life of extreme hardship, of ceaseless struggle with nature, will
develop very 
different powers from those evolved amid the luxuriant plenty of a
tropical 
island ; both sets of powers are needed, for the soul is to conquer
every region 
of nature, but striking differences may thus be evolved even in
souls of the 
same age, and one may appear to be more advanced than the other,
according as 
the observer estimates most highly the more "practical"
or the more 
"contemplative" powers of the soul, the active
outward-going energies, or the 
quiet inward-turned musing faculties. The perfected soul possesses
all, but the 
soul in the making must develop them successively, and thus arises
another cause 
of the immense variety found among human beings. 
For again, it must be remembered that human evolution is
individual. In a group 
informed by a single monadic group-soul the same instincts will be
found in all, 
for the receptacle of the experiences is that monadic group-soul,
and it pours 
its life into all forms dependent upon it. 
But each man has his own physical vehicle and one only at a time,
and the 
receptacle of all experiences is the causal body, which pours its
life into its 
one physical vehicle, and can affect no other physical vehicle,
being connected 
with none other. Hence we find differences separating individual
men greater, 
than the ever separated, closely allied animals, and hence also the
evolution of 
qualities cannot be studied in men in the mass, but only in the
continuing 
individual. The lack of power to make such a study leaves science
unable to 
explain why some men tower above their fellows, intellectual and
moral giants, 
unable to trace the intellectual evolution of a Shankarâchârya or a
Pythagoras, 
the moral evolution of a Buddha or of a Christ. 
Let us now consider the factors in reincarnation, as a clear
understanding of 
these is necessary for the explanation of some of the difficulties
– such as the 
alleged loss of memory – which are felt by those unfamiliar with
the idea. We 
have seen that man, during his passage through physical death,
Kâmaloka and 
Devachan, loses one after the other, his various bodies, the
physical, the 
astral, and the mental. These are all disintegrated, and their
particles remix 
with the materials of their several planes. The connection of the
man with the 
physical vehicle is entirely broken off and done with ; but the
astral and 
mental bodies hand on to the man himself, to the Thinker, the germs
of the 
faculties and qualities resulting from the activities of the
earth-life, and 
these are stored within the causal body, the seeds of his next
astral and mental 
bodies. 
At this stage, then, only the man himself is left, the labourer who
has brought 
his harvest home, and has lived upon it till it is all worked up
into himself. 
The dawn of a new life begins, and he must go forth again to his
labour until 
the even. 
The new life begins by the vivifying of the mental germs, and they
draw upon the 
materials of the lower mental levels, till a mental body has grown
up from them 
that represents exactly the mental stage of the man, expressing all
his mental 
faculties as organs ; the experiences of the past do not exist as
mental images 
in this new body; as mental images they perished when the old
mind-body 
perished, and only their essence, their effects on faculty, remain
; they were 
the food of the mind, the materials which it wove into powers, and
in the new 
body they reappear as powers, they determine its materials, and
they form its 
organs. When the man, the Thinker, has thus clothed himself with a
new body for 
his coming life on the lower mental levels, he proceeds, by
vivifying the astral 
germs, to provide himself with an astral body for his life on the
astral plane. 
This, again, exactly represents his desire-nature, faithfully
reproducing the 
qualities he evolved in the past, as the seed reproduces its parent
tree. Thus 
the man stands, fully equipped for his next incarnation, the only
memory of 
these events of his past being in the causal body, in his own
enduring form, the 
one body that passes on from life to life. 
Meanwhile, action external to himself is being taken to provide him
with a 
physical body suitable for the expression of his qualities. In past
lives he has 
made ties with, contracted liabilities towards, other human beings,
and some of 
these will partly determine his place of birth and his family. – (
This and the 
following causes determining the outward circumstances of the new
life will be 
fully explained in Chapter IX, on "Karma".) He has been a
source of happiness or 
of unhappiness to others ; this is a factor in determining the
conditions of his 
coming life. His desire-nature is well disciplined, or unregulated
and riotous ; 
this will be taken into account in the physical heredity of the new
body. He has 
cultivated certain mental powers, such as the artistic ; this must
be 
considered, as here again physical heredity is an important factor
where 
delicacy of nervous organisation and tactile sensibility are
required. 
And so on, in endless variety. The man may, certainly will, have in
him many 
incongruous characteristics, so that only some can find expression
in any one 
body that could be provided, and a group of his powers suitable for
simultaneous 
expression must be selected. All this is done by certain mighty
spiritual 
Intelligences,( Spoken of by H.P.Blavatsky in the Secret Doctrine.
They are the 
Lipika, the Keepers of the kârmic records, and the Mahârâjas, who
direct the 
practical working out of the decrees of the Lipika.) - often spoken
of as the 
Lords of Karma, because it is their function to superintend the
working out of 
causes continually set going by thoughts, desires, and actions.
They hold the 
threads of destiny which each man has woven, and guide the
reincarnating man to 
the environment determined by his past, unconsciously self-chosen through
his 
past life. 
The race, the nation, the family, being thus determined, what may
be called the 
mould of the physical body – suitable for the expression of the
man’s qualities, 
and for the working out of the causes he has set going – is given
by these great 
Ones, and the new etheric double, a copy of this, is built within
the mother’s 
womb by the agency of an elemental, the thought of the Karmic Lords
being its 
motive power. 
The dense body is built into the etheric double molecule by
molecule, following 
it exactly, and here physical heredity has full sway in the
materials provided. 
Further, the thoughts and passions of surrounding people,
especially of the 
continually present father and mother, influence the building
elemental in its 
work, the individuals with whom the incarnating man had formed ties
in the past 
thus affecting the physical conditions growing up for his new life
on earth. 
At a very early stage the new astral body comes into connection
with the new 
etheric double, and exercises considerable influence over its
formation, and 
through it the mental body works upon the nervous organisation,
preparing it to 
become a suitable instrument for its own expression in the future.
This 
influence commenced in ante natal life – so that when a child is
born its 
brain-formation reveals the extent and balance of its mental and
moral qualities 
– is continued after birth, and this building of brain and nerves,
and their 
correlation to the astral and mental bodies, go on till the seventh
year of 
childhood, at which age the connection between the man and his
physical vehicle 
is complete, and he may be said to work through it henceforth more
than upon it. 
Up to this age, the consciousness of the Thinker is more upon the
astral plane 
than upon the physical, and this is often evidenced by the play of
psychic 
faculties in young children. They see invisible comrades and fairy
landscapes, 
hear voices inaudible to their elders, catch charming and delicate
fancies from 
the astral world. These phenomena generally vanish as the Thinker
begins to work 
effectively through the physical vehicle, and the dreamy child
becomes the 
commonplace boy or girl, oftentimes much to the relief of the bewildered
parents, ignorant of the cause of their child’s
"queerness." 
Most children have at least a touch of this "queerness,"
but they quickly learn 
to hide away their fancies and visions from their unsympathetic
elders, fearful 
of blame for "telling stories," or of what the child
dreads far more – ridicule. 
If parents could see their children’s brains, vibrating under an
inextricable 
mingling of physical and astral impacts, which the children
themselves are quite 
incapable of separating, and receiving sometimes a thrill – so
plastic are they 
– even from the higher regions, giving a vision of ethereal beauty,
of heroic 
achievement, they would be more patient with, more responsive to,
the confused 
prattlings of the little ones, trying to translate into the
difficult medium of 
unaccustomed words the elusive touches of which they are conscious,
and which 
they try to catch and retain. Reincarnation, believed in and
understood, would 
relieve child life of its most pathetic aspect, the unaided struggle
of the soul 
to gain control over its new vehicles, and to connect itself fully
with its 
densest body without losing power to impress the rarer ones in a
way that would 
enable them to convey to the denser their own more subtle
vibrations. 
The ascending stages of consciousness through which the Thinker
passes as he 
reincarnates during his long cycle of lives in the three lower
worlds are 
clearly marked out, and the obvious necessity for many lives, in
which to 
experience them, if he is to evolve at all, may carry to the more
thoughtful 
minds the clearest conviction of the truth of reincarnation. 
The first of the stages is that in which all the experiences are
sensational, 
the only contribution made by the mind consisting of the
recognition that 
contact with some object is followed by a sensation of pleasure,
while contact 
with others is followed by a sensation of pain. These objects form
mental 
pictures, and the pictures soon begin to act as a stimulus to seek
the objects 
associated with pleasure, when those objects are not present, the
germs of 
memory and of mental initiative thus making their appearance. This
first rough 
division of the external world is followed by the more complex idea
of the 
bearing of quantity on pleasure and pain, already referred to. 
At this stage of evolution, memory is very short lived, or, in
other words, 
mental images are very transitory. The idea of forecasting the
future from the 
past, even to the most rudimentary extent, has not dawned on the
infant Thinker, 
and his actions are guided from outside, by the impacts that reach
him from the 
external world, or at furthest by the promptings of his appetites
and passions, 
craving gratification. He will throw away anything for an immediate
satisfaction, however necessary the thing may be for his future
well being; the 
need of the moment overpowers every other consideration. Of human
souls in this 
embryonic condition, numerous examples can be found in books of
travel, and the 
necessity for many lives will be impressed on the mind of any one
who studies 
the mental condition of the least evolved savages, and compares it
with the 
mental condition of even average humanity among ourselves. 
Needless to say that the moral capacity is no more evolved than the
mental; the 
idea of good and evil has not yet been conceived. Not is it
possible to convey 
to the quite undeveloped mind even elementary notion of either good
or bad. Good 
and pleasant are to it interchangeable terms, as in the well-known
case of the 
Australian savage mentioned by Charles Darwin. Pressed by hunger,
the man 
speared the nearest living creature that could serve as food, and
this happened 
to be his wife; a European remonstrated with him on the wickedness
of his deed, 
but failed to make any impression; for from the reproach that to
eat his wife 
was very, very bad he only deduced the inference that the stranger
thought she 
had proved nasty of indigestible, and he put him right by smiling
peacefully as 
he patted himself after his meal, and declaring in a satisfied way,
"She is very 
good." 
Measure in thought the moral distance between that man and St.
Francis of 
Assisi, and it will be seen that there must either be evolution of
souls as 
there is evolution of bodies, or else in the realm of the soul
there must be 
constant miracle, dislocated creations. 
There are two paths along either of which man may gradually emerge
from this 
embryonic mental condition. He may be directly ruled and controlled
by men far 
more evolved than himself, or he may be left slowly to grow
unaided. The latter 
case would imply the passage of uncounted millennia, for, without
example and 
without discipline, left to the changing impacts of external
objects, and to 
friction with other men as undeveloped as himself, the inner
energies could be 
but very slowly aroused. 
As a matter of fact, man has evolved by the road of direct precept
and example 
and of enforced discipline. We have already seen that when the bulk
of the 
average humanity received the spark which brought the Thinker into
being, there 
were some of the greater Sons if Mind who incarnated as Teachers,
and that there 
was also a long succession of lesser Sons of Mind, at various
stages of 
evolution, who came into incarnation as the crest-wave of the
advancing tide of 
humanity. 
These ruled the less evolved, under the beneficent sway of the
great Teachers, 
and the compelled obedience to elementary rules of right living –
very 
elementary at first, in truth – much hastened the development of
mental and 
moral faculties in the embryonic souls. Apart from all other
records the 
gigantic remains of civilizations that have long since disappeared
– evidencing 
great engineering skill, and intellectual conceptions far beyond
anything 
possible by the mass of the then infant humanity – suffice to prove
that there 
were present on earth men with minds that were capable of greatly
planning and 
greatly executing. 
Let us continue the early stage of the evolution of consciousness.
Sensation was 
wholly lord of the mind, and the earliest mental efforts were
stimulated by 
desire. This led the man, slowly and clumsily, to forecast, to
plan. He began to 
recognise a definite association of certain mental images, and,
when one 
appeared, to expect the appearance of the other that had invariably
followed in 
its wake. He began to draw inferences, and even to initiate action
on the faith 
of these inferences – a great advance. And he began also to
hesitate now and 
again to follow the vehement promptings of desire, when he found,
over and over 
again, that the gratification demanded was associated in his mind
with the 
subsequent happening of suffering. 
This action was much quickened by the pressure upon him of verbally
expressed 
laws; he was forbidden to seize certain gratifications, and was
told that 
suffering would follow disobedience. When he had seized the
delight-giving 
object and found the suffering follow upon pleasure, the fulfilled
declaration 
made a far stronger impression on his mind than would have been
made by the 
unexpected – and therefore to him fortuitous – happening of the
same thing un 
foretold. Thus conflict continually arose between memory and
desire, and the 
mind grew more active by the conflict, and was stirred into livelier
functioning. The conflict, in fact, marked the transition to the
second great 
stage. 
Here began to show itself the germ of will. Desire and will guide a
man’s 
actions, and will has even been defined as the desire which emerges
triumphant 
from the contest of desires. But this is a crude and superficial
view, 
explaining nothing. Desire is the outgoing energy of the Thinker,
determined in 
its direction by the attraction of external objects. Will is the
outgoing energy 
of the Thinker, determined in its direction by the conclusions
drawn by the 
reason, from past experiences, or by the direct intuition of the
Thinker 
himself. Otherwise put: desire is guided from without – will from
within. At the 
beginning of man’s evolution, desire has complete sovereignty, and
hurries him 
hither and thither; in the middle of his evolution, desire and will
are in 
continual conflict, and victory lies sometimes with the one,
sometimes with the 
other; at the end of his evolution desire has died, and will rules
with 
unopposed, unchallenged sway. 
Until the Thinker, is sufficiently developed to see directly, will
is guided by 
him through the reason; and as the reason can draw its conclusions
only from its 
stock of mental images – its experiences – and that stock is
limited, the will 
constantly commands mistaken actions. The suffering which flows
from these 
mistaken actions increases the stock of mental images, and thus
gives the reason 
an increased store from which to draw its conclusions. Thus
progress is made and 
wisdom is born. 
Desire often mixes itself up with will, so that what appears to be
determined 
from within is really largely prompted by the cravings of the lower
nature for 
objects which afford it gratification. Instead of an open conflict
between the 
two, the lower subtly insinuates itself into the current of the
higher and turns 
its course aside. Defeated in the open field, the desire of the
personality thus 
conspire against their conqueror, and often win by guile what they
failed to win 
by force. During the whole of this second great stage, in which the
faculties of 
the lower mind are in full course of evolution, conflict is the
normal 
condition, conflict between the rule of sensations and the rule of
reason. 
The problem to be solved in humanity is the putting an end to
conflict while 
preserving the freedom of the will; to determine the will
inevitably to the 
best, while yet leaving that best as a matter of choice. The best
is to be 
chosen, but by a self-initiated volition, that shall come with all
the certainty 
of a foreordained necessity. The certainty of a compelling law is
to be obtained 
from countless wills, each one left free to determine its own
course. The 
solution of that problem is simple when it is known, though the
contradiction 
looks irreconcilable when first presented. Let man be left free to
choose his 
own actions, but let every action bring about an inevitable result;
let him run 
loose amid all objects of desire and seize whatever he will, but
let him have 
all the results of his choice, be they delightful or grievous.
Presently he will 
freely reject the objects whose possession ultimately causes him
pain; he will 
no longer desire them when he has experienced to the full that
their possession 
ends in sorrow. 
Let him struggle to hold the pleasure and avoid the pain, he will
none the less 
be ground between the stones of law, and the lesson will be
repeated any number 
of times found necessary; reincarnation offers us many lives as are
needed by 
the most sluggish learner. Slowly desire for an object that brings
suffering in 
its train will die, and when the thing offers itself in all its
attractive 
glamour it will be rejected, not by compulsion but by free choice. 
It is no longer desirable, it has lost its power. Thus with thing
after thing; 
choice more and more runs in harmony with law. "There are many
roads of error; 
the road of truth is one"; when all the paths of error have
been trodden, when 
all have been found to end in suffering, the choice to walk in the
way of truth 
is unswerving, because based on knowledge. The lower kingdoms work
harmoniously, 
compelled by law; man’s kingdom is a chaos of conflicting wills,
fighting 
against, rebelling against law; presently there evolves from it a
nobler unity, 
a harmonious choice of voluntary obedience, an obedience that,
being voluntary, 
based on knowledge and on memory of the results of disobedience, is
stable and 
can be drawn aside by no temptation. Ignorant, inexperienced, man
would always 
have been in danger of falling; as a God, knowing good and evil by
experience, 
his choice of the good is raised forever beyond possibility of
change. 
Will in the domain of morality is generally entitled conscience,
and it is 
subject to the same difficulties in this domain as in its other
activities. So 
long as actions are in question which have been done over and over
again, of 
which the consequences are familiar either to the reason or to the
Thinker 
himself, the conscience speaks quickly and firmly. But when
unfamiliar problems 
arise as to the working out of which experience is silent,
conscience cannot 
speak with certainty; it has but a hesitating answer from the
reason, which can 
draw only a doubtful inference, and the Thinker cannot speak if his
experience 
does not include the circumstances that have now arisen. 
Hence conscience often decides wrongly; that is, the will, failing
clear 
direction from either the reason or the intuition, guides action
amiss. Nor can 
we leave out of consideration the influences which play upon the
mind from 
without, from the thought-forms of others, of friends, of the
family, of the 
community, of the nation. (Chapter 11, "The Astral
Plane.") These all surround 
and penetrate the mind with their own atmosphere, distorting the
appearance of 
everything, and throwing all things our of proportion. Thus
influenced, the 
reason often does not even judge calmly from its own experience,
but draws false 
conclusions as it studies its materials through a distorting
medium. 
The evolution of moral faculties is very largely stimulated by the
affections, 
animal and selfish as these are during the infancy of the Thinker.
The laws of 
morality are laid down by the enlightened reason, discerning the laws
by which 
Nature moves, and bringing human conduct into consonance with the
Divine Will. 
But the impulse to obey these laws, when no outer force compels,
has its roots 
in love, in that hidden divinity in man which seeks to pour itself
out to give 
itself to others. Morality begins in the infant Thinker when he is
first moved 
by love to wife, to child, to friend, to do some action that serves
the loved 
one without any thought of gain to himself thereby. It is the first
conquest 
over the lower nature, the complete subjugation of which is the
achievement of 
moral perfection. 
Hence the importance of never killing out or striving to weaken,
the affection, 
as is done in many of the lower kinds of occultism. However impure
and gross the 
affections may be, they offer possibilities of moral evolution from
which the 
cold-hearted and self-isolated have shut themselves out. It is an
easier task to 
purify than to create love, and this is why "the sinners"
have been said by 
great Teachers to be nearer to the kingdom of heaven than the
Pharisees and 
Scribes. 
The third great stage of consciousness sees the development of the
higher 
intellectual powers; the mind no longer dwells entirely on mental
images 
obtained from sensations, no longer reasons on purely concrete
objects, nor is 
concerned with the attributes which differentiate one from another.
The Thinker 
having learned clearly to discriminate between objects by dwelling
upon their 
unlikenesses, now begins to group them together by some attribute
which appears 
in a number of objects otherwise dissimilar and makes a link
between them. 
He draws out, abstracts, his common attribute, and sets all objects
that posses 
it, apart from the rest which are without it; and in this way he
evolves the 
power of recognising identity amid diversity, a step toward the
much later 
recognition of the One underlying the man, he thus classifies all
that is around 
him, developing the synthetic faculty, and learning to construct as
well as 
analyse. Presently he takes another step, and conceives of the
common property 
as an idea, apart from all the objects in which it appears, and
thus constructs 
a higher kind of mental image of a concrete object – the image of
an idea that 
has no phenomenal existence in the worlds of form, but which exists
on the 
higher levels of the mental plane, and affords material on which
the Thinker 
himself can work. 
The lower mind reaches the abstract idea by reason, and in thus
doing 
accomplishes its loftiest flight, touching the threshold of the
formless world, 
and dimly seeing that which lies beyond. The Thinker sees these
ideas, and lives 
among them habitually, and when the power of abstract reasoning is
developed and 
exercised the Thinker is becoming effective in his own world, and
is beginning 
his life of active functioning in his own sphere. 
Such men care little for the life of the senses, care little for
external 
observation, or for mental application to images of external
objects; their 
powers are indrawn, and no longer rush outwards in the search for
satisfaction. 
They dwell calmly within themselves, engrossed with the problems of
philosophy, 
with the deepest aspects of life and thought, seeking to understand
causes 
rather than troubling themselves with effects, and approaching
nearer and nearer 
to the recognition of the One that underlies all the diversities of
external 
Nature. 
In the fourth stage of consciousness that One is seen, and with the
transcending 
the barrier set up by the intellect the consciousness spreads out
to embrace the 
world, seeing all things in itself and as parts of itself, and
seeing itself as 
a ray of the LOGOS, and therefore as one with Him. Where is then
the Thinker? He 
has become Consciousness, and, while the spiritual Soul can at will
use any of 
his lower vehicles, he is no longer limited to their use, nor needs
them for 
this full and conscious life. Then is compulsory reincarnation over
and the man 
has destroyed death; he has verily achieved immortality. Then has
he become "a 
pillar in the temple of God and shall go out no more." 
To complete this part of our study, we need to understand the
successive 
quickenings of the vehicles of consciousness, the bringing them one
by one into 
activity as the harmonious instruments of the human Soul. 
We have seen that from the very beginning of his separate life the
Thinker has 
possessed coatings of mental, astral, etheric, and dense physical
matter. These 
form the media by which his life vibrates outwards, the bridge of
consciousness, 
as we may call it, along which all impulses from the Thinker may
reach the dense 
physical body, all impacts from the outer world may reach him. 
But this general use of the successive bodies as parts of a connected
whole is a 
very different thing from the quickening of each in turn to serve
as a distinct 
vehicle of consciousness, independently of those below it, and it
is this 
quickening of the vehicles that we have now to consider. The lowest
vehicle, the 
dense physical body, is the first one to be brought into harmonious
working 
order; the brain and the nervous system have to be elaborated and
to be rendered 
delicately responsive to every thrill which is within their gamut
of vibratory 
power. In the early stages, while the physical dense body is
composed of the 
grosser kinds of matter, this gamut is extremely limited, and the
physical organ 
of the mind can respond only to the slowest vibrations sent down. 
It answers far more promptly, as is natural, to the impacts from
the external 
world caused by objects similar in materials to itself. Its
quickening as a 
vehicle of consciousness consists in its being made responsive to
the vibrations 
that are initiated from within, and the rapidity of this quickening
depends on 
the co-operation of the lower nature with the higher, its loyal
subordination of 
itself in the service of its inner ruler. 
When after many, many life-periods, it dawns upon the lower nature
that it 
exists for the sake of the soul, that all its value depends on the
help it can 
bring to the soul, that it can win immortality only by merging
itself in the 
soul, then its evolution proceeds in giant strides. Before this,
the evolution 
has been unconscious; at first, the gratification of the lower
nature was the 
object of life, and, while this was a necessary preliminary for
calling out the 
energies of the Thinker, it did nothing directly to render the body
a vehicle of 
consciousness; the direct working upon it begins when the life of
the man 
establishes its centre in the mental body, and when thought
commences to 
dominate sensation. 
The exercise of the mental powers works on the brain and the
nervous system, and 
the coarser materials are gradually expelled to make room for the
finer, which 
can vibrate in unison with the thought-vibrations sent to them. The
brain 
becomes finer in constitution, and increases by ever more
complicated 
convolutions the amount of surface available for the coating of
nervous matter 
adapted to respond to thought-vibrations. The nervous system
becomes more 
delicately balanced, more sensitive, more alive to every thrill of
mental 
activity. And when the recognition of its function as an instrument
of the Soul, 
spoken of above, has come, then active co-operation in performing
this function 
sets in. The personality begins deliberately to discipline itself,
and to set 
the permanent interests of the immortal individual above its own
transient 
gratifications. 
It yields up the time that might be spent in the pursuit of lower
pleasures to 
the evolution of mental powers; day by day time is set apart for
serious study; 
the brain is gladly surrendered to receive impacts from within
instead of from 
without, is trained to answer to consecutive thinking, and is
taught to refrain 
from throwing up its own useless disjointed images, made by past
impressions. It 
is taught to remain at rest when it is not wanted by its master; to
answer, not 
to initiate vibrations. (One of the signs that it is being accomplished
is the 
cessation of the confused jumble of fragmentary images which are
set up during 
sleep by the independent activity of the physical brain. When the
brain is 
coming under control this kind of dream is very seldom
experienced.) 
Further, some discretion and discrimination will be used as to the
food-stuffs 
which supply physical materials to the brain. The use of the
coarser kinds will 
be discontinued, such as animal flesh and blood and alcohol, and
pure food will 
build up a pure body. Gradually the lower vibrations will find no
materials 
capable of responding to them, and the physical body thus becomes
more and more 
entirely a vehicle of consciousness, delicately responsive to all
the thrills of 
thought and keenly sensitive to the vibrations sent outwards by the
Thinker. 
The etheric double so closely follows the constitution of the dense
body that it 
is not necessary to study separately its purification and
quickening; it does 
not normally serve as a separate vehicle of consciousness, but
works 
synchronously with its dense partner, and when separated from it
either by 
accident or by death, it responds very feebly to the vibrations
initiated from 
within. It function in truth is not to serve as a vehicle of 
mental-consciousness, but as a vehicle of Prâna, of specialised
life-force, and 
its dislocation from the denser particles to which it conveys the
life-currents 
is therefore disturbing and mischievous. 
The astral body is the second vehicle of consciousness to be
vivified, and we 
have already seen the changes through which it passes as it becomes
organised 
for the work. (see Chapter II, "The Astral Plane".). When
it is thoroughly 
organised, the consciousness which has hitherto worked within it,
imprisoned by 
it, when in sleep it has left the physical body and is drifting
about in the 
astral world, begins not only to receive the impressions through it
of astral 
objects that form the so-called dream-consciousness, but also to
perceive astral 
objects by its senses – that is, begins to relate the impressions
received to 
the objects which give rise to those impressions. 
These perceptions are at first confused, just as are the
perceptions at first 
made by the mind through a new physical baby-body, and they have to
be corrected 
by experience in the one case as in the other. The Thinker has
gradually to 
discover the new powers which he can use through this subtler
vehicle, and by 
which he can control the astral elements and defend himself against
astral 
dangers. He is not left alone to face this new world unaided, but
is taught and 
helped and – until he can guard himself – protected by those who
are more 
experienced than himself in the ways of the astral world. Gradually
the new 
vehicle of consciousness comes completely under his control, and
life on the 
astral plane is as natural and as familiar as life on the physical.
The third vehicle of consciousness, the mental body, is rarely, if
ever, 
vivified for independent action without the direct instruction of a
teacher, and 
its functioning belongs to the life of the disciple at the present
stage of 
human evolution. (See Chapter XI, "Man’s Ascent"). As we
have already seen, it 
is rearranged for separate functioning (See Chapter IV, "The
Mental Plane"), on 
the mental plane, and here again experience and training are needed
ere it comes 
fully under its owner’s control. A fact – common to all these three
vehicles of 
consciousness, but more apt to mislead perhaps in the subtler than
in the 
denser, because it is generally forgotten in their case, while it
is so obvious 
that it is remembered in the denser – is that they are subject to
evolution, and 
that with their higher evolution their powers to receive and to
respond to 
vibrations increase. 
How many more shades of a colour are seen by a trained eye than by
an untrained. 
How many overtones are heard by a trained ear, where the untrained
hears only 
the single fundamental note. As the physical senses grow more keen
the world 
becomes fuller and fuller, and where the peasant is conscious only
his furrow 
and his plough, the cultured mind is conscious of hedgerow flower
and quivering 
aspen, of rapturous melody down-dropping from the skylark and the
whirring of 
tiny wings through the adjoining wood, of the scudding of rabbits
under the 
curled fronds of the bracken, and the squirrels playing with each
other through 
the branches of the beeches, of all the gracious movements of wild
things, of 
all the fragrant odours of filed and woodland, of all the changing
glories of 
the cloud-flecked sky, and of all the chasing lights and shadows on
the hills. 
Both the peasant and the cultured have eyes, both have brains, but
of what 
differing powers of observation, of what differing powers to
receive 
impressions. 
Thus also in other worlds. As the as the astral and mental bodies
begin to 
function as separate vehicles of consciousness, they are in, as it
were, the 
peasant stage of receptivity, and only fragments of the astral and
mental 
worlds, with their strange and elusive phenomena, make their way
into 
consciousness; but they evolve rapidly, embracing more and more,
and conveying 
to consciousness a more and more accurate reflection of its
environment. Here, 
as everywhere else, we have to remember that our knowledge is not
the limit of 
Nature’s powers, and that in the astral and mental worlds, as in
the physical, 
we are still children, picking up a few shells cast up by the
waves, while the 
treasures hid in the ocean are still unexplored. 
The quickening of the causal body as a vehicle of consciousness
follows in due 
course the quickening of the mental body, and opens up to a man a
yet more 
marvelous state of consciousness, stretching backwards into an
illimitable past, 
onwards into the reaches of the future. Then the Thinker not only
possesses the 
memory of his own past and can trace his growth through the long
succession of 
his incarnate and excarnate lives, but he can also roam at will
through the 
storied past of the earth, and learn the weighty lessons of
world-experience, 
studying the hidden laws that guide evolution and the deep secrets
of life 
hidden in the bosom of Nature. 
In that lofty vehicle of consciousness he can each the veiled Isis,
and lift a 
corner of her down-dropped veil; for there he can face her eyes
without being 
blinded by her lightening glances, and he can see in the radiance
that flows 
from her the causes of the world’s sorrow and its ending, with
heart pitiful and 
compassionate, but no longer wrung with helpless pain. Strength and
calm and 
wisdom come to those who are using the causal body as a vehicle of 
consciousness, and who behold with opened eyes the glory of the
Good law. 
When the buddhic body is quickened as a vehicle of consciousness
the man enters 
into the bliss of non-separateness, and knows in full and vivid
realisation his 
unity with all that is. As the predominant element of consciousness
in the 
causal body is knowledge, and ultimately wisdom, so the predominant
element of 
consciousness in the buddhic body is bliss and love. The serenity
of wisdom 
chiefly marks the one, while the tenderest compassion streams forth
inexhaustibly from the other; when to these is added the godlike
and unruffled 
strength that marks the functioning of Âtma, then humanity is
crowned with 
divinity, and the God-man is manifest in all the plenitude of his
power, of his 
wisdom, of his love. 
The handing down to the lower vehicles of such part of the
consciousness 
belonging to the higher as they are able to receive does not
immediately follow 
on the successive quickening of the vehicles. In this matter
individuals differ 
very widely, according to their circumstances and their work, for
this 
quickening of the vehicles above the physical rarely occurs till
probationary 
discipleship is reached, ( See Chapter XI, "Man’s
Ascent"), and then the duties 
to be discharged depend on the needs of the time. 
The disciple, and even the aspirant for discipleship, is taught to
hold all his 
powers entirely for the service of the world, and the sharing of
the lower 
consciousness in the knowledge of the higher is for the most part
determined by 
the needs of the work in which the disciple is engaged. It is
necessary that the 
disciple should have the full use of his vehicles of consciousness
on the higher 
planes, as much of his work can be accomplished only in them; but
the conveying 
of knowledge of that work to the physical vehicle, which is in no
way concerned 
in it, is a matter of no importance and the conveyance or
non-conveyance is 
generally determined by the effect that the one course or the other
would have 
on the efficiency of his work on the physical plane. 
The strain on the physical body when the higher consciousness
compels it to 
vibrate responsively is very great, at the present stage of
evolution, and 
unless the external circumstances are very favourable this strain
is apt to 
cause nervous disturbance, hyper-sensitiveness with its attendant
evils. Hence 
most of those who are in full possession of the quickened higher
vehicles of 
consciousness, and whose most important work is done out of the
body, remain 
apart from the busy haunts of men, if they desire to throw down
into the 
physical consciousness the knowledge they use on the higher planes,
thus 
preserving the sensitive physical vehicle from the rough usage and
clamour of 
ordinary life. 
The main preparation to be made for receiving in the physical
vehicle the 
vibrations of the higher consciousness are: its purification from
grosser 
materials by pure food and pure life; the entire subjugation of the
passions, 
and the cultivation of an even, balanced temper and mind,
unaffected by the 
turmoil and vicissitudes of external life ; the habit of quiet
meditation on 
lofty topics, turning the mind away from the objects of the senses,
and from the 
mental images arising from them, and fixing it on higher things ;
the cessation 
of hurry, especially of that restless, excitable hurry of the mind,
which keeps 
the brain continually at work and flying from one subject to
another ; the 
genuine love for the things of the higher world, that makes them
more attractive 
than the objects of the lower, so that the mind rests contentedly
in their 
companionship as in that of a well-loved friend. 
In fact, the preparations are much the same as those necessary for
the conscious 
separation of "soul" from "body" and those were
elsewhere stated by me as 
follows: 
The student – 
"Must begin by practising extreme temperance in all things,
cultivating an 
equable and serene state of mind, his life must be clean and his
thoughts pure, 
his body held in strict subjection to the soul, and his mind
trained to occupy 
itself with noble and lofty themes; he must habitually practise
compassion, 
sympathy, helpfulness to others, with indifference to troubles and
pleasures 
affecting himself, and he must cultivate courage, steadfastness,
and devotion. 
In fact, he must live the religion and ethics that other people for
the most 
part only talk. Having by persevering practice learned to control
his mind to 
some extent so that he is able to keep it fixed on one line of
thought for some 
little time, he must begin its more rigid training, by a daily
practice of 
concentration on some difficult or abstract subject, or on some
lofty object of 
devotion; this concentration means the firm fixing of the mind on
one single 
point, without wandering, and without yielding to any distraction caused
by 
external objects, by the activity of the senses, or by that of the
mind itself. 
It must be braced up to an unswerving steadiness and fixity, until
gradually it 
will learn so to withdraw its attention form the outer world and
from the body 
that the senses will remain quiet and still, while the mind is
intensely alive 
with all its energies drawn inwards to be launched at a single
point of thought, 
the highest to which it can attain. 
When it is able to hold itself thus with comparative ease it is
ready for a 
further step, and by a strong but calm effort of the will it can
throw itself 
beyond the highest thought it can reach while working in the
physical brain, and 
in the effort will rise and unite itself with the higher
consciousness and find 
itself free of the body. When this is done there is no sense of
sleep or dream 
nor any loss of consciousness; the man finds himself outside his
body, but as 
though he merely slipped off a weighty encumbrance, nor as though
he had lost 
any part of himself; he is not really "disembodied", but
had risen out of the 
gross body ‘in a body of light’ which obeys his slightest thought
and serves as 
a beautiful and perfect instrument for carrying out his will. In
this he is free 
of the subtle worlds, but will need to train his faculties long and
carefully 
for reliable work under the new conditions. 
"Freedom from the body may be obtained in other ways; by the
rapt intensity of 
devotion or by special methods that may be imparted by a great
teacher to his 
disciple. 
Whatever the way, the end is the same – the setting free of the
soul in full 
consciousness, able to examine its new surroundings in regions
beyond the 
treading of the flesh of the man of flesh. At will it can return to
the body and 
re-enter it, and under these circumstances it can impress on the
brain-mind, and 
thus retain while in the body, the memory of the experiences it has
undergone." 
[ Conditions of life after death" Nineteenth Century of Nov.
1896 ] 
Those who have grasped the main ideas sketched in the foregoing
pages will feel 
that these ideas are in themselves the strongest proof that
reincarnation is a 
fact in nature. It is necessary in order that the vast evolution
implied in the 
phrase, " the evolution of the soul," may be
accomplished. The only alternative 
– putting aside for the moment the materialistic idea that the soul
is only the 
aggregate of the vibrations of a particular kind of physical matter
– is that 
each soul is a new creation, made when a babe is born, and stamped
with virtuous 
or with vicious tendencies, endowed with ability or with stupidity,
by the 
arbitrary whim of the creative power. 
As the Muhammadan would say, his fate is hung round his neck at birth,
for a 
man’s fate depends on his character and his surroundings, and a
newly created 
soul flung into the world must be doomed to happiness or misery
according to the 
circumstances environing him and the character stamped upon him.
Predestination 
in its most offensive form is the alternative of reincarnation.
Instead of 
looking on men as slowly evolving, so that the brutal savage of
today will in 
time evolve the noblest qualities of saint and hero, and thus,
seeing in the 
world a wisely planned and wisely directed process of growth, we
shall be 
obliged to see in it a chaos of most unjustly treated sentient
beings, awarded 
happiness or misery, knowledge or ignorance, virtue or vice, wealth
or poverty, 
genius or idiocy, by an arbitrary external will, unguided by either
justice or 
mercy – a veritable pandemonium, irrational and unmeaning. 
And this chaos is supposed to be the higher part of the cosmos, in
the lower 
regions of which are manifested all the orderly and beautiful
workings of a law 
that ever evolves higher and more complex form from the lower and
the simpler, 
that obviously "makes for righteousness," for harmony and
for beauty. 
If it be admitted that the soul of the savage is destined to live
and evolve, 
and that he is not doomed for eternity to his present infant state,
but that his 
evolution will take place after death and in other worlds, then the
principle of 
soul-evolution is conceded, and the question of the place of
evolution alone 
remains. Were all souls on earth at the same stage of evolution,
much might be 
said for the contention that further worlds are needed for the
evolution of 
souls beyond the infant stage. 
But we have around us souls that are far advanced, and that were
born with noble 
mental and moral qualities. But parity of reasoning, we must
suppose them to 
have been evolved in other worlds ere their one birth in this, and
we cannot but 
wonder why an earth that offers varied conditions, fit for
little-developed and 
also for advanced souls, should be paid only one flying visit by
souls at every 
stage of development, all the rest of their evolution being carried
on in worlds 
similar to this, equally able to afford all the conditions needed
to evolve the 
souls of different stages of evolution, as we find them to be when
they are born 
here. 
The Ancient Wisdom teaches, indeed, that the soul progresses
through many 
worlds, but it also teaches that he is born in each of these worlds
over and 
over again, until he has completed the evolution possible in that
world. The 
worlds themselves, according to its teaching, form an evolutionary
chain, and 
each plays its own part as a field for certain stages of evolution.
Our own 
world offers a field suitable for the evolution of the mineral,
vegetable, 
animal and human kingdoms, and therefore collective or individual
reincarnation 
goes on upon it in all these kingdoms. Truly, further evolution
lies before us 
in other worlds, but in the divine order they are not open to us
until we have 
learned and mastered the lessons of our own world has to teach. 
There are many lines of thought that lead us to the same goal of
reincarnation, 
as we study the world around us. The immense differences that
separate man from 
man have already been noticed as implying an evolutionary past
behind each soul; 
and attention has been drawn to these differentiating the
individual 
reincarnation of men – all of whom belong to a single species –
from the 
reincarnation of monadic group-souls in the lower kingdoms. The
comparatively 
small differences that separate the physical bodies of men, all
being externally 
recognisable as men, should be contrasted with the immense
differences that 
separate the lowest savage and the noblest human type in mental and
moral 
capacities. Savages are often splendid in physical development and
with large 
cranial contents, but how different their minds from that of a
philosopher or 
saint! 
If high mental and moral qualities are regarded as the accumulated
results of 
civilised living, then we are confronted with the fact that the
ablest men of 
the present are over-topped by the intellectual giants of the past,
and that 
none of our own day reaches the moral altitude of some historical
saints. 
Further, we have to consider that genius has neither parent nor
child; that it 
appears suddenly and not as the apex of a gradually improving
family, and is 
itself generally sterile, or, if a child be born to it, it is a
child of the 
body, not of the mind. 
Still more significantly, a musical genius is for the most part
born in a 
musical family, because that form of genius needs for its
manifestation a 
nervous organisation of a peculiar kind, and nervous organisation
falls under 
the law of heredity. But how often in such a family its object
seems over when 
it has provided a body for a genius, and it then flickers out and
vanishes in a 
few generations into the obscurity of average humanity. Where are
the 
descendants of Bach, of Beethoven, of Mozart, of Mendelssohn, equal
to their 
sires? Truly genius does not descend from father to son, like the
family types 
of the Stuart and the Bourbon. 
On what ground, save that or reincarnation, can the "infant
prodigy" be 
accounted for? Take as an instance the case of the child who became
Dr. Young, 
the discoverer of the undulatory theory of light, a man whose
greatness is 
scarcely yet sufficiently widely recognised. As a child of two he
could read 
"with considerable fluency", and before he was four he
had read through the 
Bible twice; at seven he began arithmetic, and mastered
Walkingham’s Tutor’s 
Assistant before he had reached the middle of it under his tutor,
and a few 
years later we find him mastering, while at school, Latin, Greek,
Hebrew, 
mathematics, book-keeping, French, Italian, turning and
telescope-making and 
delighting in Oriental literature. 
At fourteen he was to be placed under private tuition with a boy a
year and a 
half younger, but, the tutor first engaged failing to arrive, Young
taught the 
other boy. (Life of Dr. Thomas Young, by G. Peacock, D.D.). Sir
William Rowan 
Hamilton showed power even more precocious. He began to learn
Hebrew when he was 
barely three, and "at the age of seven he was pronounced by
one of the Fellows 
of Trinity College, Dublin, to have shown a greater knowledge of
the language 
than many candidates for a fellowship. At the age of thirteen he
had acquired 
considerable knowledge of at least thirteen languages. 
Among these, besides the classical and the modern European
languages, were 
included Persian, Arabic, Sanskrit, Hindustani, and even Malay…..
He wrote, at 
the age of fourteen, a complimentary letter to the Persian
Ambassador, who 
happened to visit Dublin; and the latter said that he had not
thought there was 
a man in Britain who could have written such a document in the
Persian language. 
A relative of his says: "I remember him a little boy of six,
when he would 
answer a difficult mathematical question, and run off gaily to his
little cart. 
At twelve he engaged Colburn, the American ‘calculating boy,’ who
was then being 
exhibited as a curiosity in Dublin, and he had not always the worst
of the 
encounter." When he was eighteen, Dr. Brinkley (Royal
Astronomer of Ireland) 
said of him in 1823: "This young man, I do not say will be,
but is, the first 
mathematician of his age." "At college his career was
perhaps unexampled. Among 
a number of competitors of more than ordinary merit, he was first
in every 
subject, and at every examination. (North British Review, September
1866). 
Let the thoughtful student compare these boys with a semi-idiot, or
even with an 
average lad, note how, starting with these advantages, they become
leaders of 
thought, and then ask himself whether such souls have no past behind
them. 
Family likenesses are generally explained as being due to the
"law of heredity," 
but differences in mental and in moral character are continually
found within a 
family circle, and these are left unexplained. Reincarnation
explains the 
likenesses by the fact that a soul in taking birth is directed to a
family which 
provides by its physical heredity a body suitable to express his 
characteristics; and it explains the unlikenesses by attaching the
mental and 
moral character to the individual himself, while showing that ties
set up in the 
past have led him to take birth in connection with some other
individual of that 
family. (See Chapter IX, on "Karma"). 
A "matter of significance in connection with twins is that
during infancy they 
will often be indistinguishable from each other, even to the keen
eye of the 
mother and of nurse; whereas, later in life, when Manas has been
working on his 
physical encasement, he will have so modified it that the physical
likeness 
lessens and the differences of character stamp themselves on the
mobile 
features." [ Reincarnation by Annie Besant, ] Physical
likeness with mental and 
moral unlikeness seems to imply the meeting of two different lines
of causation. 
The striking dissimilarity found to exist between people of about
equal 
intellectual power in assimilating particular kinds of knowledge is
another 
"pointer" to reincarnation. A truth is recognised at once
by one, while the 
other fails to grasp it even after long and careful observation.
Yet the very 
opposite may be the case when another truth is presented to them,
and it may be 
seen by the second and missed by the first. "Two students are
attracted to 
Theosophy and begin to study it, at a year’s end
one is familiar with its main 
conceptions and can apply them, while the other is struggling in a
maze. To the 
one each principle seemed familiar on presentation ; to the other
new, 
unintelligible, strange. 
The believer in reincarnation understands that the teaching is old
to the one, 
and new to the other; one learns quickly because he remembers, he
is but 
recovering past knowledge; the other learns slowly because his
experience has 
not included these truths of nature, and he is acquiring them toil
fully for the 
first time.[ Reincarnation by annie Besant, ] " So also
ordinary intuition is 
"merely recognition of a fact familiar in a past life, though
met with for the 
first time in the present," another sign of the road along
which the individual 
has traveled in the past. 
The main difficulty with many people in the reception of the
doctrine of 
reincarnation is their own absence of memory of their past. Yet
they are every 
day familiar with the fact that they have forgotten very much even
of their 
lives in their present bodies, and that the early years of
childhood are blurred 
and those of infancy a blank. They must also know that events of
the past which 
have entirely slipped out of their normal consciousness are yet
hidden away in 
dark caves of memory and ban be brought out again vividly in some
forms of 
disease or under the influence of mesmerism. 
A dying man has been known to speak a language heard only in
infancy, and 
unknown to him during a long life; in delirium, events long
forgotten have 
presented themselves vividly to the consciousness. Nothing is
really forgotten; 
but much is hidden out of sight of the limited vision of our waking
consciousness, the most limited form of our consciousness, although
the only 
consciousness recognised by the vast majority. Just as memory of
some of the 
present life is in-drawn beyond the reach of this waking
consciousness, and 
makes itself known again only when the brain is hypersensitive and
thus able to 
respond to vibrations that usually beat against it unheeded, so is
the memory of 
the past lives stored up our of reach of the physical
consciousness. It is all 
with the Thinker, who alone persists from life to life; he has the
whole book of 
memory within his reach, for he is the only " I " that
has passed through all 
the experiences recorded therein. 
Moreover, he can impress his own memories of the past on his
physical vehicle, 
as soon as it has been sufficiently purified to answer his swift
and subtle 
vibrations, and then the man of flesh can share his knowledge of
the storied 
past. The difficulty of memory does not lie in forgetfulness, for
the lower 
vehicle, the physical body, has never passed through the previous
lives of its 
owner; it lies in the absorption of the present body in its present
environment, 
in its coarse unresponsiveness to the delicate thrills in which
alone the soul 
can speak. Those who would remember the past must not have their
interests 
centred in the present, and they must purify and refine the body
till it is able 
to receive impressions from the subtler spheres. 
Memory of their own past lives, however, is possessed by a
considerable number 
of people who have achieved the necessary sensitiveness of the
physical 
organism, and to these of course, reincarnation is no longer a
theory, but has 
become a matter of personal knowledge. They have learned how much
richer life 
becomes when memories of past lives pout into it, when the friends
of this brief 
day are found to be the friends of the long-ago, and old
remembrances strengthen 
the ties of the fleeting present. Life gains security and dignity
when it is 
seen with a long vista behind it, and when the loves of old
reappear in the 
loves of today. Death fades into its proper place as a mere
incident in life, a 
change from one scene to another, like a journey that separates
bodies but 
cannot sunder friend from friend. The links of the present are
found to be part 
of a golden chain that stretches backwards, and the future can be
faced with a 
glad security in the thought that these links will endure through
days to come, 
and form part of that unbroken chain. 
Now and then we find children who have brought over a memory of
their immediate 
past, for the most part when they have died in childhood and are
reborn almost 
immediately. In the West such cases are rarer than in the East,
because in the 
West the first words of such a child would be met with disbelief,
and he would 
quickly lose faith in his own memories. In the East, where belief
in 
reincarnation is almost universal, the child’s remembrances are
listened to, and 
where the opportunity serves they have been verified. 
There is another important point with respect to memory that will
repay 
consideration. The memory of past events remains, as we have seen,
with the 
Thinker only, but the results of those events embodied in faculties
are at the 
service of the lower man. If the whole of these past events were
thrown down 
into the physical brain, a vast mass of experiences in no
classified order, 
without arrangement, the man could not be guided by the out come of
the past, 
nor utilise it for present help. Compelled to make a choice between
two lines of 
action, he would have to pick, out of the un-arranged facts from
his past, 
events similar in character, trace out their results, and after
long and weary 
study arrive at some conclusion – a conclusion very likely to be
vitiated by the 
overlooking of some important factor, and reached long after the
need for 
decision had passed. 
All the events, trivial and important, of some hundreds of lives
would form a 
rather unwieldy and chaotic mass for reference in an emergency that
demanded a 
swift action. The far more effective plan of Nature leaves to the
Thinker the 
memory of the events, provides a long period of excarnate existence
for the 
mental body, during which all events are tabulated and compared and
their 
results are classified; then these results are embodied as
faculties, and these 
faculties form the next mental body of the Thinker. 
In this way, the enlarged and improved faculties are available for
immediate 
use, and, the faculties of the past being in them, a decision can
be come to, in 
accordance with those results and without any delay. The clear
quick insight and 
prompt judgment are nothing else than the outcome of past
experiences, moulded 
into an effective form for use; they are surely more useful
instruments than 
would be a mass of unassimilated experiences, out of which the
relevant ones 
would have to be selected and compared, and from which inferences
would have to 
be drawn, on each separate occasion on which a choice arises. 
From all these lines of thought, however, the mind turns back to
rest on the 
fundamental necessity for reincarnation if life is to be made
intelligible, and 
if injustice and cruelty are not to mock the helplessness of man.
With 
reincarnation man is a dignified, immortal being, evolving towards
a divinely 
glorious end; without it, he is a tossing straw on the stream of
chance 
circumstances , irresponsible for his character, for his actions,
for his 
destiny. 
With it, he may look forward with fearless hope, however low in the
scale of 
evolution he may be today, for he is on the ladder to divinity, and
the climbing 
to its summit is only a question of time; without it, he has no
reasonable 
ground of assurance as to progress in the future, nor indeed any
reasonable 
ground of assurance in a future at all. Why should a creature
without a past 
look forward to a future?He may be a mere bubble on the ocean of
time. Flung 
into the world from non-entity, with qualities of good or evil,
attached to him 
without reason or desert, why should he strive to make the best of
them? Will 
not his future, if he have one, be as isolated, as uncaused, as
unrelated as his 
present? In dropping reincarnation from its beliefs, the modern
world has 
deprived God of His justice and has bereft man of his security; he
may be 
"lucky" or "unlucky" but the strength and
dignity conferred by reliance on a 
changeless law are rent away from him, and he is left tossing
helplessly on an 
un-navigable ocean of life. 
KARMA
Having traced the evolution of the soul by the way of
reincarnation, we are now 
in a position to study the great law of causation under which
rebirths are 
carried on, the law which is named Karma. Karma is a Sanskrit word,
literally 
meaning "action"; as all actions are effects flowing from
preceding causes, and 
as each effect becomes a cause of future effects, this idea of
cause and effect 
is an essential part of the idea of action, and the word action, or
karma, is 
therefore used for causation, or for the unbroken linked series of
causes and 
effects that make up all human activity. 
Hence the phrase is sometimes used of an event, "This is my
karma," i.e., "This 
event is the effect of a cause set going by me in the past."
No one life is 
isolated! It is the child of all the lives before it, the parent of
all the 
lives that follow it, in the total aggregate of the lives that make
up the 
continuing existence of the individual. 
There is no such thing as "chance" or as
"accident"; every event is linked to a 
preceding cause, to a following effect; all thoughts, deeds,
circumstances are 
causally related to the past and will causally influence the
future; as our 
ignorance shrouds from our vision alike the past and the future,
events often 
appear to us to come suddenly from the void, to be
"accidental," but this 
appearance is illusory and is due entirely to our lack of
knowledge. Just as the 
savage, ignorant of the laws of the physical universe, regards
physical events 
as uncaused, and the results of unknown physical laws as
"miracles"; so do many, 
ignorant of moral and mental laws, regard moral and mental events
as uncaused, 
and the results of unknown moral and mental laws as good and bad
"luck." 
When at first this idea of inviolable, immutable law is a realm
hitherto vaguely 
ascribed to chance dawns upon the mind, it is apt to result in a
sense of 
helplessness, almost of moral and mental paralysis. Man seems to be
held in the 
grip of an iron destiny, and the resigned "kismet" of the
Moslem appears to be 
the only philosophical utterance. Just so might the savage feel
when the idea of 
physical law first dawns on his startled intelligence, and he
learns that every 
movement of his body, every movement in external nature, is carried
on under 
immutable laws. 
Gradually he learns that natural laws only lay down conditions
under which all 
workings must be carried on, but do not prescribe the workings; so
that man 
remains ever free at the centre, while limited in his external
activities by the 
conditions of the plane on which those activities are carried on.
He learns 
further that while the conditions master him, constantly
frustrating his 
strenuous efforts, so long as he is ignorant of them, or, knowing
them, fights 
against them, he masters them and they become his servants and
helpers when he 
understands them, knows their directions, and calculates their
forces. 
In truth science is possible only on the physical plane because its
laws are 
inviolable, immutable. Were there no such things as natural laws,
there could be 
no sciences. An investigator makes a number of experiments, and
from the results 
of these he learns how Nature works; knowing this, he can calculate
how to bring 
about a certain desired result, and if he fail in achieving that
result he knows 
that he has omitted some necessary condition – either his knowledge
is 
imperfect, or he has made a miscalculation. He reviews his
knowledge, revises 
his methods, recasts his calculations, with a serene and complete
certainty that 
if he ask his question rightly Nature will answer him with
unvarying precision. 
Hydrogen and oxygen will not give him water today and prussic acid
tomorrow; 
fire will not burn him today and freeze him tomorrow. If water be a
fluid today 
and a solid tomorrow, it is because the conditions surrounding it
have been 
altered, and the reinstatement of the original conditions will
bring about the 
original result. 
Every new piece of information about the laws of Nature is not a
fresh 
restriction but a fresh power, for all these energies of Nature
become forces 
which he can use in proportion as he understands them. Hence the
saying that 
"knowledge is power," for exactly in proportion to his
knowledge can he utilise 
these forces; by selecting those with which he will work, by
balancing one 
against another, by neutralising opposing energies that would
interfere with his 
object, he can calculate beforehand the result, and bring about
what he 
predetermines. 
Understanding and manipulating causes, he can predict effects, and
thus the very 
rigidity of nature which seemed at first to paralyse human action
can be used to 
produce and infinite variety of results. Perfect rigidity in each
separate force 
makes possible perfect flexibility in their combinations. For the
forces being 
of every kind, moving in every direction, and each being
calculable, a selection 
can be made and the selected forces so combined as to yield any
desired result. 
The object to be gained being determined, it can be infallibly
obtained by a 
careful balancing of forces in the combination put together as a
cause. But, be 
it remembered, knowledge is requisite thus to guide events, to
bring about 
desired results. The ignorant man stumbles helplessly along,
striking himself 
against the immutable laws and seeing his efforts fail, while the
man of 
knowledge walks steadily forward, foreseeing, causing, preventing,
adjusting, 
and bringing about that at which he aims, not because he is lucky
but because he 
understands. The one is the toy, the slave of Nature, whirled along
by her 
forces: the other is her master, using her energies to carry him
onwards in the 
direction chosen by his will. 
That which is true of the physical realm of law is true of the
moral and mental 
worlds, equally realms of law. Here also the ignorant is a slave,
the sage is a 
monarch; here also the inviolability, the immutability, that were
regarded as 
paralysing, are found to be the necessary conditions of sure
progress and of 
clear-sighted direction of the future. Man can become the master of
his destiny 
only because that destiny lies in a realm of law, where knowledge
can build up 
the science of the soul and place in the hands of man the power of
controlling 
his future – of choosing alike his future character and his future 
circumstances.The knowledge of karma that threatened to paralyse,
becomes an 
inspiring, a supporting, an uplifting force. 
Karma is then, the law of causation, the law of cause and effect.
It was put 
pointedly by the Christian Initiate, S. Paul: "Be not
deceived, God is not 
mocked: for whatsoever a man soweth that shall he also
reap."(Galatians, vi, 7). 
Man is continually sending out forces on all the planes on which he
functions; 
these forces – themselves in quantity and quality the effects of
his past 
activities – are causes which he sets going in each world he
inhabits; they 
bring about certain definite effects both on himself and on others,
and as these 
causes radiate forth from himself as centre over the whole field of
his 
activity, he is responsible for the results they bring about. 
As a magnet has its "magnetic field," an area within
which all its forces play, 
larger or smaller according to its strength, so has every man a
field of 
influence within which play the forces he emits, and these forces
work in curves 
that return to their forth-sender, that re-enter the centre whence
they emerged. 
As the subject is a very complicated one, we will sub-divide it,
and then study 
the subdivisions one by one. 
Three classes of energies are sent forth by man in his ordinary
life, belonging 
respectively to the three worlds that he inhabits; mental energies
on the mental 
plane, giving rise to the causes we call thoughts; desire energies
on the astral 
plane, giving rise to those we call desires; physical energies
aroused by these, 
and working on the physical plane, giving rise to the causes we
call action. We 
have to study each of these in its workings, and to understand the
class of 
effects to which each gives rise, if we wish to trace intelligently
the part 
that each plays in the perplexed and complicated combinations we
set up, called 
in their totality "our Karma." When a man, advancing more
swiftly than his 
fellows, gains the ability to function on higher planes, he then
becomes the 
centre of higher forces, but for the present we may leave these out
of account 
and confine ourselves to ordinary humanity, treading the cycle of
reincarnation 
in the three worlds. 
In studying these three classes of energies we shall have to
distinguish between 
their effect on the man who generates them and their effect on
others who come 
within the field of his influence; for a lack of understanding on
this point 
often leaves the student in a slough of hopeless bewilderment. 
Then we must remember that every force works on its own plane and
reacts on the 
planes below it in proportion to its intensity, the plane on which
it is 
generated gives it its special characteristics, and in its reaction
on lower 
planes it sets up vibrations in their finer or coarser materials
according to 
its own original nature.The motive which generates the activity
determines the 
plane to which the force belongs. 
Next it will be necessary to distinguish between ripe karma, ready
to show 
itself as inevitable events in the present life; the karma of
character, showing 
itself in tendencies that are the outcome of accumulated
experiences, and that 
are capable of being modified in the present life by the same power
(the Ego) 
that created them in the past; the karma that is now making, and
will give rise 
to future events and future character. ( These divisions are
familiar to the 
student as Prarabdha (commenced, to be worked out in the life);
Sanchita 
(accumulated), a part of which is seen in the tendencies,
Kriyamana, (in course 
of making). 
Further, we have to realise that while a man makes his own
individual karma he 
also connects himself thereby with others, thus becoming a member
of various 
groups – family, national, racial – and as a member he shares in
the collective 
karma of each of these groups. 
It will be seen that the study of karma is one of much complexity;
however, by 
grasping the main principles of its working as set out above, a
coherent idea of 
its general bearing may be obtained without much difficulty, and
its details can 
be studied at leisure as opportunity offers. Above all, let it
never be 
forgotten, whether details are understood or not, that each man
makes his own 
karma, creating alike his own capacities and his own limitations;
and that 
working at any time with these self-created capacities, and within
these 
self-created limitations, he is still himself, the living soul, and
can 
strengthen or weaken his capacities, enlarge or contract his
limitations. 
The chains that bind him are of his own forging, and he can file
them away or 
rivet them more strongly; the house he lives in is of his own
building, and he 
can improve it, let it deteriorate, or rebuild it, as he will. We
are ever 
working in plastic clay and can shape it to our fancy, but the clay
hardens and 
becomes as iron, retaining the shape we gave it. A proverb from the
Hitopadesha 
runs, as translated by Sir Edwin Arnold: 
"Look! The clay dries into iron, but the potter moulds the
clay; 
Destiny today is the master – Man was master yesterday. " 
Thus we are all masters of our tomorrows, however much we are
hampered today by 
the results of our yesterdays. 
Let us now take in order the divisions already set out under which
karma may be 
studied. 
Three classes of causes, with their effects on their creator and on
those he 
influences.The first of these classes is composed of our thoughts.
Thought is 
the most potent factor in the creation of human karma, for in
thought the 
energies of the SELF are working in mental matter, the matter
which, in its 
finer kinds, forms the individual vehicle, and even in its coarser
kinds 
responds swiftly to every vibration of self-consciousness. The
vibrations which 
we call thought, the immediate activity of the Thinker, give rise
to forms of 
mind-stuff, or mental images, which shape and mould his mental
body, as we have 
already seen; every thought modifies this mental body, and the
mental faculties 
in each successive life are made by the thinkings of the previous
lives. 
A man can have no thought-power, no mental ability, that he has not
himself 
created by patiently repeated thinkings; on the other hand, no
mental image that 
he has thus created is lost, but remains as material for faculty,
and the 
aggregate of any group of mental images is built into a faculty
which grows 
stronger with every additional thinking, or creation of a mental
image, of the 
same kind. 
Knowing this law, the man can gradually make for himself the mental
character he 
desires to possess and he can do it as definitely and as certainly
as a 
bricklayer can build a wall. Death does not stop his work, but by
setting him 
free from the encumbrance of the body facilitates the process of
working up his 
mental images into the definite organ we call a faculty, and he
brings this back 
with him to his next birth on the physical plane, part of the brain
of the new 
body being moulded so as to serve as the organ of this faculty, in
a way to be 
explained presently. 
All these faculties together form the mental body for his opening
life on earth, 
and his brain and nervous system are shaped to give his mental body
expression 
on the physical plane. Thus the mental images created in one life
appear as 
mental characteristics and tendencies in another, and for this
reason it is 
written in one of the Upanishads: "Man is a creature of
reflection: that which 
he reflects on in this life he becomes the same hereafter."
(Chhandogyopanishad 
IV, xiv,1). Such is the law, and it places the building of our
mental character 
entirely in our own hands; if we build well, ours the advantage and
the credit; 
if we build badly, ours the loss and blame. Mental character, then,
is a case of 
individual karma in its action on the individual who generates it. 
This same man that we are considering, however, affects other by
his thoughts. 
For these mental images that form his own mental body set up
vibrations, thus 
reproducing themselves in secondary forms. These generally, being
mingled with 
desire, take up some astral matter, and I have therefore elsewhere
(see Karma, - 
Theosophical Manual No. IV) called these secondary thought-forms –
astro-mental 
images. Such forms leave their creator and lead a quasi-independent
life – still 
keeping up a magnetic tie with their progenitor. 
They come into contact with and affect others, in this way setting
up karmic 
links between these others and himself; thus they largely influence
his future 
environment. In such fashion are made the ties which draw people
together for 
good or evil in later lives; which surround us with relatives,
friends, and 
enemies; which bring across our path helpers and hinderers, people
who benefit 
and who injure us, people who love us without our winning in this
life, and who 
hate us though in this life we have done nothing to deserve their
hatred. 
Studying the results, we grasp a great principle – that while our
thoughts 
produce our mental and moral character in their action on
ourselves, they help 
to determine our human associates in the future by their effects on
others. 
The second great class of energies is composed of our desires – our
out-goings 
after objects that attract us in the external world: as a mental
element always 
enters into these in man, we may extend the term "mental
images " to include 
them, although they express themselves chiefly in astral matter.
These in their 
action on their progenitor mould and form his body of desire, or
astral body, 
shape his fate when he passes into Kamaloka after death, and
determine the 
nature of his astral body in his next rebirth. 
When the desires are bestial, drunken, cruel, unclean, they are the
fruitful 
causes of congenital diseases, of weak and diseased brains, giving
rise to 
epilepsy, catalepsy, and nervous diseases of all kinds, of physical
malformations and deformities, and, in extreme cases, of
monstrosities. Bestial 
appetites of an abnormal kind or intensity may set up links in the
astral world 
which for a time chain the Egos, clothed in astral bodies shaped by
these 
appetites, to the astral bodies of animals to which these appetites
properly 
belong, thus delaying their reincarnation; where this fate is
escaped, the 
bestially shaped astral body will sometimes impress its
characteristics on the 
forming physical body of the babe during ante natal life, and
produce the 
semi-human horrors that are occasionally born. 
Desires – because they are outgoing energies that attach themselves
to objects – 
always attract the man towards an environment in which they may be
gratified. 
Desires for earthly things, linking the soul to the outer world,
draw him 
towards the place where the objects of desire are most readily
obtainable, and 
therefore it is said that a man is born according to his desires. (
See 
Brihadaranyakopanishad,IV,iv, 5,7,and context). They are one of the
causes that 
determine the place of rebirth. 
The astro-mental images caused by desires affect others as do those
generated by 
thoughts. They, therefore, also link us with other souls, and often
by the 
strongest ties of love and hatred, for at the present stage of
human evolution 
an ordinary man’s desires are generally stronger and more sustained
than his 
thoughts. They thus play a great part in determining his human
surroundings in 
future lives, and may bring into those lives persons and influences
of whose 
connection with himself he is totally unconscious. 
Suppose a man by sending out a thought of bitter hatred and revenge
has helped 
to form in another the impulse which results in a murder; the
creator of that 
thought is linked by his karma to the committer of the crime,
although they have 
never met on the physical plane, and the wrong he has done to him,
by helping to 
impel him to a crime , will come back as an injury in the
infliction of which 
the whilhom criminal will play his part. Many a "bolt from the
blue" that is 
felt is utterly undeserved is the effect of such a cause, and the
soul thereby 
learns and registers a lesson while the lower consciousness is
writhing under a 
sense of injustice. 
Nothing can strike a man that he has not deserved, but his absence
of memory 
does not cause a failure in the working of the law. We thus learn
that our 
desires in their action on ourselves produce our desire-nature, and
through it 
largely affect our physical bodies in our next birth; that they
play a great 
part in determining the place of rebirth; and by their effect on
others they 
help to draw around us our human associates in future lives. 
The third great class of energies, appearing on the physical plane
as actions, 
generate much karma by their effects on others, but only slightly
affect 
directly the Inner Man. They are effects of his past thinkings and desires,
and 
the karma they represent is for the most part exhausted in their
happening. 
Indirectly they affect him in proportion as he is moved by them to
fresh 
thoughts and desires or emotions, but the generating force lies in
these and not 
in the actions themselves. 
Again, if actions are often repeated, they set up a habit of the
body which acts 
as a limitation to the expression of the Ego in the outer world;
this, however, 
perishes with the body, thus limiting the karma of the action to a
single life 
so far as its effect on the soul is concerned. But it far otherwise
when we come 
to study the effects of actions on others, the happiness or
unhappiness caused 
by these, and the influence exercised by these as examples.They
link us to 
others by this influence and are thus a third factor in determining
our future 
human associates, while they are the chief factor in determining
what may be 
called our non-human environment. Broadly speaking, the favourable
or 
unfavourable nature of the physical surroundings into which we are
born depends 
on the effect of our previous actions in spreading happiness or
unhappiness 
among other people. The physical results on others of actions on
the physical 
plane work out karmically in repaying to the actor good or bad
surroundings in a 
future life. 
If he has made people physically happy, by sacrificing wealth or
time or 
trouble, this action karmically brings him favourable physical
circumstances 
conducive to physical happiness. If he has caused people
wide-spread physical 
misery, he will reap karmically from his action wretched physical
circumstances 
conducive to physical suffering. And this is so, whatever may have
been his 
motive in either case – a fact which leads us to consider the law
that: 
Every force works on its own plane. If a man sows happiness for
others on the 
physical plane, he will reap conditions favourable to happiness for
himself on 
that plane, and his motive in sowing it does not affect the result
. A man might 
sow wheat with the object of speculating with it to ruin his
neighbour, but his 
bad motive would not make the wheat grains grow up as dandelions.
Motive is a 
mental or astral force, according as it arises from will or desire,
and it 
reacts on moral and mental character or on the desire-nature
severally. 
The causing of physical happiness by an action is a physical force
and works on 
the physical plane. "By his actions" man affects his
neighbours on the physical 
plane; he spreads happiness around him or he causes distress,
increasing or 
diminishing the sum of human welfare. This increase or diminution
of happiness 
may be due to very different motives – good, bad, or mixed. A man
may do an act 
that gives widespread enjoyment from sheer benevolence, from a
longing to give 
happiness to his fellow creatures. 
Let us say that from such a motive he presents a park to a town for
the free use 
of its inhabitants; another may do a similar act from mere
ostentation, from 
desire to attract attention from those who can bestow social
honours (say, he 
might give it as purchase-money for a title); a third may give a
park from mixed 
motives, partly unselfish, partly selfish. The motives will
severally affect 
these three men’s characters in their future incarnations, for
improvement, for 
degradation, for small results. 
But the effect of the action is causing happiness to large numbers
of people 
does not depend on the motive of the giver; the people enjoy the
park equally, 
no matter what may have prompted its gift, and this enjoyment, due
to the action 
of the giver, establishes for him a karmic claim on Nature, a debt
due to him 
that will be scrupulously paid. He will receive a physically
comfortable or 
luxurious environment, as he has given widespread physical
enjoyment, and his 
sacrifice of physical wealth will bring him his due reward, the
karmic fruit of 
his action. 
This is his right. But the use he makes of his position, the
happiness he 
derives from his wealth and his surroundings, will depend chiefly
on his 
character, and here again the just reward accrues to him, each seed
bearing its 
appropriate harvest. Truly, the ways of Karma are equal. It does
not withhold 
from the bad man the result which justly follows from an action
which spreads 
happiness, and it also deals out to him the deteriorated character
earned by his 
bad motive, so that in the midst of wealth he will remain
discontented and 
unhappy. 
Nor can the good man escape physical suffering if he cause physical
misery by 
mistaken actions done from good motive; the misery he caused will
bring him 
misery in his physical surroundings, but his good motive, improving
his 
character, will give him a source of perennial happiness within
himself, and he 
will be patient and contented amid his troubles. Many a puzzle
maybe answered by 
applying these principles to the facts we see around us. 
These respective effects of motive and of the results (or fruits)
of actions are 
due to the fact that each force has the characteristics of the
plane on which it 
was generated, and the higher the plane the more potent and the
more persistent 
the force. Hence motive is far more important than action, and a
mistaken action 
done with a good motive is productive of more good to the doer than
a 
well-chosen action done with a bad motive. The motive, reacting on
the 
character, gives rise to a long series of effects, for the future
actions guided 
by that character will all be influenced by its improvement or its
deterioration 
‘ whereas the action, bringing on its doer physical happiness or
unhappiness, 
according to its results on others, has in it no generating force,
but is 
exhausted in its results. 
If bewildered as to the path of right action by a conflict of
apparent duties, 
the knower of karma diligently tries to choose the best path, using
his reason 
and judgment to the utmost; he is scrupulously careful about his
motive, 
eliminating selfish considerations and purifying his heart; then he
acts 
fearlessly, and if his action turn out to be a blunder he willingly
accepts the 
suffering which results from his mistake as a lesson which will be
useful in the 
future. Meanwhile, his high motive has ennobled his character for
all time to 
come. 
This general principle that the force belongs to the plane on which
it is 
generated is one of far-reaching import. If it be liberated with
the motive of 
gaining physical objects, it works on the physical plane and
attaches the actor 
to that plane. If it aim at devachanic objects, it works on the
devachanic plane 
and attaches the actor thereto. If it have no motive save the
divine service, it 
is set free on the spiritual plane, and therefore cannot attach the
individual, 
since the individual is asking for nothing. 
The Three Kinds of Karma 
Ripe Karma is that which is ready for reaping and which is
therefore inevitable. 
Out of all the karma of the past there is a certain amount which
can be 
exhausted within the limits of a single life; there are some kinds
of karma that 
are so incongruous that they could not be worked out in a single
physical body, 
but would require very different types of body for their
expression; there are 
liabilities contracted towards other souls, and all these souls
will not be in 
incarnation at the same time; there is karma that must be worked
out in some 
particular nation or particular social position, while the same man
has other 
karma that needs an entirely different environment. 
Part only, therefore, of his total karma can be worked out in a
given life, and 
this part is selected by the Great Lords of Karma – of whom
something will 
presently be said – and the soul is guided to incarnate in a
family, a nation, a 
place, a body, suitable for the exhaustion of that aggregate of
causes which can 
be worked out together. This aggregate of causes fixes the length
of that 
particular life; gives to the body its characteristics, its powers,
and its 
limitations; brings into contact with the man the souls incarnated
within that 
life-period to whom he has contracted obligations, surrounding him
with 
relatives, friends, and enemies; marks out the social conditions
into which he 
is born, with their accompanying advantages and disadvantages; selects
the 
mental energies he can show forth by moulding the organisation of
the brain and 
nervous system with which he has to work; puts together the causes
that result 
in troubles and joys in his outer career and that can be brought
into a single 
life. 
All this is the "ripe karma," and this can be sketched
out in a horoscope cast 
by a competent astrologer. In all this the man has no power of
choice; all is 
fixed by the choices he has made in the past, and he must discharge
to the 
uttermost farthing the liabilities he has contracted. 
The physical, astral and mental bodies which the soul takes on for
a new 
life-period are, as we have seen, the direct result of his past,
and they form a 
most important part of this ripe karma. They limit the soul on every
side, and 
his past rises up in judgment against him, marking out the
limitations which he 
has made for himself. Cheerfully to accept these, and diligently to
work at 
their improvement, is the part of the wise man, for he cannot
escape from them. 
There is another kind of ripe karma that is of very serious
importance – that of 
inevitable actions. Every action is the final expression of a
series of 
thoughts; to borrow an illustration from chemistry, we obtain a
saturated 
solution of thought by adding thought after thought of the same
kind, until 
another thought – or even an impulse, a vibration, from without –
will produce 
the solidification of the whole; the action which expresses the
thoughts. If we 
persistently reiterate thoughts of the same kind, say of revenge,
we at last 
reach the point of saturation, and any impulse will solidify these
into action 
and a crime results. Or we may have persistently reiterated
thoughts of help to 
another to the point of saturation, and when the stimulus of
opportunity touches 
us they crystallise out as an act of heroism. 
A man may bring over with him some ripe karma of this kind, and the
first 
vibration that touches such a mass of thoughts ready to solidify
into action 
will hurry him without his renewed volition, unconsciously, into
the commission 
of the act. He cannot stop to think; he is in the condition in
which the first 
vibration of the mind causes action; poised on the very point of
balancing, the 
slightest impulse sends him over. Under these circumstances a man
will marvel at 
his own commission of some crime, or at his own performance of some
sublime act 
of self-devotion. He says: " I did it without thinking,"
unknowing that he had 
thought so often that he had made that action inevitable. When a
man has willed 
to do an act many times, he at last fixes his will irrevocably, and
it is only a 
question of opportunity when he will act. 
So long he can think, his freedom of choice remains, for he can set
the new 
though against the old and gradually wear it out by the reiteration
of opposing 
thoughts; but when the next thrill of the soul in response to a
stimulus means 
action, the power of choice is exhausted. 
Herein lies the solution of the old problem of necessity and free
will; man by 
the exercise of free will gradually creates necessities for
himself, and between 
the two extremes lie all the combinations of free will and
necessity which make 
the struggles within ourselves of which we are conscious. 
We are continually making habits by the repetitions of purposive
actions guided 
by the will; then the habit becomes a limitation, and we perform
the action 
automatically. Perhaps we are then driven to the conclusion that
the habit is a 
bad one, and we begin laboriously to unmake it by thoughts of the
opposite kind, 
and, after many an inevitable lapse into it, the new
thought-current turns the 
stream, and we regain our full freedom, often again gradually to
make another 
fetter. 
So old thought-forms persist and limit our thinking capacity,
showing as 
individual and as national prejudices. The majority do not know
that they are 
thus limited, and go on serenely in their chains, ignorant of their
bondage; 
those who learn the truth about their own nature become free. The
constitution 
of our brain and nervous system is one of the most marked
necessities in life; 
these we have made inevitable by our past thinkings, and they now
limit us and 
we often chafe against them. They can be improved slowly and
gradually; the 
limits can be expanded, but they cannot be suddenly transcended. 
Another form of this ripe karma is where some past evil-thinking
has made a 
crust of evil habits around a man which imprisons him and makes an
evil life; 
the actions are the inevitable outcome of his past, as just
explained, and they 
have been held over, even through several lives, in consequence of
those lives 
not offering opportunities for their manifestation. Meanwhile the
soul has been 
growing and has been developing noble qualities. In one life this
crust of past 
evil is thrown out by opportunity, and because of this the soul
cannot show his 
later development; like a chicken ready to be hatched, he is hidden
within the 
imprisoning shell, and only the shell is visible to the external
eye. After a 
time that karma is exhausted, and some apparently fortuitous event
– a word from 
a great Teacher, a book, a lecture – breaks the shell and the souls
comes forth 
free. 
These are the rare, sudden, but permanent "conversions,"
the "miracles of divine 
grace," of which we hear; all perfectly intelligible to the
knower of karma, and 
felling within the realm of the law. The accumulated karma that
shows itself as 
character is, unlike the ripe, always subject to modifications. It
may be said 
to consist of tendencies, strong or weak, according to the
thought-force that 
has gone to their making, and these can be further strengthened or
weakened by 
fresh streams of thought-force sent to work with or against them. 
If we find in ourselves tendencies of which we disapprove, we can
set ourselves 
to work to eliminate them; often we fail to withstand temptation,
overborne by 
the strong out-rushing stream of desire, but the longer we can hold
out against 
it, even though we fail in the end, the nearer are we to overcoming
it. Every 
such failure is a step towards success, for the resistance wears
away part of 
the energy, and there is less of it available for the future. The
karma which is 
in the course of making has been already studied. 
Collective Karma 
When a group of people is considered karmically, the play of karmic
forces upon 
each member of the group introduces a new factor into the karma of
the 
individual. We know that when a number of forces play on a point,
the motion of 
the point is not in the direction of any one of these forces, but
in the 
direction which is the result of their combination. So the karma of
a group is 
the resultant of the interacting forces of the individuals
composing it, and all 
the individuals are carried along in the direction of that
resultant. 
An Ego is drawn by his individual karma into a family, having set
up in previous 
lives ties which closely connect him with some of the other Egos
composing it; 
the family has inherited property from a grandfather who is
wealthy; an heir 
turns up, descended from the grandfather’s elder brother, who had
been supposed 
to have died childless, and the wealth passes to him and leaves the
father of 
the family heavily indebted; it is quite possible that our Ego had
had no 
connection in the past with this heir, to whom in past lives the
father had 
contracted some obligation which has resulted in this catastrophe,
and yet he is 
threatened with suffering by his action, being involved with family
karma. 
If, in his own individual past, there was a wrong-doing which can
be exhausted 
by suffering caused by the family karma, he is left involved in it;
if not, he 
is by some "unforeseen circumstances" lifted out of it,
perchance by some 
benevolent stranger who feels an impulse to adopt and educate him,
the stranger 
being one who in the past was his debtor. 
Yet more clearly does this come out, in the working of such things
as railway 
accidents, shipwrecks, floods, cyclones, etc. A train is wrecked,
the 
catastrophe being immediately due to the action of the drivers, the
guards, the 
railway directors, the makers or employees of that line, who
thinking themselves 
wronged, send clustering thoughts of discontent and anger against
it as a whole. 
Those who have in their accumulated karma – but not necessarily in
their ripe 
karma – the debt of a life suddenly cut short, may be allowed to
drift into this 
accident and pay their debt; another, intending to go by the train,
but with no 
such debt in his past, is "providentially" saved by being
late for it. 
Collective karma may throw a man into the troubles consequent on
his nation 
going to war, and here again he may discharge his debts of his past
not 
necessarily within the ripe karma of his then life. In no case can
a man suffer 
that which he has not deserved, but, if an unforeseen opportunity
should arise 
to discharge a past obligation, it is well to pay it and be rid of
it for 
evermore. 
The "Lords of Karma" are the great spiritual
Intelligences who keep the karmic 
Records and adjust the complicated workings of karmic law. They are
described by 
H.P. Blavatsky in The Secret Doctrine as the Lipika, the Recorders
of Karma, and 
the Maharajas (The Mahadevas, or Chaturdevas of the Hindus) – and
Their hosts, 
who are "the agents of Karma upon earth." The Lipika are
They who know the 
karmic record of every man, and who with omniscient wisdom select
and combine 
portions of that record to form the plan of a single life; They
give the "idea" 
of the physical body which is to be the garment of the
reincarnating soul, 
expressing his capacities and his limitations; this is taken by the
Maharajas 
and worked into a detailed model, which is committed to one of
Their inferior 
agents to be copied; this copy is the etheric double , the matrix
of the dense 
body, the materials for these being drawn from the mother and
subject to 
physical heredity. 
The race, the country, the parents, are chosen for their capacity
to provide 
suitable materials for the physical body of the incoming Ego, and
suitable 
surroundings for his early life. The physical heredity of the
family affords 
certain types and has evolved certain peculiarities of material
combinations; 
hereditary diseases, hereditary finenesses of nervous organisation,
imply 
definite combinations of physical matter, capable of transmission. 
An Ego who has evolved peculiarities in his mental and astral bodies,
needing 
special physical peculiarities for their expression, is guided to
parents whose 
physical heredity enables them to meet these requirements. Thus an
Ego with high 
artistic faculties devoted to music would be guided to take his
physical body in 
a musical family, in which the materials supplied for building the
etheric 
double and the dense body would have been made ready to adapt
themselves to his 
needs, and the hereditary type of nervous system would furnish the
delicate 
apparatus necessary for the expression of his faculties. 
An Ego of very evil type would be guided to a coarse and vicious
family, whose 
bodies were built of the coarsest combinations, such as would make
a body able 
to respond to the impulses from his mental and astral bodies. An
Ego who had 
allowed his astral body and lower mind to lead him into excesses,
and had 
yielded to drunkenness, for instance, would be led to incarnate in
a family 
whose nervous systems were weakened by excess, and would be born
from drunken 
parents, who would supply diseased materials for his physical
envelope. The 
guidance of the Lords of Karma thus adjust means to ends, and
insures the doing 
of justice; the Ego brings with him his karmic possessions of
faculties and 
desires, and he receives a physical body suited to be their
vehicle. 
As the soul must return to earth until he has discharged all his
liabilities, 
thus exhausting all his individual karma, and as in each life
thoughts and 
desires generate fresh karma, the question may arise in the mind:
"How can this 
constantly renewing bond be put an end to ? How can the soul attain
his 
liberation?" Thus we come to the "ending of karma,"
and have to investigate how 
this may be. 
The binding element in karma is the first thing to be clearly
grasped. The 
outward going energy of the soul attaches itself to some object,
and the soul is 
drawn back by this tie to the place where that attachment may be
realised by 
union with the object of desire, so long as the soul attaches
himself to any 
object, he must be drawn to the place where that object can be
enjoyed. Good 
karma binds the soul as much as does bad, for any desire, whether
for objects 
here or in Devachan, must draw the soul to the place of
gratification. 
Action is prompted by desire, an act is done not for the sake of
doing the act, 
but for the sake of obtaining by the act something that is desired,
of acquiring 
its results, or, as it is technically called, of enjoying its fruit.
Men work, 
not because they want to dig, or build, or weave, but because they
want the 
fruits of digging, building, and weaving, in the shape of money or
of goods. A 
barrister pleads, not because he wants to set forth the dry details
of a case, 
but because he wants wealth and fame, and rank.Men around us are
labouring for 
something, and the spur to their activity lies in the fruit it
brings them and 
not in the labour. Desire for the fruit of action moves them to
activity, and 
enjoyment of that fruit rewards their exertions. 
Desire is, then , the binding element in karma, and when the soul
no longer 
desires any object in earth or in heaven, his tie to the wheel of
reincarnation 
that turns in the three worlds is broken. Action itself has no
power to hold the 
soul, for with the completion of the action it slips into the past.
But the 
ever-renewed desire for fruit constantly spurs the soul into fresh
activities, 
and thus new chains are continually being forged. 
Nor should we feel any regret when we see men constantly driven to
action by the 
whip of desire, for desire overcomes sloth, laziness, inertia –
(the student 
will remember that these show the dominance of the tamasic guna,
and while it is 
dominant men do not emerge from the lowest of the three stages of
their 
evolution) – and prompts men to the activity that yields them
experience. Note 
the savage, idly dozing on the grass; he is moved to activity by
hunger, the 
desire for food,, and is driven to exert patience, skill, and
endurance to 
gratify his desire. Thus he develops mental qualities, but when his
hunger is 
satisfied he sinks again into a dozing animal. How entirely have
mental 
qualities been evolved by the promptings of desire, and how useful
have proved 
desires for fame, for posthumous renown. Until man is approaching
divinity he 
needs the urgings of desires, and the desires simply grow purer and
less selfish 
as he climbs upwards. But none the less desires bind him to
rebirth, and if he 
would be free he must destroy them. 
When a man begins to long for liberation, he is taught to practise
"renunciation 
of the fruits of action"; that is, he gradually eradicates in
himself the wish 
to possess any object; he at first voluntarily and deliberately
denies himself 
the object, and thus habituates himself to do contentedly without
it; after a 
time he no longer misses it, and he finds the desire for it is
disappearing from 
his mind. At this stage he is very careful not to neglect any work
which is duty 
because he has become indifferent to the results it brings to him,
and he trains 
himself in discharging every duty with earnest attention, while
remaining 
entirely indifferent to the fruits it brings forth.When he attains
perfection in 
this, and neither desires nor dislikes any object, he ceases to
generate karma; 
ceasing to ask anything from the earth or from Devachan, he is not
drawn to 
either; he wants nothing that either can give him, and all links
between himself 
and them are broken off. This is the ceasing of individual karma,
so far as the 
generation of new karma is concerned. 
But the soul has to get rid of old chains as well as to cease from
the forging 
of new, and these old chains must be either allowed to wear out
gradually or 
must be broken deliberately. For this breaking, knowledge is
necessary, a 
knowledge which can look back into the past, and see the causes
there set going, 
causes which are working out their effects in the present. 
Let us suppose that a person, thus looking backward over his past
lives, sees 
certain causes which will bring about an event which is still in
the future; let 
us suppose further that these causes are thoughts of hatred for an
injury 
inflicted on himself, and that they will cause suffering a year
hence to the 
wrong-doer; such a person can introduce a new cause to intermingle
with the 
causes working from the past, and he may counteract them with
strong thoughts of 
love and goodwill that will exhaust them, and will thus prevent
their bringing 
about the otherwise inevitable event, which would, in its turn,
have generated 
new karmic trouble. Thus he may neutralise forces coming out of the
past by 
sending against them forces equal and opposite, and may in this way
"burn up his 
karma by knowledge." In similar fashion he may bring to an end
karma generated 
in his present life that would normally work out in future lives. 
Again, he may be hampered by liabilities contracted to other souls
in the past, 
wrongs he has done to them, duties he owes them. By the use of his
knowledge he 
can find those souls, whether in this world or in either of the
other two, and 
seek opportunities of serving them. There may a soul incarnated
during his own 
life-period to whom he owes some karmic debt; he may seek out that
soul and pay 
his debt, thus setting himself free from a tie which, left to the
course of 
events, would have necessitated his own reincarnation, or would
have hampered 
him in a future life. Strange and puzzling lines of action adopted
by occultists 
have sometimes this explanation – the man of knowledge enters into
close 
relations with some person who is considered by the ignorant
bystanders and 
critics to be quite outside the companionships that are fitting for
him; but 
that occultist is quietly working out a karmic obligation which
would otherwise 
hamper and retard his progress. 
Those who do not possess knowledge enough to review their past
lives may yet 
exhaust many causes that they have set going in the present life;
they can 
carefully go over all that they can remember, and note where they
have wronged 
any or where any has wronged them, exhausting the first cases by
pouring out 
thoughts of love and service, and performing acts of service to the
injured 
person, where possible on the physical plane also; and in the
second cases 
sending forth thoughts of pardon and good will. Thus they diminish
their karmic 
liabilities and bring near the day of liberation. 
Unconsciously, pious people who obey the precept of all great
Teachers of 
religion to return good for evil are exhausting karma generated in
the present 
that would otherwise work out in the future. No one can weave with
them a bond 
of hatred if they refuse to contribute any stands of hatred to the
weaving, and 
persistently neutralise every force of hatred with one of love. Let
a soul 
radiate in every direction love and compassion, and thoughts of
hatred can find 
nothing to which they can attach themselves. 
"The Prince of this world cometh and hath nothing in me."
All great Teachers 
knew the law and based on it Their precepts, and those who through
reverence and 
devotion to Them obey Their directions profit under the law,
although they know 
nothing of the details of its working. An ignorant man who carries
out 
faithfully the instructions given him by a scientist can obtain
results by his 
working with the laws of Nature, despite his ignorance of them, and
the same 
principle holds good in worlds beyond the physical. Many who have
not time to 
study, and perforce accept on the authority of experts rules which
guide their 
daily conduct in life, may thus unconsciously be discharging their
karmic 
liabilities. 
In countries where reincarnation and karma are taken for granted by
every 
peasant and labourer, the belief spreads a certain quiet acceptance
of 
inevitable troubles that conduces much to the calm and contentment
of ordinary 
life. A man overwhelmed by misfortunes rails neither against God
nor against his 
neighbours, but regards his troubles as the results of his own past
mistakes and 
ill-doings. 
He accepts them resignedly and makes the best of them, and thus
escapes much of 
the worry and anxiety with which those who know not the law
aggravate troubles 
already sufficiently heavy. He realises that his future lives
depend on his own 
exertions, and that the law which brings him pain will bring him
just joy as 
inevitably if he sows the seed of good. Hence a certain patience
and a 
philosophic view of life, tending directly to social stability and
to general 
contentment. 
The poor and ignorant do not study profound and detailed
metaphysics, but they 
grasp thoroughly these simple principles – that every man is reborn
on earth 
time after time, and that each successive life is moulded by those
that precede 
it. To them rebirth is as sure and as inevitable as the rising and
setting of 
the sun; it is part of the course of nature, against which it is
idle to repine 
or to rebel. 
When Theosophy has restored these ancient truths to
their rightful place in 
western thought, they will gradually work their way among all
classes of society 
in Christendom, spreading understanding of the nature of life and
acceptance of 
the result of the past. Then too will vanish the restless
discontent which 
arises chiefly from the impatient and hopeless feeling that life is
unintelligible, unjust, and unmanageable, and it will be replaced
by the quiet 
strength and patience which come from an illumined intellect and a
knowledge of 
the law, and which characterise the reasoned and balanced activity
of those who 
feel that they are building for eternity. 
THE LAW OF SACRIFICE
The study of the Law of Sacrifice follows naturally on the study of
the Law of 
Karma, and the understanding of the former, it was once remarked by
a Master, is 
as necessary for the world as the understanding of the latter. By
an act of 
Self-sacrifice the LOGOS became manifest for the emanation of the
universe, by 
sacrifice the universe is maintained, and by sacrifice man reaches
perfection. 
(The Hindu will remember the opening words of the
Brihadaranyakopanishad, that 
the dawn is in sacrifice; the Zoroastrian will recall how Ahura Mazda
came forth 
from an act of sacrifice; the Christian will think of the Lamb –
the symbol of 
the LOGOS – slain from the foundation of the world.) Hence every
religion that 
springs from Ancient Wisdom has sacrifice as a central teaching,
and some of the 
profoundest truths of occultism are rooted in the law of sacrifice.
An attempt to grasp, however feebly, the nature of the sacrifice of
the LOGOS 
may prevent us from falling into the very general mistake that
sacrifice is an 
essentially painful thing; whereas the very essence of sacrifice is
a voluntary 
and glad pouring forth of life that others may share in it; and
pain only arises 
when there is discord in the nature of the sacrificer, between the
higher whose 
joy is in giving and the lower whose satisfaction lies in grasping
and 
holding.It is that discord alone that introduces the element of
pain, and in the 
supreme Perfection, in the LOGOS, no discord could arise; the One
is the perfect 
chord of Being, of infinite melodious concords, all tuned to a
single note, in 
which Life and Wisdom and Bliss are blended into one keynote of
Existence. 
The sacrifice of the LOGOS lay in His voluntarily circumscribing
His infinite 
life in order that He might manifest. Symbolically, in the infinite
ocean of 
light, with centre everywhere and with circumference nowhere, there
arises a 
full-orbed sphere of living light, a LOGOS, and the surface of that
sphere is 
His will to limit Himself that He may become manifest, His veil (
This is the 
Self-limiting power of the LOGOS, His Maya, the limiting principle
by which all 
forms are brought forth. His Life appears as "Spirit,"
His Maya as "Matter," and 
these are never disjoined during manifestation.)in which He
incloses Himself 
that within it a universe may take form. 
That for which the sacrifice is made is not yet in existence; its
future being 
lies in the "thought" of the LOGOS alone; to him it owes
its conception and will 
own its manifold life. Diversity could not arise in the
"partless Brahman" save 
for this voluntary sacrifice of Deity taking on Himself form in
order to emanate 
myriad forms, each dowered with a spark of His life and therefore
with the power 
evolving into His image. "The primal sacrifice that causes the
birth of beings 
is named action (karma)," it is said (Bhagavad Gîtâ, viii,3.),
and this coming 
forth into activity from the bliss of perfect repose of
self-existence has ever 
been recognised as the sacrifice of the LOGOS. 
That sacrifice continues throughout the term of the universe, for
the life of 
the LOGOS is the sole support of every separated " life "
and He limits His life 
in each of the myriad forms to which He gives birth, bearing all
the restraints 
and limitations implied in each form. From any one of these He
could burst forth 
at any moment, the infinite Lord, filling the universe with His
glory; but only 
by sublime patience and slow and gradual expansion can each form be
led upward 
until it becomes a self-dependent centre of boundless power like
Himself. 
Therefore does He cabin Himself in forms, and bear all imperfection
till 
perfection is attained, and His creature is like unto Himself and
one with Him, 
but with its own thread of memory. Thus this pouring out of His
life into forms 
is part of the original sacrifice, and has in it the bliss of the
eternal Father 
sending forth His offspring as separated lives, that each may
evolve an identity 
that shall never perish, and yield its own note blended with all
others to swell 
the eternal song of bliss, intelligence and life. 
This marks the essential nature of sacrifice. Whatever other
elements may become 
mixed with the central idea; it is the voluntary pouring out of
life that others 
may partake of it, to bring others into life and to sustain them in
it till they 
become self-dependent, and this is but one expression of divine
joy. There is 
always joy in the exercise of activity which is the expression of
the power of 
the actor; the bird takes joy in the outpouring of song, and
quivers with the 
mere rapture of singing; the painter rejoices in the creation of
his genius, in 
the putting into form of his idea; the essential activity of the
divine life 
must lie in giving, for there is nothing higher than itself from
which it can 
receive; if it is to be active at all – and manifested life is
active motion – 
it must pour itself out. 
Hence the sign of the spirit is giving, for spirit is the active
divine life in 
every form. 
But the essential activity of matter, on the other hand, lies in
receiving; by 
receiving life-impulses it is organised into forms; by receiving
them these are 
maintained; on their withdrawal they fall to pieces. All its
activity is of this 
nature of receiving, and only by receiving can it endure as a form.
Therefore it 
is always grasping, clinging, seeking to hold for its own; the
persistence of 
the form depends on its grasping and retentive power, and it will
therefore seek 
to draw into itself all it can, and will grudge every fraction with
which it 
parts. Its joy will be in seizing and holding; to it giving is like
courting 
death. 
It is very easy from this standpoint, to see how the notion arose
that sacrifice 
was suffering. While the divine life found its delight in
exercising its 
activity of giving, and even when embodied in form cared not if the
form 
perished by the giving, knowing it to be only its passing
expression and the 
means of its separated growth; the form which felt its life-forces
pouring away 
from it cried out in anguish, and sought to exercise its activity
in holding, 
thus resisting the outward flow. The sacrifice diminished the
life-energies the 
form claimed as its own; or even entirely drained them away,
leaving the form to 
perish. 
In the lower world of form this was the only aspect of sacrifice
cognisable, and 
the form found itself driven to slaughter, and cried out in fear
and agony. What 
wonder that men, blinded by form, identified sacrifice with the
agonising form 
instead of with the free life that gave itself, crying
gladly:"Lo! I come to do 
thy will, O God; I am content to do it." What wonder that men
– conscious of a 
higher and a lower nature, and oft identifying their
self-consciousness more 
with the lower than with the higher – felt the struggle of the
lower nature, the 
form, as their own struggles, and felt that they were accepting
suffering in 
resignation to a higher will, and regarded sacrifice as that devout
and resigned 
acceptance of pain. 
Not until man identifies himself with the life instead of with the
form can the 
element of pain in sacrifice be gotten rid of. In a perfectly
harmonised entity, 
pain cannot be, for the form is then the perfect vehicle of the
life, receiving 
or surrendering with ready accord. With the ceasing of struggle
comes the 
ceasing of pain. For suffering arises from jar, from friction, from
antagonistic 
movements, and where the whole nature works in perfect harmony the
conditions 
that give rise to suffering are not present. 
The law of sacrifice being thus the law of life - evolution in the
universe, we 
find every step in the ladder is accomplished by sacrifice – the
life pouring 
itself out to take birth in a higher form, while the form that
contained it 
perishes. Those who look only at the perishing forms see Nature as
a vast 
charnel house; while those who see the deathless soul escaping to
take new and 
higher form hear ever the joyous song of birth from the upward
springing life. 
The Monad in the mineral kingdom evolves by the breaking up of its
forms for the 
production and support of plants. Minerals are disintegrated that
plant-forms 
may be built out of their materials; the plant draws from the soil
its nutritive 
constituents, breaks them up, and incorporates them into its own
substance. The 
mineral forms perish that the plant forms may grow, and this law of
sacrifice 
stamped on the mineral kingdom is the law of evolution of life and
form. The 
life passes onward and the Monad evolves to produce the vegetable
kingdom, the 
perishing of the lower form being the condition for the appearing
and the 
support of the higher. 
The story is repeated in the vegetable kingdom, for its forms in
turn are 
sacrificed in order that animal forms may be produced and may grow;
on every 
side grasses, grains, trees perish for the sustenance of animal
bodies; their 
tissues are disintegrated that the materials comprising them may be
assimilated 
by the animal and build up its body. Again the law of sacrifice is
stamped on 
the world, this time on the vegetable kingdom; its life evolves
while its forms 
perish; the Monad evolves to produce the animal kingdom, and the
vegetable is 
offered up that the animal forms may be brought forth and
maintained. 
So far the idea of pain has scarcely connected itself with that of
sacrifice, 
for, as we have seen in the course of our studies, the astral
bodies of plants 
are not sufficiently organised to give rise to any acute sensations
either of 
pleasure or of pain. But as we consider the law of sacrifice in its
working in 
the animal kingdom, we cannot avoid the recognition of the pain
there involved 
in the breaking up of forms. It is true that the amount of pain
caused by the 
preying of one animal upon another in "the state of nature
" is comparatively 
trivial in each case, but still some pain occurs. 
It is also true that man, in the part he has played in helping to
evolve 
animals, has much aggravated the amount of pain, and has
strengthened instead of 
diminishing the predatory instincts of carnivorous animals; still,
he did not 
implant those instincts, though he took advantage of them for his
own purposes, 
and innumerable varieties of animals, with the evolution of which
man has had 
directly nothing to do, prey upon each other, the forms being
sacrificed to the 
support of other forms, as in the mineral and vegetable kingdoms. 
The struggle for existence went on long before man appeared on the
scene, and 
accelerated the evolution alike of life and of forms, while the
pains 
accompanying the destruction of forms began the long task of
impressing on the 
evolving Monad the transitory nature of all forms, and the
difference between 
the forms that perished and the life that persisted . 
The lower nature of man was evolved under the same law of sacrifice
as ruled in 
the lower kingdoms. But the outpouring of divine Life which gave
the human Monad 
came a change in the way in which the law of sacrifice worked as
the law of 
life. In man was to be developed the will, the self-moving,
self-initiated 
energy, and the compulsion which forced the lower kingdoms along
the path of 
evolution could not therefore be employed in his case, without
paralysing the 
growth of this new and essential power. 
No mineral, no plant, no animal was asked to accept the law of
sacrifice as a 
voluntarily chosen law of life. It was imposed upon them from
without, and it 
forced their growth by a necessity from which they could not
escape. Man was to 
have the freedom of choice necessary for the growth of a
discriminative and 
self-conscious intelligence, and the question arose: "How can
this creature be 
left free to choose, and yet learn to choose to follow the law of
sacrifice, 
while yet he is a sensitive organism, shrinking from pain, and pain
is 
inevitable in the breaking up of sentient forms?" 
Doubtless eons of experience, studied by a creature becoming ever
more 
intelligent, might have finally led man to discover that the law of
sacrifice is 
the fundamental law of life; but in this, as in so much else, he
was not left to 
his own unassisted efforts. Divine Teachers were there at the side
of man in his 
infancy, and they authoritatively proclaimed the law of sacrifice,
and 
incorporated it in a most elementary form in the religions by which
They trained 
the dawning intelligence of man. 
It would have been useless to have suddenly demanded from these
child-souls that 
they should surrender without return what seemed to them to be the
most 
desirable objects, the objects on the possession of which their
life in form 
depended. They must be led along a path which would lead gradually
to the 
heights of voluntary self-sacrifice. To this end they were first
taught that 
they were not isolated units, but were parts of a larger whole, and
that their 
lives were linked to other lives both above and below them. 
Their physical lives were supported by lower lives, by the earth;
by plants, 
they consumed these, and in thus doing they contracted a debt which
they were 
bound to pay, Living on the sacrificed lives of others, they must
sacrifice in 
turn something which should support other lives, they must nourish
even as they 
were nourished, taking the fruits produced by the activity of the
astral 
entities that guide physical Nature, they must recruit the expended
forces by 
suitable offerings. 
Hence have arisen all the sacrifices to these forces – as science
calls them – 
to these intelligences guiding physical order, as religions have
always taught. 
As fire quickly disintegrated the dense physical, it quickly
restored the 
etheric particles of the burnt offerings to the ethers; thus the
astral 
particles were easily set free to be assimilated by the astral
entities 
concerned with the fertility of the earth and the growth of plants.
Thus the 
wheel of production was kept turning, and man learned that he was
constantly 
incurring debts to Nature which he must as constantly discharge. 
Thus the sense of obligation was implanted and nurtured in his
mind, and the 
duty that he owed to the whole, to the nourishing mother Nature,
became 
impressed on his thought. It is true that this sense of obligation
was closely 
connected with the idea that its discharge was necessary for his
own welfare, 
and that the wish to continue to prosper moved him to the payment
of his debt. 
He was but a child-soul, learning his first lessons, and this
lesson of the 
interdependence of lives, of the life of each depending on the
sacrifice of 
others, was of vital importance to his growth. Not yet could he
feel the divine 
joy of giving; the reluctance of the form to surrender aught that
nourished it 
had first to be overcome, and sacrifice became identified with this
surrender of 
something valued, a surrender made from a sense of obligation and
the desire to 
continue prosperous. 
The next lesson removed the reward of sacrifice to a region beyond
the physical 
world. First, by a sacrifice of material goods, material welfare
was to be 
secured. Then the sacrifice of material goods was to bring
enjoyment in heaven, 
on the other side of death. The reward of the sacrificer was of a
higher kind, 
and he learned that the relatively permanent might be secured by
the sacrifice 
of the relatively transient – a lesson that was important as
leading to 
discriminative knowledge.The clinging of the form to physical
objects was 
exchanged for a clinging to heavenly joys. In all exoteric
religions we find 
this educative process resorted to by the Wise Ones – too wise to expect
child-souls the virtue of unrewarded heroism, and content, with a
sublime 
patience, to coax their wayward charges slowly along a pathway that
was a thorny 
and a stony one to the lower nature. 
Gradually men were induced to subjugate the body, to overcome its
sloth by the 
regular daily performance of religious rites, often burdensome in
their nature, 
and to regulate its activities by directing them into useful
channels; they were 
trained to conquer the form and to hold it in subjection to the
life, and to 
accustom the body to yield itself to works of goodness and charity
in obedience 
to the demands of the mind, even while that mind was chiefly
stimulated by a 
desire to enjoy reward in heaven. 
We can see among the Hindus, the Persians, the Chinese, how men
were taught to 
recognise their manifold obligations; to make the body yield
dutiful sacrifice 
of obedience and reverence to ancestors, to parents, to elders; to
bestow 
charity with courtesy; and to show kindness to all. Slowly men were
helped to 
evolve both heroism and self-sacrifice to a high degree, as witness
the martyrs 
who joyfully flung their bodies to torture and death rather than
deny their 
faith or be false to their creed. They looked indeed for a
"crown of glory" in 
heaven as a recompense for the sacrifice of the physical form, but
it was much 
to have overcome the clinging to the physical form, and to have
made the 
invisible world so real that it outweighed the visible. 
The next step was achieved when the sense of duty was definitely
established; 
when the sacrifice of the lower to the higher was seen to be
"right," apart from 
all question of a reward to be received in another world; when the
obligation 
owed by the part to the whole was recognised, and the yielding of
service by the 
form that existed by the service of others was felt to be justly
due without any 
claim to wages being established thereby. 
Then man began to perceive the law of sacrifice as the law of life,
and 
voluntarily to associate himself with it; and he began to learn to
disjoin 
himself in idea from the form he dwelt in and to identify himself
with the 
evolving life. This gradually led him to feel a certain
indifference to all the 
activities of form, save as they consisted in "duties that
ought to be done," 
and to regard all of them as mere channels for the life-activities
that were due 
to the world, and not as activities performed by him with any
desire for their 
results. Thus he reached the point already noted, when karma
attracting him to 
the three worlds ceased to be generated, and he turned the wheel of
existence 
because it ought to be turned, and not because its revolution
brought any 
desirable object to himself. 
The full recognition of the law of sacrifice, however, lifts man
beyond the 
mental plane – whereon duty is recognised as duty, as "what
ought to be done 
because it is owed" – to that higher plane of Buddhi where all
selves are felt 
as one, and where all activities are poured out for the use of all,
and not for 
the gain of a separated self. Only on that plane is the law of
sacrifice felt as 
a joyful privilege, instead of only recognised intellectually as
true and just. 
On the buddhic plane man clearly sees that life is one, that it
streams out 
perpetually as the free outpouring of the love of the LOGOS, that
life holding 
itself separate is a poor and a mean thing at best, and an
ungrateful one to 
boot. There the whole heart rushes upwards to the LOGOS in one
strong surge of 
love and worship, and gives itself in joyfullest self-surrender to
be a channel 
of His life and love to the world. To be a carrier of His light, a
messenger of 
His compassion, a worker in His realm – that appears as the only
life worth 
living; to hasten evolution, to serve the Good Law, to lift part of
the heavy 
burden of the world – that seems to be the very gladness of the
Lord Himself. 
From this plane only can a man act as one of the Saviours of the
world, because 
on it he is one with the selves of all. Identified with humanity
where it is 
one, his strength, his love, his life can flow downwards into any
or into every 
separated self. 
He has become a spiritual force, and the available spiritual energy
of the 
world-system is increased by pouring into it of his life. The
forces he used to 
expend on the physical , astral, and mental planes, seeking things
for his 
separated self, are now all gathered up in one act of sacrifice,
and, transmuted 
thereby into spiritual energy, they pour down upon the world as
spiritual life. 
This transmutation is wrought by the motive which determines the
plane on which 
the energy is set free. 
If a man’s motive be the gain of physical objects, the energy
liberated works 
only on the physical plane; if he desire astral objects, he
liberates energy on 
the astral plane; if he seek mental joys, his energy functions on
the mental 
plane; but if he sacrifice himself to be a channel of the LOGOS, he
liberates 
energy on the spiritual plane, and it works everywhere with the
potency and 
keenness of a spiritual force. For such a man, action and inaction
are the same; 
for he does everything while doing nothing, he does nothing while
doing 
everything. 
For him, high and low, great and small are the same; he fills any
place that 
needs filling, and the LOGOS is alike in every place and in every
action. He can 
flow into any form, he can work along any line, he knows not any
longer choice 
or difference; his life by sacrifice has been made one with the
life of the 
LOGOS – he sees God in everything and everything in God. How then
can place or 
form make to him any difference? He no longer identifies himself
with form, but 
is self-conscious Life. "Having nothing, he possesseth all
things " asking for 
nothing, everything flows into him. His life is bliss, for he is
one with his 
Lord, who is Beatitude; and, using form for service without
attachment to it, 
"he has put and end to pain." 
Those who grasp something of the wonderful possibilities which open
out before 
us as we voluntarily associate ourselves with the law of sacrifice
will wish to 
begin that voluntary association long ere they can rise to the
heights just 
dimly sketched. Like other deep spiritual truths, it is eminently
practical in 
its application to daily life, and none who feel its beauty need to
hesitate to 
begin to work with it. When a man resolves to begin the practice of
sacrifice, 
he will train himself to open every day with an act of sacrifice,
the offering 
of himself, ere the day’s work begins, to Him to whom he gives his
life; his 
first waking thought will be this dedication of all his power to
his Lord. 
Then each thought, each word, each action in daily life will be
done as a 
sacrifice – not for its fruit, not even as duty, but as the way in
which, at the 
moment, his Lord can be served. All that comes will be accepted as
the 
expression of His will; joys, troubles, anxieties, successes,
failures, all to 
him are welcome as marking out his path of service; he will take
each happily as 
it comes and offer it as a sacrifice; he will loose each happily as
it goes, 
since its going shows that his Lord has no longer need for it. 
Any powers he has he gladly uses for service; when they fail him,
he takes their 
failure with happy equanimity; since they are no longer available
he cannot give 
them. Even suffering that springs from past causes not yet
exhausted can be 
changed into a voluntary sacrifice by welcoming it; taking
possession of it by 
willing it, a man may offer it as a gift, changing it by this
motive into a 
spiritual force. Every human life offers countless opportunities
for this 
practice of the law of sacrifice, and every human life becomes a
power as these 
opportunities are seized and utilised. 
Without any expansion of his waking consciousness, a man may thus
become a 
worker on the spiritual planes, liberating energy there which pours
down into 
the lower worlds. His self-surrender here in the lower
consciousness, imprisoned 
as it is in the body, calls out responsive thrills of life from the
buddhic 
aspect of the Monad which is his true Self, and hastens the time
when that Monad 
shall become the spiritual Ego, self-moved and ruling all his
vehicles, using 
each of them at will as needed for the work that is to be done. 
In no way can progress be made so rapidly, and the manifestation of
all the 
powers latent in the Monad be brought about so quickly, as by the
understanding 
and the practice of the law of sacrifice. Therefore it was called
by a Master, 
"The Law of evolution for man." It has indeed profounder
and more mystic aspects 
than any touched on here, but these will unveil themselves without
words to the 
patient and loving heart whose life is all a sacrificial offering.
There are 
things that are heard only in the stillness; there are teachings
that can be 
uttered only by "The Voice of the Silence." Among these
are the deeper truths 
rooted in the law of sacrifice. 
MAN’S ASCENT
So stupendous is the ascent up which some men have climbed, and
some are 
climbing, that when we scan it by an effort of the imagination we
are apt to 
recoil, wearied in thought by the mere idea of that long journey.
From the 
embryonic soul of the lowest savage to the liberated and triumphant
perfected 
spiritual soul of the divine man – it seems scarcely credible that
the one can 
contain in it all that is expressed in the other, and that the
difference is but 
a difference in evolution, that one is only at the beginning and
the other at 
the end of man’s ascent. 
Below the one stretch the long ranks of the sub-human – the
animals, vegetables, 
minerals, elemental essences; above the other stretch the infinite
gradations of 
the superhuman – the Chohans, Manus, Buddhas, Builders, Lipikas;
who may name or 
number the hosts of the mighty Ones? Looked at thus, as a stage in
a yet vaster 
life, the many steps within the human kingdom shrink into a
narrower compass, 
and man’s ascent is seen as comprising but one grade in evolution
in the linked 
lives that stretch from the elemental essence onwards to the
manifested God. 
We have traced man’s ascent from the appearance of the embryonic
soul to the 
state of the spiritually advanced, through the stages of evolving consciousness
from the life of sensation to the life of thought. We have seen him
retread the 
cycle of birth and death in the three worlds, each world yielding
him its 
harvest and offering him opportunities for progress. We are now in
a position to 
follow him into the final stages of his human evolution, stages
that lie in the 
future for the vast bulk of our humanity, but that have already
been trodden by 
its eldest children, and that re being trodden by a slender number
of men and 
women in our own day. 
These stages have been classified under two headings – the first
are spoken of 
as constituting "the probationary Path," while the later
ones are included in 
"the Path proper" or " the Path of
discipleship." We will take them in their 
natural order. 
As a man’s intellectual, moral, and spiritual nature develops, he
becomes more 
and more conscious of the purpose of human life, and more and more
eager to 
accomplish that purpose in his own person. Repeated longings for
earthly joys, 
followed by full possession and by subsequent weariness, have
gradually taught 
him the transient and unsatisfactory nature of earth’s best gifts;
so often has 
he striven for, gained, employed, been satiated, and finally
nauseated, that he 
turns away discontented from all that earth can offer. "What
doth it profit?" 
sighs the wearied soul: "All is vanity and vexation. Hundreds,
yea, thousands of 
times have I possessed, and finally have found disappointment even
in 
possession." 
"These joys are illusions, as bubbles on a stream,
fairy-coloured, rainbow-hued, 
but bursting at a touch. I am athirst for realities; I have had
enough of 
shadows; I pant for the eternal and the true, for freedom from the
limitations 
that hem me in, that keep me prisoner amid these changing shows."
This first cry of the soul for liberation is the result of the
realisation that, 
were this earth all that poets have dreamed it, were every evil
swept away, 
every sorrow put an end to , every joy intensified, every beauty
enhanced, were 
everything raised to its point of perfection, he would still be
aweary of it, 
would turn from it void of desire. It has become to him a prison,
and, let it be 
decorated as it may, he pants for the free and limitless air beyond
its 
inclosing walls. 
Nor is heaven more attractive to him than earth; of that too he is
aweary; its 
joys have lost their attractiveness, even its intellectual and
emotional 
delights no longer satisfy. They also "come and go,
impermanent" like the 
contacts of the senses; they are limited, transient, unsatisfying.
He is tired 
of the changing; from very weariness he cries out for liberty. 
Sometimes this realisation of the worthlessness of earth and heaven
is at first 
but a flash in consciousness, and the external worlds reassert
their empire and 
the glamour of their illusive joys again laps the soul into
content. Some lives 
even may pass, full of noble work and unselfish achievement, of
pure thoughts 
and lofty deeds, ere this realisation of the emptiness of all that
is phenomenal 
becomes the permanent attitude of the soul. 
But sooner or later the soul once and for ever breaks with earth
and heaven as 
incompetent to satisfy his needs, and this definite turning away
from the 
transitory, this definite will to reach the eternal, is the gateway
to the 
probationary Path. The soul steps off the highway of evolution to
breast the 
steeper climb up the mountain side, resolute to escape from the
bondage of 
earthly and heavenly lives, and to reach the freedom of the upper
air. 
The work which has to be accomplished by the man who enters on the
probationary 
Path is entirely mental and moral; he has to bring himself up to
the point at 
which he will fit to "meet his Master face to face": but
he very words "his 
Master" need explanation. There are certain great Beings
belonging to our race 
who have completed Their human evolution, and to whom allusion has
already been 
made as constituting a Brotherhood, and as guiding and forwarding
the 
development of the race. 
These Great Ones, the Masters, voluntarily incarnate in human
bodies on order to 
form the connecting link between human and superhuman beings, and
They permit 
those who fulfil certain conditions to become Their disciples, with
the object 
of hastening their evolution and thus qualifying themselves to
enter the great 
Brotherhood, and to assist in its glorious and beneficent work for
man. 
The Masters ever watch the race, and mark any who by the practice
of virtue, by 
unselfish labour for human good, by intellectual effort turned to
the service of 
man, by sincere devotion, piety, and purity, draw ahead of the mass
of their 
fellows, and render themselves capable of receiving spiritual
assistance beyond 
that shed down on mankind as a whole. If an individual is to
receive special 
help he must show special receptivity. 
For the Masters are the distributors of the spiritual energies that
help on 
human evolution, and the use of these for the swifter growth of a
single soul is 
only permitted when that soul shows a capacity for rapid progress
and can thus 
be quickly fitted to become a helper of the race, returning to it
the aid that 
had been afforded to himself. When a man, by his own efforts,
utilising to the 
full all the general help coming to him through religion and
philosophy, has 
struggled onwards to the front of the advancing human wave and when
he shows a 
loving, selfless, helpful nature, then he becomes a special object
of attention 
to the watchful Guardians of the race, and opportunities are put in
his way to 
test his strength and call forth his intuition.In proportion as he
successfully 
uses these, he is yet further helped, and glimpses are afforded to
him of the 
true life, until the unsatisfactory and unreal nature of mundane
existence 
presses more and more on the soul, with the result already
mentioned – the 
weariness which makes him long for freedom and brings him to the
gateway of the 
probationary Path. 
His entrance on his Path places him in the position of a disciple
or chelâ, on 
probation, and some one Master takes him under His care,
recognising him as a 
man who has stepped out of the highway of evolution, and seeks the
Teacher who 
shall guide his steps along the steep and narrow path which leads
to liberation. 
That Teacher is awaiting him at the very entrance of the Path, and
even though 
the neophyte knows not his Teacher, his Teacher knows him, sees his
efforts, 
directs his steps, leads him into the conditions that best subserve
his 
progress, watching over him with the tender solicitude of a mother,
and with the 
wisdom born of perfect insight. The road may seem lonely and dark,
and the young 
disciple may fancy himself deserted, but a "friend who
sticketh closer than a 
brother" is ever at hand, and the help withheld from the
senses is given to the 
soul. 
There are four definite "qualifications" that the
probationary chelâa must set 
himself to acquire, that are by the wisdom of the great Brotherhood
laid down as 
the conditions of full discipleship. They are not asked for in
perfection, but 
they must be striven for and partially possessed ere Initiation is
permitted.The 
first of these is the discrimination between the real and the
unreal which has 
been already dawning on the mind of the pupil, and which drew him
to the Path on 
which he is now entered; the distinctions grows clear and sharply
defined in his 
mind, and gradually frees him to a great extent from the fetters
which bind him, 
for the second qualification, indifference to external things,
comes naturally 
in the wake of discrimination, from the clear perception of their
worthlessness. 
He learns that the weariness which took all the savour out of life
was due to 
the disappointments constantly arising from his search for
satisfaction in the 
unreal, when only the real can content the soul; that all forms are
unreal and 
without stability, changing ever under the impulses of life, and
that nothing is 
real but the one Life that we seek for and love unconsciously under
its many 
veils. This discrimination is much stimulated by the rapidly
changing 
circumstances into which a disciple is generally thrown, with the
view of 
pressing on him strongly the instability of all external things. 
The lives of a disciple are generally lives of storm and stress, in
order that 
the qualities which are normally evolved in a long succession of
lives in the 
three worlds may in him be forced into swift growth and quickly
brought to 
perfection. As he alternates rapidly from joy to sorrow, from peace
to storm, 
from rest to toil, he learns to see in the changes the unreal
forms, and to feel 
through all a steady unchanging life. He grows indifferent to the
presence or 
the absence or the absence of things that thus come and go, and
more and more he 
fixes his gaze on the changeless reality that is ever present. 
While he is thus gaining in insight and stability he works also at
the 
development of the third qualification – the six mental attributes
that are 
demanded from him ere he may enter on the Path itself. He need not
possess them 
all perfectly, but he must have them all partially present at least
ere he will 
be permitted to pass onward. 
First he must gain control over his thoughts, the progeny of the
restless, 
unruly mind, hard to curb as the wind. (Bhagavad Gitâ, vi. 34).
Steady, daily 
practice in meditation, in concentration, had begun to reduce this
mental rebel 
to order ere he entered on the probationary Path, and the disciple
now works 
with concentrated energy to complete the task, knowing that the
great increase 
in thought power that will accompany his rapid growth will prove a
danger both 
to others and to himself unless the developing force be thoroughly
under his 
control. 
Better give a child dynamite as a plaything, than place the
creative powers of 
thought in the hands of the selfish and ambitious. Secondly, the
young chela 
must add outward self-control to inner, and must rule his speech
and his actions 
as rigidly as he rules his thoughts. As the mind obeys the soul, so
must the 
lower nature obey the mind. The usefulness of the disciple in the
outer world 
depends as much on the pure and noble example set by his visible
life, as his 
usefulness in the inner world depends on the steadiness and
strength of his 
thoughts. Often is a good work marred by carelessness in this lower
part of 
human activity, and the aspirant is bidden strive towards an ideal
perfect in 
every part, in order that he may not later, when treading the Path,
stumble in 
his own walk and cause the enemy to blaspheme. 
As already said, perfection in anything is not demanded at this
stage, but the 
wise pupil strives towards perfection, knowing that at his best he
is still far 
away from his ideal. 
Thirdly, the candidate for full discipleship seeks to build into
himself the 
sublime and far-reaching virtue of tolerance – the quiet acceptance
of each man, 
each form of existence, as it is, without demand that it should be
something 
other shaped more to his own liking. Beginning to realise that the
one Life 
takes on countless limitations, each right in its own place and
times, he 
accepts each limited expression of that Life without wishing to
transform it 
into something else; he learns to revere the wisdom which planned
this world and 
which guides it, and to view with wide-eyed serenity the imperfect
parts as they 
slowly work out their partial lives. 
The drunkard, learning his alphabet of the suffering caused by the
dominance of 
the lower nature, is doing as usefully in his own stage as is the
saint in his, 
completing his last lesson in earth’s school, and no more can
justly be demanded 
from either than he is able to perform. One is in the kindergarten
stage, 
learning by object-lessons, while the other is graduating, ready to
leave his 
university; both are right for their age and their place, and
should be helped 
and sympathised with in their place. 
This is one of the lessons of what is known in occultism as
"tolerance." 
Fourthly must be developed endurance, the endurance that cheerfully
bears all 
and resents nothing, going straight onwards unswervingly to the
goal. Nothing 
can come to him but by the Law, and he knows the Law is good. He
understands 
that the rocky pathway that leads up the mountain-side straight to
the summit 
cannot be as easy to his feet as the well-beaten winding highway. 
He realises that he is paying in a few short lives all the karmic
obligations 
accumulated during his past, and that the payments must be
correspondingly 
heavy. The very struggle into which he is plunged develop in him
the fifth 
attribute, faith – faith in his Master and in himself, a serene
strong 
confidence that is unshakeable. He learns to trust in the wisdom,
the love, the 
power of his Master, and he is beginning to realise – not only to
say he 
believes in – the Divinity within his own heart, able to subdue all
things to 
Himself. The last mental requisite, balance, equilibrium, grows up
to some 
extent without conscious effort during the striving after the
preceding five. 
The very setting of the will to tread the Path is a sign that the
higher nature 
is opening out, and that the external world is definitely relegated
to a lower 
place. The continuous efforts to lead the life of discipleship
disentangle the 
soul from any remaining ties that may knit it to the world of
sense, for the 
withdrawal of the soul’s attention from lower objects gradually
exhausts the 
attractive power of those objects. They "turn away from an
abstemious dweller in 
the body," ( Bhagavad Gitâ, ii, 59.) and soon lose all power
to disturb this 
balance. Thus he learns to move amid them undisturbed, neither
seeking nor 
rejecting any. He also learns to balance amid mental troubles of
every kind, 
amid alternations of mental joy and mental pain, this balance being
further 
taught by the swift changes already spoken of through which his
life is guided 
by the ever-watchful care of his Master. 
These six mental attributes being in some measure attained, the
probationary 
chelâa needs further but the fourth qualification, the deep intense
longing for 
liberation, that yearning of the soul towards union with deity that
is the 
promise of its own fulfillment. This adds the last touch to his
readiness to 
enter into full discipleship, for, once that longing has definitely
asserted 
itself, it can never again be eradicated, and the soul that has
felt it can 
never again quench his thirst at earthly fountains; their waters
will ever taste 
flat and vapid when he sips them, so that he will turn away with
ever-deepening 
longing for the true water of life. 
At this stage he is "the man ready for Initiation," ready
to definitely "enter 
the stream" that cuts him off forever from the interests of earthly
life save as 
he can serve his Master in them and help forward the evolution of
the race. 
Henceforth his life is not to be the life of separateness; it is to
be offered 
up on the altar of humanity, a glad sacrifice of all he is, to be
used for the 
common good. 
The student will be glad to have the technical names of these
stages in Sanskrit 
and Pâli, so that he may be able to follow them out in more
advanced books: 
SANSKRIT (used by Hindus) PALI (used by Buddhists) 
1 VIVEKA discrimination between the real and the unreal 1
MANODVÂRAVAJJANA the 
opening of the doors of the mind; a conviction of the impermanence
of the 
earthly 
2 VAIRÂGYA indifference to the unreal, the transitory 2 PARIKAMMA
preparation 
for action; indifference to the fruits of action 
3 SHATSAMPATTI SHAMA control of thought 3 UPACHÂRO attention or
conduct; divided 
under the same headings as in the Hindu 
DAMA control of conduct 
UPARATI tolerance 
TITIKSHA endurance 
SHRADDHA faith 
SANADDGBA balance 
4 MUMUKSHA desire for liberation 4 ANULOMA direct order or
succession, its 
attainment following on the other three. 
The man is then the ADHIKARI The man is then the GATRABHU 
During the years spent in evolving the four qualifications, the probationary
chelâa will have been advancing in many other respects. He will
have been 
receiving from his Master much teaching, teaching usually imparted
during the 
deep sleep of the body; the soul, clad in the well-organised astral
body, will 
have become used to it as a vehicle of consciousness, and will have
been drawn 
to his Master – to receive instruction and spiritual illumination. 
He will further have been trained in meditation, and this effective
practice 
outside the physical body will have quickened and brought into
active exercise 
many of the higher powers; during such meditation he will have
reached higher 
regions of being, learning more of the life of the mental plane. He
will have 
been taught to use his increasing powers in human service, and
during many of 
the hours of sleep for the body he will have been working
diligently on the 
astral plane, aiding the souls that have passed on to it by death,
comforting 
the victims of accidents, teaching any less instructed than
himself, and in 
countless ways helping those who needed it, thus in humble fashion
aiding the 
beneficent work of the Masters, and being associated with Their
sublime 
Brotherhood as a co-labourer in a however modest and lowly degree. 
Either on the probationary Path or later, the chelâa is offered the
privilege of 
performing one of those acts of renunciation which mark the swifter
ascent of 
man. He is allowed "to renounce Devachan," that is, to
resign the glorious life 
in the heavenly places that awaits him on his liberation from the
physical 
world, the life which in his case would mostly be spent in the
middle arupa 
world in the company of the Masters, and in all the sublime joys of
the purest 
wisdom and love. If he renounce this fruit of his noble and devoted
life, the 
spiritual forces that would have been expended in his Devachan are
set free for 
the general service of the world, and he himself remains in the
astral region to 
await a speedy rebirth upon earth. 
His Master in this case selects and presides over his
reincarnation, guiding him 
to take birth amid conditions conducive to his usefulness in the
world, suitable 
for his further progress and for the work required at his hands. He
has reached 
the stage at which every individual interest is subordinated to the
divine work, 
and in which his will is fixed to serve in whatever way may be
required of him. 
He therefore, gladly surrenders himself into the hands he trusts,
accepting 
willingly and joyfully the place in the world in which he can best
render 
service, and perform his share of the glorious work of aiding the
evolution of 
humanity. 
Blessed is the family into which a child is born tenanted by such a
soul, a soul 
that brings with him the benediction of the Master and is ever
watched and 
guided, every possible assistance being given him to bring his
lower vehicles 
quickly under control. Occasionally, but rarely a chelâ may
reincarnate in a 
body that has passed through infancy and extreme youth as the
tabernacle of a 
less progressed Ego; when an Ego comes to the earth for a very
brief 
life-period, say for some fifteen or twenty years, he will be
leaving his body 
at the time of dawning manhood, when it has passed through the time
of early 
training and is rapidly becoming an effective vehicle for the soul.
If such a body be a very good one, and some chelâ be awaiting a
suitable 
reincarnation, it will often be watched during its tenancy by the
Ego for whom 
it was originally built, with the view of utilising it when he has
done with it; 
when the life-period of that Ego is completed, and he passes out of
the body 
into Kamaloka on his way to Devachan, his cast-off body will be
taken possession 
of by the waiting chelâ, a new tenant will enter the deserted
house, and the 
apparently dead body will revive. Such cases are unusual, but are
not unknown to 
occultists, and some references to them may be found in occult
books. 
Whether the incarnation be normal or abnormal, the progress of the
soul, of the 
chelâ himself, continues, and the period already spoken of is
reached when he 
is "ready for Initiation"; through that gateway of
Initiation he enters, as a 
definitely accepted chelâ, on the Path. This Path consists of four
distinct 
stages, and the entrance into each is guarded by an Initiation.
Each Initiation 
is accompanied by an expansion of consciousness which gives what is
called "the 
key to knowledge" belonging to the stage to which it admits,
and this key of 
knowledge is also a key of power, for truly is knowledge power in
all the realms 
of Nature. 
When the chelâ has entered the Path he becomes what has been called
"the 
houseless man," (The Hindus call this stage that of
Parivrajaka, the wanderer; 
the Buddhist calls it that of Srotapatti, he who has reached the
stream. The 
chelâ is thus designated after his first Initiation and before his
second.) for 
he longer looks on earth s this home – he has no abiding-place
here, to him all 
places are welcome wherein he can serve his Master. 
While he is on this stage of the Path there are three hindrances to
progress, 
technically called "fetters," which he has to get rid of,
and now – as he is 
rapidly to perfect himself – it is demanded from him that he shall
entirely 
eradicate faults of character, and perform completely the tasks
belonging to his 
condition. The three fetters that he must loose from his limbs ere
he can pass 
the second Initiation are: the illusion of the personal self,
doubt, and 
superstition. The personal self must be felt in consciousness as an
illusion, 
and must lose forever its power to impose itself on the soul as a
reality. 
He must feel himself one with all, all must live and breathe in him
and he in 
all. Doubt must be destroyed, but by knowledge, not by crushing
out; he must 
know reincarnation and karma and the existence of the Masters as
facts; not 
accepting them as intellectually necessary, but knowing them as
facts in Nature 
that he has himself verified, so that no doubt on these heads can
ever again 
rise in his mind. 
Superstition is escaped as the man rises into a knowledge of
realities, and of 
the proper place of rites and ceremonies in the company of Nature;
he learns to 
use every means and to be bound by none. When the chelâ has cast
off these 
fetters – sometimes the task occupies several lives, sometimes it
is achieved in 
part of a single life – he finds the second Initiation open to him,
with its new 
"key of knowledge" and its widened horizon. The chelâ now
sees before him a 
swiftly shortening span of compulsory life on earth, for when he
has reached 
this stage he must pass through his third and fourth Initiations in
his present 
life or in the next. (The chelâ on the second stage of the path is
for the Hindu 
the Kutichaka, the man who builds a hut; he has reached a place of
peace. For 
the Buddhist he is the Sakridagamin, the man who receives birth but
once more.) 
In this stage he has to bring into full working order the inner
faculties, those 
belonging to the subtle bodies, for he needs them for his service
in the higher 
realms of being. If he has developed them previously, this stage
may be a very 
brief one, but he may pass through the gateway of death once more
ere he is 
ready to receive his third Initiation, to become "the
Swan," the individual who 
soars into the empyrean, that wondrous Bird of Life whereof so many
legends are 
related. ( The Hindu calls him the Paramahamsa, beyond the " I
"; the Buddhist 
names him the Arhat, the worthy.) 
On this third stage of the Path the chelâ casts off the fourth and
fifth 
fetters, those of desire and aversion; he sees the One self in all,
and the 
outer veil can no longer blind him, whether it be fair or foul. He
looks on all 
with an equal eye; that fair bud of tolerance that he cherished on
the 
probationary Path now flowers out into an all-embracing love that
wraps 
everything within its tender embrace. He is "the friend of
every creature," the 
"lover of all that lives" in a world where all things
live. 
As a living embodiment of divine love, he passes swiftly onwards to
the fourth 
Initiation, that admits him to the last stage of the Path, where he
is "beyond 
the Individual," the worthy , the venerable. ( The Hamsa, he
who realises "I am 
THAT," in the Hindu terms; the Anagamin, the man who receives
birth no more, in 
the Buddhist.)Here he remains at his will, casting off the last
fine fetters 
that still bind him with threads however fragile, and keep him back
from 
liberation. He throws off all clinging to life in form, and then
all longing for 
formless life; these are the chains and he must be chainless; he
may move 
through the three worlds, but not a shred of theirs must have power
to hold him; 
the splendours of the "formless world" must charm him no
more than the concrete 
glories of the worlds of form. 
Then – mightiest of all achievements – he casts off the last fetter
of 
separateness, the "I "ever making faculty –(Ahamkara,
generally given as Mana, 
pride, since pride is the subtlest manifestation on the
"I" as distinct from 
others.) – which realises itself as apart from others, for he
dwells on the 
plane of unity in his waking consciousness, on the buddhic plane
where the Self 
of all is known and realised as one. This faculty was born with the
soul, is the 
essence of individuality, and it persists till all that is valuable
in it is 
worked into the Monad, and it can be dropped on the threshold of
liberation, 
leaving its priceless result to the Monad, that sense of individual
identity 
which is so pure and fine that it does not mar the consciousness of
oneness. 
Easily then drops away anything that could respond to ruffling
contacts, and the 
chelâ stands robed in that glorious vesture of unchanging peace
that naught can 
mar. And the casting away of that same "I-making" faculty
has cleared away from 
the spiritual vision the last clouds that could dim its piercing
insight, and in 
the realisation of unity, ignorance – (Avidya, the first illusion
and the last, 
that which makes the separated worlds – the first of the Nidanas –
and that 
which drops off when liberation is attained.) – the limitation that
gives birth 
to all separateness – falls away, and the man is perfect, is free. 
Then has come the ending of the Path, and the ending of the Path is
the 
threshold to Nirvana. Into that marvellous state of consciousness
the chelâ has 
been wont to pass out of the body while he has been traversing the
final stage 
of the Path; now, when he crosses the threshold, the nirvanic
consciousness 
becomes his normal consciousness, for Nirvana is the home of the
liberated Self. 
(The Jivanmukta, the liberated life, of the Hindu; the Asekha, he
who has no 
more to learn, of the Buddhist.) He has completed man’s ascent, he
touches the 
limit of humanity; above him there stretch hosts of mighty Beings,
but they are 
superhuman; the crucifixion in flesh is over, the hour of
liberation has struck, 
and the triumphant "It is finished!" rings from the
conqueror’s lips. See! – he 
has crossed the threshold, he has vanished into the light nirvanic,
another son 
of earth has conquered death. 
What mysteries are veiled by that light supernal we know not; dimly
we feel that 
the Supreme Self is found, that lover and Beloved are one. The long
search is 
over, the thirst of the heart is quenched forever, he has entered
into the joy 
of his Lord. 
But has earth lost her child, is humanity bereft of her triumphant
son? Nay! He 
has come forth from the bosom of the light, and He standeth again
on the 
threshold of Nirvana, Himself seeming the very embodiment of that
light, 
glorious beyond all telling, a manifested Son of God. But now His
face is turned 
to earth, His eyes beam with divinest compassion on the wandering
sons of men, 
His brethren after the flesh; He cannot leave them comfortless,
scattered as 
sheep without a shepherd. Clothed in the majesty of a mighty
renunciation, 
glorious with the strength of perfect wisdom and "power of an
endless life," He 
returns to earth to bless and guide humanity, Master of Wisdom,
kingly Teacher, 
divine Man. 
Returning thus to earth, the Master devotes Himself to the service
of humanity 
with mightier forces at His command than He wielded while He trod
the Path of 
discipleship; He has dedicated Himself to the helping of man, and
He bends all 
the sublime powers that He holds to the quickening of the evolution
of the 
world. He pays to those who are approaching the Path the debt He
contracted in 
the days of His own chelaship, guiding, helping, teaching them as
He was guided, 
helped, and taught before. 
Such are the stages of man’s ascent, from the lowest savagery to
the divine 
manhood. To such goal is humanity climbing, to such glory shall the
race attain. 
BUILDING A COSMOS
It is not possible, at our present stage of evolution, to do more
than roughly 
indicate a few points in the vast outline of the kosmic scheme in
which our 
globe plays a part. By " a kosmos " is here meant a
system which seems, from out 
standpoint, to be complete in itself, arising from a single LOGOS,
and sustained 
by His Life. Such a system is our solar system, and the physical
sun may be 
considered to be the lowest manifestation of the LOGOS when acting
as the centre 
of His kosmos; every form is indeed one of His concrete
manifestations, but the 
sun is His lowest manifestation as the life-giving, invigorating,
all-pervading, 
all controlling, regulative, coordinating, central power. 
Says an occult commentary: 
"Surya (the sun), in its visible reflection, exhibits the
first or lowest state 
of the seventh, the highest state of the Universal PRESENCE, the
pure of the 
pure, the first manifested Breath of the ever unmanifested SAT
(Be-ness). All 
the central physical or objective Suns are in their substance the
lowest state 
of the first Principle of the BREATH, (Secret Doctrine; I, 330,
Adyar Ed.), 
are in short, the lowest state of the "Physical Body" of
the LOGOS." 
All physical forces and energies are but transmutations of the life
poured forth 
by the sun, the Lord and Giver of life to his system. Hence in many
ancient 
religions the sun stood as the symbol of the Supreme God – the
symbol, in truth, 
the least liable to misconstruction by the ignorant. Mr. Sinnett
well says: 
"The solar system is indeed an area of Nature including more
than any but the 
very highest beings whom our humanity is capable of developing are
in position 
to investigate. Theoretically we may feel sure – as we look up into
the heavens 
at night – that the whole solar system itself is but a drop in the
ocean of the 
kosmos, but that drop is in its turn an ocean from the point of
view of the 
consciousness of such half-developed beings within it as ourselves,
and we can 
only hope at present to acquire vague and shadowy conceptions of
its origin and 
constitution. Shadowy, however, though these may be, they enable us
to assign 
the subordinate planetary series, in which our own evolution is
carried on, to 
its proper place in the system of which it is a part, or at all
events to get a 
broad idea of the relative magnitude of the whole system, of our
planetary 
chain, of the world in which we are at present functioning, and of
the 
respective periods of evolution in which as human beings we are
interested. " 
For in truth we cannot grasp our own position intellectually
without some idea – 
however vague it may be – of our relation to the whole; and while
some student 
are content to work within their own sphere of duty and to leave
the wider 
reaches of life until they are called to function in them, others
feel the need 
of a far-reaching scheme in which they have their place, and take
an 
intellectual delight in soaring upwards to obtain a bird’s-eye view
of the whole 
field of evolution. This need has been recognised and met by the
spiritual 
Guardians of humanity in the magnificent delineation of the kosmos
from the 
standpoint of the occultist traced by their pupil and messenger,
H.P.Blavatsky, 
in The Secret Doctrine, a work that will become ever more and more
enlightening 
as students of the Ancient Wisdom themselves explore and master the
lower levels 
of our evolving world. 
The appearance of the LOGOS, we are told, is the herald of the
birth-hour of our 
kosmos. 
"When He is manifest, all is manifested after Him; by His
manifestation this All 
becomes manifest." (Mundakopanishad, II, ii, 10). 
With Himself He brings the fruits of a past kosmos – the mighty
spiritual 
Intelligences who are to be His co-workers and agents in the
universe now to be 
built. Highest of these are "the Seven," often Themselves
spoken of as Logoi, 
since each in His place is the centre of a distinct department in
the kosmos, as 
the LOGOS is the centre of the whole. The commentary before quoted
says: 
The seven Beings in the Sun are the Seven Holy Ones, Self-born from
the inherent 
power in the matrix of Mother-substance …The energy from which they
sprang into 
conscious existence in every Sun is what some people call Vishnu,
which is the 
Breath of the Absoluteness. We call it the one manifested Life –
itself a 
reflection of the Absolute. (Secret Doctrine, I , 331, Adyar ed.) 
This "one manifested Life" is the LOGOS, the manifested
God. From this primary 
division our kosmos takes its sevenfold character, and all
subsequent divisions 
in their descending order reproduce this seven-keyed scale. Under
each of the 
seven secondary Logoi come the descending hierarchies of
Intelligences that form 
the governing body of His kingdom . 
Among These we hear of the Lipika, who are the Recorders of the
karma of that 
kingdom and of all entities therein; of the Maharajas or Devarajas,
who 
superintend the working out of karmic law; and of the vast hosts of
the 
Builders, who shape and fashion all forms after the Ideas that
dwell in the 
treasure-house of the LOGOS, in the Universal Mind, and that pass
from Him to 
the Seven, each of whom plans out His own realm under that supreme
direction and 
all-inspiring life, giving to it, at the same time, His own individual
colouring. H. P. Blavatsky calls these Seven Realms that make up
the solar 
systems the seven Laya centres; she says: 
The seven Laya centres are the seven Zero points, using the term
Zero in the 
same sense that chemists do, to indicate a point at which, in
Esotericism, the 
scale of reckoning of differentiation begins. From the Centres –
beyond which 
Esoteric philosophy allows us to perceive the dim metaphysical
outlines of the 
"Seven Sons" of Life and Light, the seven Logoi of the
Hermetic and all other 
philosophies – begins the differentiation of the elements which
enter into the 
constitution of our Solar System.(Secret Doctrine, I , 195, Adyar
Ed.) 
This realm is a planetary evolution of a stupendous character, the
field in 
which are lived out the stages of life of which a physical planet,
such as 
Venus, is but a transcient embodiment. We may speak of the Evolver
and Ruler of 
this realm as a planetary Logos, so as to avoid confusion. He draws
from the 
matter of the solar system, outpoured from the central LOGOS
Himself, the crude 
materials He requires, and elaborates them by His own
life-energies, each 
planetary Logos thus specialising the matter of His realm from a
common stock. 
(See in chapter I, on "The Physical Plane" the statement
on the evolution of 
matter.) 
The atomic state in each of the seven planes of His kingdom being
identical with 
the matter of a sub-plane of the whole solar system, continuity is
thus 
established throughout the whole. As H. P. Blavatsky remarks, atoms
change 
"their combining equivalents on every planet," the atoms
themselves being 
identical, but their combinations differing. She goes on: - 
"Not alone the elements of our planet, but even those of all
its sisters in the 
solar system, differ as widely from each other in their
combinations, as from 
the cosmic elements beyond our solar limits…Each atom has seven
planes of being, 
or existence, we are taught. (Secret Doctrine, Volume1, pages 166
and174, of the 
1893 edition or Volume 1, 199, , of the Adyar edition.) 
The sub-planes, as we have been calling them, of each great plane.
On the three 
lower planes of His evolving realm the planetary Logos establishes
seven globes 
or worlds, which for convenience’ sake, following the received
nomenclature, we 
will call globes A,B,C,D,E,F,G. 
These are the Seven small wheels revolving, one giving birth to the
other spoken 
of in Stanza vi, of the Book of Dzyan: He builds them in the
likeness of the 
older wheels, placing them on the imperishable centres. (Secret
Doctrine, Volume 
1, , of the 1893 edition or Volume 1, , of the Adyar edition.) 
Imperishable, since each wheel not only gives birth to its
successor, but is 
also itself reincarnated at the same centre, as we shall see. 
These globes may be figured as disposed in three pairs on the arc
of an ellipse, 
with the middle globe at the mid-most and lowest point; for the
most part globes 
A and G – the first and seventh – are on the Arupa levels of the mental
plane; 
globes B and F – the second and sixth – are on the rûpa levels;
globes C and E – 
the third and fifth – are on the astral plane; globe D – the fourth
– is on the 
physical plane. These globes are spoken of by H. P. Blavatsky as
"graduated on 
the four lower planes of the world of formation,"( Secret
Doctrine, Volume 1, , 
of the1893 edition or Volume 1, , of the Adyar edition- the note is
important, 
that the archetypal world is not the world as it existed in the
mind of the 
planetary Logos, but the first model which was made.) i.e., the
physical and 
astral planes, and the two subdivisions of the mental (rûpa and
arûpa). They may 
be figured: - as 
This is the typical arrangement, but it is modified at certain
stages of 
evolution. These seven globes form a planetary ring or chain, and –
if for a 
moment we regard the planetary chain as a whole, as, so to say, an
entity, a 
planetary life or individual – that chain passes through the seven
globes as a 
whole form its planetary body, and this planetary body
disintegrates and is 
reformed seven times during the planetary life. The planetary chain
has seven 
incarnations, and the results obtained in one are handed on to the
next. 
Every such chain of worlds is the progeny and creation of another
lower and dead 
chain – its reincarnation, so to say. (Secret Doctrine, Volume 1, ,
of the 1893 
Edition or Volume 1, , of the Adyar Edition.) 
These seven incarnations (technically called
"manvantaras") make up "the 
planetary evolution," the realm of the planetary Logos. As
there are seven 
planetary Logoi, it will be seen that seven of these planetary
evolutions, each 
distinct from the others, make up the solar system. (Mr. Sinnett
calls these 
"seven schemes of evolution"). In an occult commentary
this coming forth of the 
seven Logoi from the one, and of the seven successive chains of
seven globes 
each, is described: 
From one light seven lights; from each of the seven, seven times
seven. ( Secret 
Doctrine, Volume1, , of the 1893 Edition or Volume 1, , of the
Adyar edition.) 
Taking up the incarnations of the chain, the manvantaras, we learn
that these 
also are sub-divisible into seven stages; a wave of life from the
planetary 
Logos is sent round the chain, and seven of these great life-waves,
each one 
technically spoken of as "a round," complete a single
manvantara. Each globe has 
thus seven periods of activity during a manvantara, each in turn
becoming the 
field of the evolving life. 
Looking at a single globe we find that during the period of its
activity seven 
root-races of a humanity evolve on it, together with six other
non-human 
kingdoms interdependent on each other. As these seven kingdoms
contain forms at 
all stages of evolution, as all have higher reaches stretching before
them, the 
evolving forms of one globe pass to another to carry on their
growth when the 
period of activity of the former globe comes to an end, and go on -
from globe 
to globe to the end of that round; they further pursue their course
round after 
round to the close of the seven rounds or manvantara after
manvantara till the 
end of reincarnations of their planetary chain is reached, when the
results of 
that planetary evolution are gathered up by the planetary Logos.
Needless to say 
that scarcely anything of this evolution is known to us; only the
salient points 
in the stupendous whole have been indicated by the Teachers. 
Even when we come to the planetary evolution in which our own world
is a stage, 
we know nothing of the processes through which its seven globes
evolved during 
its first two manvantaras; and of its third manvantara we only know
that the 
globe which is now our moon was globe D of that planetary chain.
This fact, 
however, may help us to realise more clearly what is meant by these
successive 
reincarnations of a planetary chain. The seven globes which formed
the lunar 
chain passed in due course through their sevenfold evolution; seven
times the 
life-wave, the Breath of the planetary Logos, swept round the
chain, quickening 
in turn each globe into life. 
It is as though that Logos in guiding His kingdom turned His
attention first to 
globe A, and thereon brought into successive existence the
innumerable forms 
that in their totality make up a world; when evolution had been
carried to a 
certain point, He turned His attention to globe B, and globe A
slowly sank into 
a peaceful sleep. Thus the life wave was carried from globe to
globe, until one 
round of the circle was completed by globe G finishing its
evolution; then there 
succeeded a period of rest, (technically called a pralaya), during
which the 
external evolutionary activity ceased. 
At the close of this period, external evolution recommenced,
starting on its 
second round and beginning as before on globe A. The process is
repeated six 
times, but when the seventh, the last round, is reached, there is a
change. 
Globe A, having accomplished its seventh life-period, gradually
disintegrates, 
and the imperishable laya centre state supervenes; from that, at
the dawn of the 
succeeding manvantara a new globe A is evolved – like a new body –
in which the 
"principles" of the preceding planet A take up their
abode. This phrase is only 
intended to convey the idea of a relation between globe A of the
first 
manvantara and globe A of the second, the nature of that connection
remains 
hidden. 
Of the connection between globe D of the lunar manvantara – our
moon – and globe 
D of the terrene manvantara – our earth – we know little more, and
Mr. Sinnett 
has given a convenient summary of the slender knowledge we possess
in The system 
to which we belong. He says:- 
The new earth nebula was developed round a centre bearing pretty
much the same 
relation to the dying planet that the centres of the earth and moon
bear to one 
another at present. But in the nebulous condition this aggregation
of matter 
occupied an enormously greater volume than the solid matter of the
earth now 
occupies. 
It stretched out in all directions so as to include the old planet
in its fiery 
embrace. The temperature of the new nebula appears to be
considerable higher 
than any temperatures we are acquainted with, and by this means the
old planet 
was superficially heated afresh in such a manner that all
atmosphere, water, and 
volatilisable matter upon it was brought into the gaseous condition
and so 
became amenable to the new centre of attraction set up at the
centre of the new 
nebula. 
In this way the air and seas of the old planet were drawn over into
the 
constitution of the new one, and thus it is that the moon in its
present state 
is an arid, glaring mass, dry and cloudless, no longer habitable,
and no longer 
required for the habitation of any physical beings. When the present
manvantara 
is nearly over, during the seventh round, its disintegration will
be completed 
and the matter which it still holds together will resolve into
meteoric dust.(Op 
.cit., ) 
In the third volume of The Secret Doctrine, in which are printed some
of the 
oral teachings given by H.P.Blavatsky to her more advanced pupils,
it is stated: 
At the beginning of the evolution of our globe, the moon was much
nearer to the 
earth, and larger than it is now. It has retreated from us, and
shrunk much in 
size.(The moon gave all her principles to the earth.) A new moon
will appear 
during the seventh round, and our moon will finally disintegrate
and disappear. 
(Op. Cit. III, 562, 1893 Ed.) 
Evolution during the lunar manvantara produced seven classes of beings,
technically called Fathers, or Pitris, since it was they who
generated the 
beings of the terrene manvantara. These are the Lunar Pitris of the
Secret 
Doctrine. More developed than these were two other classes –
variously called 
Solar Pitris, Men, Lower Dhyanis – too far advanced to enter on the
terrene 
evolution in its early stages, but requiring the aid of later
physical 
conditions for their future growth. 
The higher of these two classes consisted of individualised
animal-like beings, 
creatures with embryonic souls, i.e., they had developed the causal
body; the 
second were approaching its formation. Lunar Pitris, the first
class, were at 
the beginning of that approach showing mentality, while the second
and third had 
only developed the kamic principle. 
These seven classes of Lunar Pitris were the product the lunar
chain handed on 
for further development to the terrene, the fourth reincarnation of
the 
planetary chain. As Monads – with the mental principle present in
the first, the 
kamic principle developed in the second and third classes, this
germinal in the 
fourth, only approaching the germ stage in the still less developed
fifth, and 
imperceptible in the sixth and seventh – these entities entered the
earth-chain, 
to ensoul the elemental essence and the forms shaped by the
Builders. ( 
H.P.Blavatsky, in the Secret Doctrine, does not include those whom
Mr. Sinnett 
calls first – and second-class Pitris in the "monads from the
lunar chain": she 
takes them apart as "men," as "Dhyan Chohans."
Compare Volume 1, pages 197, 207 
and 211 of the 1893 edition; Volume 1, pages 227, 236 and 239 of
the Adyar 
edition) 
The nomenclature adopted by me is that of the Secret Doctrine. In
the valuable 
paper by Mrs. Sinnett and Mr. Scott-Elliot on the Lunar Pitris,
H.P.B.’s "Lower 
Dhyanis," that incarnate in the third and fourth rounds, are
taken as the first 
and second classes of Lunar Pitris; their third class is therefore
H.P.B.’s 
first class, their fourth class her second and so on. There is no
difference in 
the statement of facts, only in nomenclature, but this difference
of 
nomenclature may mislead the student if it be not explained. As I
am using 
H.P.B’s nomenclature, my fellow-students of the London Lodge and
readers of 
their "Transaction" will need to remember that my first
is their third, and so 
on sequentially. 
The "Builders" is a name including innumerable
Intelligences, hierarchies of 
beings of graduated consciousness and power, who on each plane
carry out the 
actual building of forms. The higher direct and control, while the
lower fashion 
the materials after the models provided. And now appears the use of
the 
successive globes of the planetary chain. 
Globe A is the archetypal world, on which are built the models of the
forms that 
are to be elaborated during the round; from the mind of the
planetary Logos the 
highest Builders take the archetypal Ideas, and guide the Builders
on the arupa 
levels as they fashion the archetypal forms for the round. 
On globe B these forms are reproduced in varied shapes in mental
matter by a 
lower rank of Builders, and are evolved slowly along different
lines, until they 
are ready to receive an infiltration of denser matter; then the
Builders in 
astral matter take up the task, and on globe C fashion astral
forms, with 
details more worked out; when the forms have been evolved as far as
the astral 
conditions permit, the Builders of globe D take up the task of
form-shaping on 
the physical plane, and the lowest kinds of matter are thus
fashioned into 
appropriate types, and the forms reach their densest and most
complete 
condition. 
From this middle point onwards the nature of the evolution some
what changes; 
hitherto the greatest attention had been directed to the building
of the form; 
on the ascending arc the chief attention is directed to using the
form as a 
vehicle of the evolving life and on the second half of the
evolution on globe D, 
and on globes E and F the consciousness expresses itself first on
the physical 
and then on the astral and lower mental planes through the
equivalents of the 
forms elaborated on the descending arc. 
On the descending arc the monad impresses itself as best it may on
the evolving 
forms, and these impressions, and so on; on the ascending arc the
Monad 
expresses itself through the forms as their inner ruler. On globe G
the 
perfection of the round is reached, the Monad inhabiting and using
as its 
vehicles the archetypal forms of globe A. 
During all these stages the Lunar Pitris have acted as the souls of
the forms, 
brooding over them, later inhabiting them. It is on the first-class
Pitris that 
the heaviest burden of the work falls during the first three
rounds. The second 
and third-class Pitris flow into the forms worked up by the first;
the first 
prepare these forms by ensouling them for a time and then pass on,
leaving them 
for the tenancy of the second and third classes. By the end of the
first round 
the archetypal forms of the mineral would have been brought down,
to be 
elaborated through the succeeding rounds, till they reach their
densest state in 
the middle of the fourth round. "Fire" is the
"element" of this first round. 
In the second round the first-class Pitris continue their human
evolution, only 
touching the lower stages as the human foetus still touches them
today, while 
the second-class, at the close of the round, have reached the
incipient human 
stage. The great work of the round is bringing down the archetypal
forms of 
vegetable life, which will reach their perfection in the fifth
round. "Air" is 
the second round "element". 
In the third round the first-class Pitris becomes definitely human
in form; 
though the body is jelly-like and gigantic, it is yet, on globe D,
compact 
enough to begin to stand upright; he is ape-like and is covered
with hairy 
bristles. The third-class Pitris reach the incipient human stage.
Second class 
solar Pitris make their first appearance on globe D in this round,
and take the 
lead in human evolution. The archetypal forms of animals are
brought down to be 
elaborated into perfection by the end of the sixth round, and
"water" is the 
characteristic "element." 
The fourth round, the middle one of the seven that make up the
terrene 
manvantara, is distinguished by bringing to globe A the archetypal
forms of 
humanity, this round being as distinctively human as its
predecessors were 
respectively animal, vegetable, and mineral. Not ill the seventh
round will 
these forms be fully realised by humanity, but the possibilities of
the human 
form are manifested in the archetypes in the fourth.
"Earth" is the "element" of 
this round, the densest, the most material. The first-class solar
Pitris may be 
said to hover round globe D more or less in this round during its
early stages 
of activity, but they do not definitely incarnate until after the
third great 
out-pouring of life from the planetary Logos in the middle of the
third race, 
and then only slowly, the number increasing as the race progresses,
and 
multitudes incarnating in the early fourth race. 
The evolution of humanity on our earth, globe D, offers in a
strongly marked 
form the continual sevenfold diversity already often alluded to.
Seven races of 
men had already shown themselves in the third round, and in the
fourth these 
fundamental divisions became very clear on globe C, where seven
races, each with 
sub-races evolved. On globe D humanity begins with a First Race –
usually called 
a Root Race – at seven different points, "seven of them, each
on his lot." (Book 
of Dzyan (Stanzas of Dzyan, 3: 13). – Secret Doctrine, Volume 2, ,
of the 1893, 
edition– Volume 3, , of the Adyar edition.) 
These seven types side by side, not successive – make up the first
root-race, 
and each again has its own seven sub-races. From the first
root-race – 
jelly-like amorphous creatures – evolves the second root-race with
forms of more 
definite consistency, and from it the third, ape-like creatures
that become 
clumsy gigantic men. In the middle of the evolution of this third
root-race, 
called the Lemurian, there come to earth – from another planetary
chain, that of 
Venus, much farther advanced in its evolution – members of its
highly evolved 
humanity, glorious Beings, often spoken of as Sons of Fire, from
Their radiant 
appearance, a lofty order among the Sons of Mind. (Manasaputra.
This vast 
hierarchy of self-conscious intelligences embraces many orders.) 
They take up Their abode on earth, as the Divine Teachers of the
young humanity, 
some of them acting as channels for the third outpouring and
projecting into 
animal man the spark of monadic life which forms the causal body.
Thus the 
first, second, and third classes of Lunar Pitris become
individualised – the 
vast bulk of humanity. The two classes of solar Pitris, already
individualised – 
the first ere leaving the lunar chain and the second later – form
two low orders 
of the Sons of Mind; the second incarnate in the third race at its
middle point, 
and the first come in later, for the most part in the fourth race,
the 
Atlantean. 
The fifth, or Aryan race, now leading human evolution, was evolved
from the 
fifth sub-race of the Atlantean, the most promising families being
in Central 
Asia, and the new race-type evolved, under the direct
superintendence of a Great 
Being, technically called a Manu. Emerging from Central Asia the
first sub-race 
settled in India, south of the Himalayas, and in their four orders
of teachers, 
warriors, merchants, and workmen, ( Brahmanas, Kshattriyas,
Vaishyas and Shudras 
) became the dominant race in the vast Indian peninsula, conquering
the 
fourth-race and third-race nations who then inhabited it. 
At the end of the seventh race of the seventh round, i.e., at the
close of our 
terrene manvantara, our chain will hand on to its successor the
fruits of its 
life; these fruits will be the perfected divine men, Buddhas,
Manus, Chohans, 
Masters, ready to take up work of guiding evolution under the
direction of the 
planetary Logos, with hosts of less evolved entities of every grade
of 
consciousness, who still need physical experience for the
perfecting of their 
divine possibilities. 
The fifth, sixth, and seventh manvantaras of our chain are still in
the womb of 
the future after this fourth one has closed, and then the planetary
Logos will 
gather up into Himself all the fruits of evolution, and with his
children enter 
on a period of rest and bliss. Of that high state we cannot speak;
how at this 
stage of our evolution could we dream of its unimaginable glory;
only we dimly 
know that our glad spirits shall "enter into the joy of the
Lord," and, resting 
in Him, shall see stretching before them boundless ranges of
sublime life and 
love, heights and depths of power and joy, limitless as the One
Existence, 
inexhaustable as the One that Is. 
PEACE TO ALL BEINGS 
H P Blavatsky’s Secret Doctrine 
Isis Unveiled by H P Blavatsky
H P Blavatsky’s Esoteric Glossary
Mahatma Letters to A P Sinnett 1 - 25
A Modern Revival of Ancient Wisdom
(Selection of Articles by H P Blavatsky)
The Secret Doctrine – Volume 3
A compilation of H P Blavatsky’s 
writings published after her death
Esoteric Christianity or the Lesser Mysteries
Searchable Theosophical Texts
Theosophy House
